Merge from gnulib
[emacs.git] / doc / misc / texinfo.tex
blob4b4856469a8683b9d9db9f1300c62b2f786a2092
1 % texinfo.tex -- TeX macros to handle Texinfo files.
2 %
3 % Load plain if necessary, i.e., if running under initex.
4 \expandafter\ifx\csname fmtname\endcsname\relax\input plain\fi
6 \def\texinfoversion{2015-05-26.15}
8 % Copyright 1985, 1986, 1988, 1990, 1991, 1992, 1993, 1994, 1995,
9 % 1996, 1997, 1998, 1999, 2000, 2001, 2002, 2003, 2004, 2005, 2006,
10 % 2007, 2008, 2009, 2010, 2011, 2012, 2013, 2014, 2015
11 % Free Software Foundation, Inc.
13 % This texinfo.tex file is free software: you can redistribute it and/or
14 % modify it under the terms of the GNU General Public License as
15 % published by the Free Software Foundation, either version 3 of the
16 % License, or (at your option) any later version.
18 % This texinfo.tex file is distributed in the hope that it will be
19 % useful, but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty
20 % of MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the GNU
21 % General Public License for more details.
23 % You should have received a copy of the GNU General Public License
24 % along with this program. If not, see <http://www.gnu.org/licenses/>.
26 % As a special exception, when this file is read by TeX when processing
27 % a Texinfo source document, you may use the result without
28 % restriction. This Exception is an additional permission under section 7
29 % of the GNU General Public License, version 3 ("GPLv3").
31 % Please try the latest version of texinfo.tex before submitting bug
32 % reports; you can get the latest version from:
33 % http://ftp.gnu.org/gnu/texinfo/ (the Texinfo release area), or
34 % http://ftpmirror.gnu.org/texinfo/ (same, via a mirror), or
35 % http://www.gnu.org/software/texinfo/ (the Texinfo home page)
36 % The texinfo.tex in any given distribution could well be out
37 % of date, so if that's what you're using, please check.
39 % Send bug reports to bug-texinfo@gnu.org. Please include including a
40 % complete document in each bug report with which we can reproduce the
41 % problem. Patches are, of course, greatly appreciated.
43 % To process a Texinfo manual with TeX, it's most reliable to use the
44 % texi2dvi shell script that comes with the distribution. For a simple
45 % manual foo.texi, however, you can get away with this:
46 % tex foo.texi
47 % texindex foo.??
48 % tex foo.texi
49 % tex foo.texi
50 % dvips foo.dvi -o # or whatever; this makes foo.ps.
51 % The extra TeX runs get the cross-reference information correct.
52 % Sometimes one run after texindex suffices, and sometimes you need more
53 % than two; texi2dvi does it as many times as necessary.
55 % It is possible to adapt texinfo.tex for other languages, to some
56 % extent. You can get the existing language-specific files from the
57 % full Texinfo distribution.
59 % The GNU Texinfo home page is http://www.gnu.org/software/texinfo.
62 \message{Loading texinfo [version \texinfoversion]:}
64 % If in a .fmt file, print the version number
65 % and turn on active characters that we couldn't do earlier because
66 % they might have appeared in the input file name.
67 \everyjob{\message{[Texinfo version \texinfoversion]}%
68 \catcode`+=\active \catcode`\_=\active}
70 \chardef\other=12
72 % We never want plain's \outer definition of \+ in Texinfo.
73 % For @tex, we can use \tabalign.
74 \let\+ = \relax
76 % Save some plain tex macros whose names we will redefine.
77 \let\ptexb=\b
78 \let\ptexbullet=\bullet
79 \let\ptexc=\c
80 \let\ptexcomma=\,
81 \let\ptexdot=\.
82 \let\ptexdots=\dots
83 \let\ptexend=\end
84 \let\ptexequiv=\equiv
85 \let\ptexexclam=\!
86 \let\ptexfootnote=\footnote
87 \let\ptexgtr=>
88 \let\ptexhat=^
89 \let\ptexi=\i
90 \let\ptexindent=\indent
91 \let\ptexinsert=\insert
92 \let\ptexlbrace=\{
93 \let\ptexless=<
94 \let\ptexnewwrite\newwrite
95 \let\ptexnoindent=\noindent
96 \let\ptexplus=+
97 \let\ptexraggedright=\raggedright
98 \let\ptexrbrace=\}
99 \let\ptexslash=\/
100 \let\ptexsp=\sp
101 \let\ptexstar=\*
102 \let\ptexsup=\sup
103 \let\ptext=\t
104 \let\ptextop=\top
105 {\catcode`\'=\active \global\let\ptexquoteright'}% active in plain's math mode
107 % If this character appears in an error message or help string, it
108 % starts a new line in the output.
109 \newlinechar = `^^J
111 % Use TeX 3.0's \inputlineno to get the line number, for better error
112 % messages, but if we're using an old version of TeX, don't do anything.
114 \ifx\inputlineno\thisisundefined
115 \let\linenumber = \empty % Pre-3.0.
116 \else
117 \def\linenumber{l.\the\inputlineno:\space}
120 % Set up fixed words for English if not already set.
121 \ifx\putwordAppendix\undefined \gdef\putwordAppendix{Appendix}\fi
122 \ifx\putwordChapter\undefined \gdef\putwordChapter{Chapter}\fi
123 \ifx\putworderror\undefined \gdef\putworderror{error}\fi
124 \ifx\putwordfile\undefined \gdef\putwordfile{file}\fi
125 \ifx\putwordin\undefined \gdef\putwordin{in}\fi
126 \ifx\putwordIndexIsEmpty\undefined \gdef\putwordIndexIsEmpty{(Index is empty)}\fi
127 \ifx\putwordIndexNonexistent\undefined \gdef\putwordIndexNonexistent{(Index is nonexistent)}\fi
128 \ifx\putwordInfo\undefined \gdef\putwordInfo{Info}\fi
129 \ifx\putwordInstanceVariableof\undefined \gdef\putwordInstanceVariableof{Instance Variable of}\fi
130 \ifx\putwordMethodon\undefined \gdef\putwordMethodon{Method on}\fi
131 \ifx\putwordNoTitle\undefined \gdef\putwordNoTitle{No Title}\fi
132 \ifx\putwordof\undefined \gdef\putwordof{of}\fi
133 \ifx\putwordon\undefined \gdef\putwordon{on}\fi
134 \ifx\putwordpage\undefined \gdef\putwordpage{page}\fi
135 \ifx\putwordsection\undefined \gdef\putwordsection{section}\fi
136 \ifx\putwordSection\undefined \gdef\putwordSection{Section}\fi
137 \ifx\putwordsee\undefined \gdef\putwordsee{see}\fi
138 \ifx\putwordSee\undefined \gdef\putwordSee{See}\fi
139 \ifx\putwordShortTOC\undefined \gdef\putwordShortTOC{Short Contents}\fi
140 \ifx\putwordTOC\undefined \gdef\putwordTOC{Table of Contents}\fi
142 \ifx\putwordMJan\undefined \gdef\putwordMJan{January}\fi
143 \ifx\putwordMFeb\undefined \gdef\putwordMFeb{February}\fi
144 \ifx\putwordMMar\undefined \gdef\putwordMMar{March}\fi
145 \ifx\putwordMApr\undefined \gdef\putwordMApr{April}\fi
146 \ifx\putwordMMay\undefined \gdef\putwordMMay{May}\fi
147 \ifx\putwordMJun\undefined \gdef\putwordMJun{June}\fi
148 \ifx\putwordMJul\undefined \gdef\putwordMJul{July}\fi
149 \ifx\putwordMAug\undefined \gdef\putwordMAug{August}\fi
150 \ifx\putwordMSep\undefined \gdef\putwordMSep{September}\fi
151 \ifx\putwordMOct\undefined \gdef\putwordMOct{October}\fi
152 \ifx\putwordMNov\undefined \gdef\putwordMNov{November}\fi
153 \ifx\putwordMDec\undefined \gdef\putwordMDec{December}\fi
155 \ifx\putwordDefmac\undefined \gdef\putwordDefmac{Macro}\fi
156 \ifx\putwordDefspec\undefined \gdef\putwordDefspec{Special Form}\fi
157 \ifx\putwordDefvar\undefined \gdef\putwordDefvar{Variable}\fi
158 \ifx\putwordDefopt\undefined \gdef\putwordDefopt{User Option}\fi
159 \ifx\putwordDeffunc\undefined \gdef\putwordDeffunc{Function}\fi
161 % Since the category of space is not known, we have to be careful.
162 \chardef\spacecat = 10
163 \def\spaceisspace{\catcode`\ =\spacecat}
165 % sometimes characters are active, so we need control sequences.
166 \chardef\ampChar = `\&
167 \chardef\colonChar = `\:
168 \chardef\commaChar = `\,
169 \chardef\dashChar = `\-
170 \chardef\dotChar = `\.
171 \chardef\exclamChar= `\!
172 \chardef\hashChar = `\#
173 \chardef\lquoteChar= `\`
174 \chardef\questChar = `\?
175 \chardef\rquoteChar= `\'
176 \chardef\semiChar = `\;
177 \chardef\slashChar = `\/
178 \chardef\underChar = `\_
180 % Ignore a token.
182 \def\gobble#1{}
184 % The following is used inside several \edef's.
185 \def\makecsname#1{\expandafter\noexpand\csname#1\endcsname}
187 % Hyphenation fixes.
188 \hyphenation{
189 Flor-i-da Ghost-script Ghost-view Mac-OS Post-Script
190 ap-pen-dix bit-map bit-maps
191 data-base data-bases eshell fall-ing half-way long-est man-u-script
192 man-u-scripts mini-buf-fer mini-buf-fers over-view par-a-digm
193 par-a-digms rath-er rec-tan-gu-lar ro-bot-ics se-vere-ly set-up spa-ces
194 spell-ing spell-ings
195 stand-alone strong-est time-stamp time-stamps which-ever white-space
196 wide-spread wrap-around
199 % Margin to add to right of even pages, to left of odd pages.
200 \newdimen\bindingoffset
201 \newdimen\normaloffset
202 \newdimen\pagewidth \newdimen\pageheight
204 % For a final copy, take out the rectangles
205 % that mark overfull boxes (in case you have decided
206 % that the text looks ok even though it passes the margin).
208 \def\finalout{\overfullrule=0pt }
210 % Sometimes it is convenient to have everything in the transcript file
211 % and nothing on the terminal. We don't just call \tracingall here,
212 % since that produces some useless output on the terminal. We also make
213 % some effort to order the tracing commands to reduce output in the log
214 % file; cf. trace.sty in LaTeX.
216 \def\gloggingall{\begingroup \globaldefs = 1 \loggingall \endgroup}%
217 \def\loggingall{%
218 \tracingstats2
219 \tracingpages1
220 \tracinglostchars2 % 2 gives us more in etex
221 \tracingparagraphs1
222 \tracingoutput1
223 \tracingmacros2
224 \tracingrestores1
225 \showboxbreadth\maxdimen \showboxdepth\maxdimen
226 \ifx\eTeXversion\thisisundefined\else % etex gives us more logging
227 \tracingscantokens1
228 \tracingifs1
229 \tracinggroups1
230 \tracingnesting2
231 \tracingassigns1
233 \tracingcommands3 % 3 gives us more in etex
234 \errorcontextlines16
237 % @errormsg{MSG}. Do the index-like expansions on MSG, but if things
238 % aren't perfect, it's not the end of the world, being an error message,
239 % after all.
241 \def\errormsg{\begingroup \indexnofonts \doerrormsg}
242 \def\doerrormsg#1{\errmessage{#1}}
244 % add check for \lastpenalty to plain's definitions. If the last thing
245 % we did was a \nobreak, we don't want to insert more space.
247 \def\smallbreak{\ifnum\lastpenalty<10000\par\ifdim\lastskip<\smallskipamount
248 \removelastskip\penalty-50\smallskip\fi\fi}
249 \def\medbreak{\ifnum\lastpenalty<10000\par\ifdim\lastskip<\medskipamount
250 \removelastskip\penalty-100\medskip\fi\fi}
251 \def\bigbreak{\ifnum\lastpenalty<10000\par\ifdim\lastskip<\bigskipamount
252 \removelastskip\penalty-200\bigskip\fi\fi}
254 % Do @cropmarks to get crop marks.
256 \newif\ifcropmarks
257 \let\cropmarks = \cropmarkstrue
259 % Dimensions to add cropmarks at corners.
260 % Added by P. A. MacKay, 12 Nov. 1986
262 \newdimen\outerhsize \newdimen\outervsize % set by the paper size routines
263 \newdimen\cornerlong \cornerlong=1pc
264 \newdimen\cornerthick \cornerthick=.3pt
265 \newdimen\topandbottommargin \topandbottommargin=.75in
267 % Output a mark which sets \thischapter, \thissection and \thiscolor.
268 % We dump everything together because we only have one kind of mark.
269 % This works because we only use \botmark / \topmark, not \firstmark.
271 % A mark contains a subexpression of the \ifcase ... \fi construct.
272 % \get*marks macros below extract the needed part using \ifcase.
274 % Another complication is to let the user choose whether \thischapter
275 % (\thissection) refers to the chapter (section) in effect at the top
276 % of a page, or that at the bottom of a page. The solution is
277 % described on page 260 of The TeXbook. It involves outputting two
278 % marks for the sectioning macros, one before the section break, and
279 % one after. I won't pretend I can describe this better than DEK...
280 \def\domark{%
281 \toks0=\expandafter{\lastchapterdefs}%
282 \toks2=\expandafter{\lastsectiondefs}%
283 \toks4=\expandafter{\prevchapterdefs}%
284 \toks6=\expandafter{\prevsectiondefs}%
285 \toks8=\expandafter{\lastcolordefs}%
286 \mark{%
287 \the\toks0 \the\toks2 % 0: top marks (\last...)
288 \noexpand\or \the\toks4 \the\toks6 % 1: bottom marks (default, \prev...)
289 \noexpand\else \the\toks8 % 2: color marks
292 % \topmark doesn't work for the very first chapter (after the title
293 % page or the contents), so we use \firstmark there -- this gets us
294 % the mark with the chapter defs, unless the user sneaks in, e.g.,
295 % @setcolor (or @url, or @link, etc.) between @contents and the very
296 % first @chapter.
297 \def\gettopheadingmarks{%
298 \ifcase0\topmark\fi
299 \ifx\thischapter\empty \ifcase0\firstmark\fi \fi
301 \def\getbottomheadingmarks{\ifcase1\botmark\fi}
302 \def\getcolormarks{\ifcase2\topmark\fi}
304 % Avoid "undefined control sequence" errors.
305 \def\lastchapterdefs{}
306 \def\lastsectiondefs{}
307 \def\prevchapterdefs{}
308 \def\prevsectiondefs{}
309 \def\lastcolordefs{}
311 % Main output routine.
312 \chardef\PAGE = 255
313 \output = {\onepageout{\pagecontents\PAGE}}
315 \newbox\headlinebox
316 \newbox\footlinebox
318 % \onepageout takes a vbox as an argument. Note that \pagecontents
319 % does insertions, but you have to call it yourself.
320 \def\onepageout#1{%
321 \ifcropmarks \hoffset=0pt \else \hoffset=\normaloffset \fi
323 \ifodd\pageno \advance\hoffset by \bindingoffset
324 \else \advance\hoffset by -\bindingoffset\fi
326 % Do this outside of the \shipout so @code etc. will be expanded in
327 % the headline as they should be, not taken literally (outputting ''code).
328 \def\commmonheadfootline{\let\hsize=\pagewidth \texinfochars}
330 \ifodd\pageno \getoddheadingmarks \else \getevenheadingmarks \fi
331 \global\setbox\headlinebox = \vbox{\commmonheadfootline \makeheadline}%
333 \ifodd\pageno \getoddfootingmarks \else \getevenfootingmarks \fi
334 \global\setbox\footlinebox = \vbox{\commmonheadfootline \makefootline}%
337 % Have to do this stuff outside the \shipout because we want it to
338 % take effect in \write's, yet the group defined by the \vbox ends
339 % before the \shipout runs.
341 \indexdummies % don't expand commands in the output.
342 \normalturnoffactive % \ in index entries must not stay \, e.g., if
343 % the page break happens to be in the middle of an example.
344 % We don't want .vr (or whatever) entries like this:
345 % \entry{{\tt \indexbackslash }acronym}{32}{\code {\acronym}}
346 % "\acronym" won't work when it's read back in;
347 % it needs to be
348 % {\code {{\tt \backslashcurfont }acronym}
349 \shipout\vbox{%
350 % Do this early so pdf references go to the beginning of the page.
351 \ifpdfmakepagedest \pdfdest name{\the\pageno} xyz\fi
353 \ifcropmarks \vbox to \outervsize\bgroup
354 \hsize = \outerhsize
355 \vskip-\topandbottommargin
356 \vtop to0pt{%
357 \line{\ewtop\hfil\ewtop}%
358 \nointerlineskip
359 \line{%
360 \vbox{\moveleft\cornerthick\nstop}%
361 \hfill
362 \vbox{\moveright\cornerthick\nstop}%
364 \vss}%
365 \vskip\topandbottommargin
366 \line\bgroup
367 \hfil % center the page within the outer (page) hsize.
368 \ifodd\pageno\hskip\bindingoffset\fi
369 \vbox\bgroup
372 \unvbox\headlinebox
373 \pagebody{#1}%
374 \ifdim\ht\footlinebox > 0pt
375 % Only leave this space if the footline is nonempty.
376 % (We lessened \vsize for it in \oddfootingyyy.)
377 % The \baselineskip=24pt in plain's \makefootline has no effect.
378 \vskip 24pt
379 \unvbox\footlinebox
382 \ifcropmarks
383 \egroup % end of \vbox\bgroup
384 \hfil\egroup % end of (centering) \line\bgroup
385 \vskip\topandbottommargin plus1fill minus1fill
386 \boxmaxdepth = \cornerthick
387 \vbox to0pt{\vss
388 \line{%
389 \vbox{\moveleft\cornerthick\nsbot}%
390 \hfill
391 \vbox{\moveright\cornerthick\nsbot}%
393 \nointerlineskip
394 \line{\ewbot\hfil\ewbot}%
396 \egroup % \vbox from first cropmarks clause
398 }% end of \shipout\vbox
399 }% end of group with \indexdummies
400 \advancepageno
401 \ifnum\outputpenalty>-20000 \else\dosupereject\fi
404 \newinsert\margin \dimen\margin=\maxdimen
406 \def\pagebody#1{\vbox to\pageheight{\boxmaxdepth=\maxdepth #1}}
407 {\catcode`\@ =11
408 \gdef\pagecontents#1{\ifvoid\topins\else\unvbox\topins\fi
409 % marginal hacks, juha@viisa.uucp (Juha Takala)
410 \ifvoid\margin\else % marginal info is present
411 \rlap{\kern\hsize\vbox to\z@{\kern1pt\box\margin \vss}}\fi
412 \dimen@=\dp#1\relax \unvbox#1\relax
413 \ifvoid\footins\else\vskip\skip\footins\footnoterule \unvbox\footins\fi
414 \ifr@ggedbottom \kern-\dimen@ \vfil \fi}
417 % Here are the rules for the cropmarks. Note that they are
418 % offset so that the space between them is truly \outerhsize or \outervsize
419 % (P. A. MacKay, 12 November, 1986)
421 \def\ewtop{\vrule height\cornerthick depth0pt width\cornerlong}
422 \def\nstop{\vbox
423 {\hrule height\cornerthick depth\cornerlong width\cornerthick}}
424 \def\ewbot{\vrule height0pt depth\cornerthick width\cornerlong}
425 \def\nsbot{\vbox
426 {\hrule height\cornerlong depth\cornerthick width\cornerthick}}
428 % Parse an argument, then pass it to #1. The argument is the rest of
429 % the input line (except we remove a trailing comment). #1 should be a
430 % macro which expects an ordinary undelimited TeX argument.
432 \def\parsearg{\parseargusing{}}
433 \def\parseargusing#1#2{%
434 \def\argtorun{#2}%
435 \begingroup
436 \obeylines
437 \spaceisspace
439 \parseargline\empty% Insert the \empty token, see \finishparsearg below.
442 {\obeylines %
443 \gdef\parseargline#1^^M{%
444 \endgroup % End of the group started in \parsearg.
445 \argremovecomment #1\comment\ArgTerm%
449 % First remove any @comment, then any @c comment.
450 \def\argremovecomment#1\comment#2\ArgTerm{\argremovec #1\c\ArgTerm}
451 \def\argremovec#1\c#2\ArgTerm{\argcheckspaces#1\^^M\ArgTerm}
453 % Each occurrence of `\^^M' or `<space>\^^M' is replaced by a single space.
455 % \argremovec might leave us with trailing space, e.g.,
456 % @end itemize @c foo
457 % This space token undergoes the same procedure and is eventually removed
458 % by \finishparsearg.
460 \def\argcheckspaces#1\^^M{\argcheckspacesX#1\^^M \^^M}
461 \def\argcheckspacesX#1 \^^M{\argcheckspacesY#1\^^M}
462 \def\argcheckspacesY#1\^^M#2\^^M#3\ArgTerm{%
463 \def\temp{#3}%
464 \ifx\temp\empty
465 % Do not use \next, perhaps the caller of \parsearg uses it; reuse \temp:
466 \let\temp\finishparsearg
467 \else
468 \let\temp\argcheckspaces
470 % Put the space token in:
471 \temp#1 #3\ArgTerm
474 % If a _delimited_ argument is enclosed in braces, they get stripped; so
475 % to get _exactly_ the rest of the line, we had to prevent such situation.
476 % We prepended an \empty token at the very beginning and we expand it now,
477 % just before passing the control to \argtorun.
478 % (Similarly, we have to think about #3 of \argcheckspacesY above: it is
479 % either the null string, or it ends with \^^M---thus there is no danger
480 % that a pair of braces would be stripped.
482 % But first, we have to remove the trailing space token.
484 \def\finishparsearg#1 \ArgTerm{\expandafter\argtorun\expandafter{#1}}
486 % \parseargdef\foo{...}
487 % is roughly equivalent to
488 % \def\foo{\parsearg\Xfoo}
489 % \def\Xfoo#1{...}
491 % Actually, I use \csname\string\foo\endcsname, ie. \\foo, as it is my
492 % favourite TeX trick. --kasal, 16nov03
494 \def\parseargdef#1{%
495 \expandafter \doparseargdef \csname\string#1\endcsname #1%
497 \def\doparseargdef#1#2{%
498 \def#2{\parsearg#1}%
499 \def#1##1%
502 % Several utility definitions with active space:
504 \obeyspaces
505 \gdef\obeyedspace{ }
507 % Make each space character in the input produce a normal interword
508 % space in the output. Don't allow a line break at this space, as this
509 % is used only in environments like @example, where each line of input
510 % should produce a line of output anyway.
512 \gdef\sepspaces{\obeyspaces\let =\tie}
514 % If an index command is used in an @example environment, any spaces
515 % therein should become regular spaces in the raw index file, not the
516 % expansion of \tie (\leavevmode \penalty \@M \ ).
517 \gdef\unsepspaces{\let =\space}
521 \def\flushcr{\ifx\par\lisppar \def\next##1{}\else \let\next=\relax \fi \next}
523 % Define the framework for environments in texinfo.tex. It's used like this:
525 % \envdef\foo{...}
526 % \def\Efoo{...}
528 % It's the responsibility of \envdef to insert \begingroup before the
529 % actual body; @end closes the group after calling \Efoo. \envdef also
530 % defines \thisenv, so the current environment is known; @end checks
531 % whether the environment name matches. The \checkenv macro can also be
532 % used to check whether the current environment is the one expected.
534 % Non-false conditionals (@iftex, @ifset) don't fit into this, so they
535 % are not treated as environments; they don't open a group. (The
536 % implementation of @end takes care not to call \endgroup in this
537 % special case.)
540 % At run-time, environments start with this:
541 \def\startenvironment#1{\begingroup\def\thisenv{#1}}
542 % initialize
543 \let\thisenv\empty
545 % ... but they get defined via ``\envdef\foo{...}'':
546 \long\def\envdef#1#2{\def#1{\startenvironment#1#2}}
547 \def\envparseargdef#1#2{\parseargdef#1{\startenvironment#1#2}}
549 % Check whether we're in the right environment:
550 \def\checkenv#1{%
551 \def\temp{#1}%
552 \ifx\thisenv\temp
553 \else
554 \badenverr
558 % Environment mismatch, #1 expected:
559 \def\badenverr{%
560 \errhelp = \EMsimple
561 \errmessage{This command can appear only \inenvironment\temp,
562 not \inenvironment\thisenv}%
564 \def\inenvironment#1{%
565 \ifx#1\empty
566 outside of any environment%
567 \else
568 in environment \expandafter\string#1%
572 % @end foo executes the definition of \Efoo.
573 % But first, it executes a specialized version of \checkenv
575 \parseargdef\end{%
576 \if 1\csname iscond.#1\endcsname
577 \else
578 % The general wording of \badenverr may not be ideal.
579 \expandafter\checkenv\csname#1\endcsname
580 \csname E#1\endcsname
581 \endgroup
585 \newhelp\EMsimple{Press RETURN to continue.}
588 % Be sure we're in horizontal mode when doing a tie, since we make space
589 % equivalent to this in @example-like environments. Otherwise, a space
590 % at the beginning of a line will start with \penalty -- and
591 % since \penalty is valid in vertical mode, we'd end up putting the
592 % penalty on the vertical list instead of in the new paragraph.
593 {\catcode`@ = 11
594 % Avoid using \@M directly, because that causes trouble
595 % if the definition is written into an index file.
596 \global\let\tiepenalty = \@M
597 \gdef\tie{\leavevmode\penalty\tiepenalty\ }
600 % @: forces normal size whitespace following.
601 \def\:{\spacefactor=1000 }
603 % @* forces a line break.
604 \def\*{\unskip\hfil\break\hbox{}\ignorespaces}
606 % @/ allows a line break.
607 \let\/=\allowbreak
609 % @. is an end-of-sentence period.
610 \def\.{.\spacefactor=\endofsentencespacefactor\space}
612 % @! is an end-of-sentence bang.
613 \def\!{!\spacefactor=\endofsentencespacefactor\space}
615 % @? is an end-of-sentence query.
616 \def\?{?\spacefactor=\endofsentencespacefactor\space}
618 % @frenchspacing on|off says whether to put extra space after punctuation.
620 \def\onword{on}
621 \def\offword{off}
623 \parseargdef\frenchspacing{%
624 \def\temp{#1}%
625 \ifx\temp\onword \plainfrenchspacing
626 \else\ifx\temp\offword \plainnonfrenchspacing
627 \else
628 \errhelp = \EMsimple
629 \errmessage{Unknown @frenchspacing option `\temp', must be on|off}%
630 \fi\fi
633 % @w prevents a word break. Without the \leavevmode, @w at the
634 % beginning of a paragraph, when TeX is still in vertical mode, would
635 % produce a whole line of output instead of starting the paragraph.
636 \def\w#1{\leavevmode\hbox{#1}}
638 % @group ... @end group forces ... to be all on one page, by enclosing
639 % it in a TeX vbox. We use \vtop instead of \vbox to construct the box
640 % to keep its height that of a normal line. According to the rules for
641 % \topskip (p.114 of the TeXbook), the glue inserted is
642 % max (\topskip - \ht (first item), 0). If that height is large,
643 % therefore, no glue is inserted, and the space between the headline and
644 % the text is small, which looks bad.
646 % Another complication is that the group might be very large. This can
647 % cause the glue on the previous page to be unduly stretched, because it
648 % does not have much material. In this case, it's better to add an
649 % explicit \vfill so that the extra space is at the bottom. The
650 % threshold for doing this is if the group is more than \vfilllimit
651 % percent of a page (\vfilllimit can be changed inside of @tex).
653 \newbox\groupbox
654 \def\vfilllimit{0.7}
656 \envdef\group{%
657 \ifnum\catcode`\^^M=\active \else
658 \errhelp = \groupinvalidhelp
659 \errmessage{@group invalid in context where filling is enabled}%
661 \startsavinginserts
663 \setbox\groupbox = \vtop\bgroup
664 % Do @comment since we are called inside an environment such as
665 % @example, where each end-of-line in the input causes an
666 % end-of-line in the output. We don't want the end-of-line after
667 % the `@group' to put extra space in the output. Since @group
668 % should appear on a line by itself (according to the Texinfo
669 % manual), we don't worry about eating any user text.
670 \comment
673 % The \vtop produces a box with normal height and large depth; thus, TeX puts
674 % \baselineskip glue before it, and (when the next line of text is done)
675 % \lineskip glue after it. Thus, space below is not quite equal to space
676 % above. But it's pretty close.
677 \def\Egroup{%
678 % To get correct interline space between the last line of the group
679 % and the first line afterwards, we have to propagate \prevdepth.
680 \endgraf % Not \par, as it may have been set to \lisppar.
681 \global\dimen1 = \prevdepth
682 \egroup % End the \vtop.
683 % \dimen0 is the vertical size of the group's box.
684 \dimen0 = \ht\groupbox \advance\dimen0 by \dp\groupbox
685 % \dimen2 is how much space is left on the page (more or less).
686 \dimen2 = \pageheight \advance\dimen2 by -\pagetotal
687 % if the group doesn't fit on the current page, and it's a big big
688 % group, force a page break.
689 \ifdim \dimen0 > \dimen2
690 \ifdim \pagetotal < \vfilllimit\pageheight
691 \page
694 \box\groupbox
695 \prevdepth = \dimen1
696 \checkinserts
699 % TeX puts in an \escapechar (i.e., `@') at the beginning of the help
700 % message, so this ends up printing `@group can only ...'.
702 \newhelp\groupinvalidhelp{%
703 group can only be used in environments such as @example,^^J%
704 where each line of input produces a line of output.}
706 % @need space-in-mils
707 % forces a page break if there is not space-in-mils remaining.
709 \newdimen\mil \mil=0.001in
711 \parseargdef\need{%
712 % Ensure vertical mode, so we don't make a big box in the middle of a
713 % paragraph.
714 \par
716 % If the @need value is less than one line space, it's useless.
717 \dimen0 = #1\mil
718 \dimen2 = \ht\strutbox
719 \advance\dimen2 by \dp\strutbox
720 \ifdim\dimen0 > \dimen2
722 % Do a \strut just to make the height of this box be normal, so the
723 % normal leading is inserted relative to the preceding line.
724 % And a page break here is fine.
725 \vtop to #1\mil{\strut\vfil}%
727 % TeX does not even consider page breaks if a penalty added to the
728 % main vertical list is 10000 or more. But in order to see if the
729 % empty box we just added fits on the page, we must make it consider
730 % page breaks. On the other hand, we don't want to actually break the
731 % page after the empty box. So we use a penalty of 9999.
733 % There is an extremely small chance that TeX will actually break the
734 % page at this \penalty, if there are no other feasible breakpoints in
735 % sight. (If the user is using lots of big @group commands, which
736 % almost-but-not-quite fill up a page, TeX will have a hard time doing
737 % good page breaking, for example.) However, I could not construct an
738 % example where a page broke at this \penalty; if it happens in a real
739 % document, then we can reconsider our strategy.
740 \penalty9999
742 % Back up by the size of the box, whether we did a page break or not.
743 \kern -#1\mil
745 % Do not allow a page break right after this kern.
746 \nobreak
750 % @br forces paragraph break (and is undocumented).
752 \let\br = \par
754 % @page forces the start of a new page.
756 \def\page{\par\vfill\supereject}
758 % @exdent text....
759 % outputs text on separate line in roman font, starting at standard page margin
761 % This records the amount of indent in the innermost environment.
762 % That's how much \exdent should take out.
763 \newskip\exdentamount
765 % This defn is used inside fill environments such as @defun.
766 \parseargdef\exdent{\hfil\break\hbox{\kern -\exdentamount{\rm#1}}\hfil\break}
768 % This defn is used inside nofill environments such as @example.
769 \parseargdef\nofillexdent{{\advance \leftskip by -\exdentamount
770 \leftline{\hskip\leftskip{\rm#1}}}}
772 % @inmargin{WHICH}{TEXT} puts TEXT in the WHICH margin next to the current
773 % paragraph. For more general purposes, use the \margin insertion
774 % class. WHICH is `l' or `r'. Not documented, written for gawk manual.
776 \newskip\inmarginspacing \inmarginspacing=1cm
777 \def\strutdepth{\dp\strutbox}
779 \def\doinmargin#1#2{\strut\vadjust{%
780 \nobreak
781 \kern-\strutdepth
782 \vtop to \strutdepth{%
783 \baselineskip=\strutdepth
784 \vss
785 % if you have multiple lines of stuff to put here, you'll need to
786 % make the vbox yourself of the appropriate size.
787 \ifx#1l%
788 \llap{\ignorespaces #2\hskip\inmarginspacing}%
789 \else
790 \rlap{\hskip\hsize \hskip\inmarginspacing \ignorespaces #2}%
792 \null
795 \def\inleftmargin{\doinmargin l}
796 \def\inrightmargin{\doinmargin r}
798 % @inmargin{TEXT [, RIGHT-TEXT]}
799 % (if RIGHT-TEXT is given, use TEXT for left page, RIGHT-TEXT for right;
800 % else use TEXT for both).
802 \def\inmargin#1{\parseinmargin #1,,\finish}
803 \def\parseinmargin#1,#2,#3\finish{% not perfect, but better than nothing.
804 \setbox0 = \hbox{\ignorespaces #2}%
805 \ifdim\wd0 > 0pt
806 \def\lefttext{#1}% have both texts
807 \def\righttext{#2}%
808 \else
809 \def\lefttext{#1}% have only one text
810 \def\righttext{#1}%
813 \ifodd\pageno
814 \def\temp{\inrightmargin\righttext}% odd page -> outside is right margin
815 \else
816 \def\temp{\inleftmargin\lefttext}%
818 \temp
821 % @| inserts a changebar to the left of the current line. It should
822 % surround any changed text. This approach does *not* work if the
823 % change spans more than two lines of output. To handle that, we would
824 % have adopt a much more difficult approach (putting marks into the main
825 % vertical list for the beginning and end of each change). This command
826 % is not documented, not supported, and doesn't work.
828 \def\|{%
829 % \vadjust can only be used in horizontal mode.
830 \leavevmode
832 % Append this vertical mode material after the current line in the output.
833 \vadjust{%
834 % We want to insert a rule with the height and depth of the current
835 % leading; that is exactly what \strutbox is supposed to record.
836 \vskip-\baselineskip
838 % \vadjust-items are inserted at the left edge of the type. So
839 % the \llap here moves out into the left-hand margin.
840 \llap{%
842 % For a thicker or thinner bar, change the `1pt'.
843 \vrule height\baselineskip width1pt
845 % This is the space between the bar and the text.
846 \hskip 12pt
851 % @include FILE -- \input text of FILE.
853 \def\include{\parseargusing\filenamecatcodes\includezzz}
854 \def\includezzz#1{%
855 \pushthisfilestack
856 \def\thisfile{#1}%
858 \makevalueexpandable % we want to expand any @value in FILE.
859 \turnoffactive % and allow special characters in the expansion
860 \indexnofonts % Allow `@@' and other weird things in file names.
861 \wlog{texinfo.tex: doing @include of #1^^J}%
862 \edef\temp{\noexpand\input #1 }%
864 % This trickery is to read FILE outside of a group, in case it makes
865 % definitions, etc.
866 \expandafter
867 }\temp
868 \popthisfilestack
870 \def\filenamecatcodes{%
871 \catcode`\\=\other
872 \catcode`~=\other
873 \catcode`^=\other
874 \catcode`_=\other
875 \catcode`|=\other
876 \catcode`<=\other
877 \catcode`>=\other
878 \catcode`+=\other
879 \catcode`-=\other
880 \catcode`\`=\other
881 \catcode`\'=\other
884 \def\pushthisfilestack{%
885 \expandafter\pushthisfilestackX\popthisfilestack\StackTerm
887 \def\pushthisfilestackX{%
888 \expandafter\pushthisfilestackY\thisfile\StackTerm
890 \def\pushthisfilestackY #1\StackTerm #2\StackTerm {%
891 \gdef\popthisfilestack{\gdef\thisfile{#1}\gdef\popthisfilestack{#2}}%
894 \def\popthisfilestack{\errthisfilestackempty}
895 \def\errthisfilestackempty{\errmessage{Internal error:
896 the stack of filenames is empty.}}
898 \def\thisfile{}
900 % @center line
901 % outputs that line, centered.
903 \parseargdef\center{%
904 \ifhmode
905 \let\centersub\centerH
906 \else
907 \let\centersub\centerV
909 \centersub{\hfil \ignorespaces#1\unskip \hfil}%
910 \let\centersub\relax % don't let the definition persist, just in case
912 \def\centerH#1{{%
913 \hfil\break
914 \advance\hsize by -\leftskip
915 \advance\hsize by -\rightskip
916 \line{#1}%
917 \break
920 \newcount\centerpenalty
921 \def\centerV#1{%
922 % The idea here is the same as in \startdefun, \cartouche, etc.: if
923 % @center is the first thing after a section heading, we need to wipe
924 % out the negative parskip inserted by \sectionheading, but still
925 % prevent a page break here.
926 \centerpenalty = \lastpenalty
927 \ifnum\centerpenalty>10000 \vskip\parskip \fi
928 \ifnum\centerpenalty>9999 \penalty\centerpenalty \fi
929 \line{\kern\leftskip #1\kern\rightskip}%
932 % @sp n outputs n lines of vertical space
934 \parseargdef\sp{\vskip #1\baselineskip}
936 % @comment ...line which is ignored...
937 % @c is the same as @comment
938 % @ignore ... @end ignore is another way to write a comment
940 \def\comment{\begingroup \catcode`\^^M=\other%
941 \catcode`\@=\other \catcode`\{=\other \catcode`\}=\other%
942 \commentxxx}
943 {\catcode`\^^M=\other \gdef\commentxxx#1^^M{\endgroup}}
945 \let\c=\comment
947 % @paragraphindent NCHARS
948 % We'll use ems for NCHARS, close enough.
949 % NCHARS can also be the word `asis' or `none'.
950 % We cannot feasibly implement @paragraphindent asis, though.
952 \def\asisword{asis} % no translation, these are keywords
953 \def\noneword{none}
955 \parseargdef\paragraphindent{%
956 \def\temp{#1}%
957 \ifx\temp\asisword
958 \else
959 \ifx\temp\noneword
960 \defaultparindent = 0pt
961 \else
962 \defaultparindent = #1em
965 \parindent = \defaultparindent
968 % @exampleindent NCHARS
969 % We'll use ems for NCHARS like @paragraphindent.
970 % It seems @exampleindent asis isn't necessary, but
971 % I preserve it to make it similar to @paragraphindent.
972 \parseargdef\exampleindent{%
973 \def\temp{#1}%
974 \ifx\temp\asisword
975 \else
976 \ifx\temp\noneword
977 \lispnarrowing = 0pt
978 \else
979 \lispnarrowing = #1em
984 % @firstparagraphindent WORD
985 % If WORD is `none', then suppress indentation of the first paragraph
986 % after a section heading. If WORD is `insert', then do indent at such
987 % paragraphs.
989 % The paragraph indentation is suppressed or not by calling
990 % \suppressfirstparagraphindent, which the sectioning commands do.
991 % We switch the definition of this back and forth according to WORD.
992 % By default, we suppress indentation.
994 \def\suppressfirstparagraphindent{\dosuppressfirstparagraphindent}
995 \def\insertword{insert}
997 \parseargdef\firstparagraphindent{%
998 \def\temp{#1}%
999 \ifx\temp\noneword
1000 \let\suppressfirstparagraphindent = \dosuppressfirstparagraphindent
1001 \else\ifx\temp\insertword
1002 \let\suppressfirstparagraphindent = \relax
1003 \else
1004 \errhelp = \EMsimple
1005 \errmessage{Unknown @firstparagraphindent option `\temp'}%
1006 \fi\fi
1009 % Here is how we actually suppress indentation. Redefine \everypar to
1010 % \kern backwards by \parindent, and then reset itself to empty.
1012 % We also make \indent itself not actually do anything until the next
1013 % paragraph.
1015 \gdef\dosuppressfirstparagraphindent{%
1016 \gdef\indent {\restorefirstparagraphindent \indent}%
1017 \gdef\noindent{\restorefirstparagraphindent \noindent}%
1018 \global\everypar = {\kern -\parindent \restorefirstparagraphindent}%
1021 \gdef\restorefirstparagraphindent{%
1022 \global\let\indent = \ptexindent
1023 \global\let\noindent = \ptexnoindent
1024 \global\everypar = {}%
1028 % @refill is a no-op.
1029 \let\refill=\relax
1031 % If working on a large document in chapters, it is convenient to
1032 % be able to disable indexing, cross-referencing, and contents, for test runs.
1033 % This is done with @novalidate (before @setfilename).
1035 \newif\iflinks \linkstrue % by default we want the aux files.
1036 \let\novalidate = \linksfalse
1038 % @setfilename is done at the beginning of every texinfo file.
1039 % So open here the files we need to have open while reading the input.
1040 % This makes it possible to make a .fmt file for texinfo.
1041 \def\setfilename{%
1042 \fixbackslash % Turn off hack to swallow `\input texinfo'.
1043 \iflinks
1044 \tryauxfile
1045 % Open the new aux file. TeX will close it automatically at exit.
1046 \immediate\openout\auxfile=\jobname.aux
1047 \fi % \openindices needs to do some work in any case.
1048 \openindices
1049 \let\setfilename=\comment % Ignore extra @setfilename cmds.
1051 % If texinfo.cnf is present on the system, read it.
1052 % Useful for site-wide @afourpaper, etc.
1053 \openin 1 texinfo.cnf
1054 \ifeof 1 \else \input texinfo.cnf \fi
1055 \closein 1
1057 \comment % Ignore the actual filename.
1060 % Called from \setfilename.
1062 \def\openindices{%
1063 \newindex{cp}%
1064 \newcodeindex{fn}%
1065 \newcodeindex{vr}%
1066 \newcodeindex{tp}%
1067 \newcodeindex{ky}%
1068 \newcodeindex{pg}%
1071 % @bye.
1072 \outer\def\bye{\pagealignmacro\tracingstats=1\ptexend}
1075 \message{pdf,}
1076 % adobe `portable' document format
1077 \newcount\tempnum
1078 \newcount\lnkcount
1079 \newtoks\filename
1080 \newcount\filenamelength
1081 \newcount\pgn
1082 \newtoks\toksA
1083 \newtoks\toksB
1084 \newtoks\toksC
1085 \newtoks\toksD
1086 \newbox\boxA
1087 \newcount\countA
1088 \newif\ifpdf
1089 \newif\ifpdfmakepagedest
1091 % when pdftex is run in dvi mode, \pdfoutput is defined (so \pdfoutput=1
1092 % can be set). So we test for \relax and 0 as well as being undefined.
1093 \ifx\pdfoutput\thisisundefined
1094 \else
1095 \ifx\pdfoutput\relax
1096 \else
1097 \ifcase\pdfoutput
1098 \else
1099 \pdftrue
1104 % PDF uses PostScript string constants for the names of xref targets,
1105 % for display in the outlines, and in other places. Thus, we have to
1106 % double any backslashes. Otherwise, a name like "\node" will be
1107 % interpreted as a newline (\n), followed by o, d, e. Not good.
1109 % See http://www.ntg.nl/pipermail/ntg-pdftex/2004-July/000654.html and
1110 % related messages. The final outcome is that it is up to the TeX user
1111 % to double the backslashes and otherwise make the string valid, so
1112 % that's what we do. pdftex 1.30.0 (ca.2005) introduced a primitive to
1113 % do this reliably, so we use it.
1115 % #1 is a control sequence in which to do the replacements,
1116 % which we \xdef.
1117 \def\txiescapepdf#1{%
1118 \ifx\pdfescapestring\thisisundefined
1119 % No primitive available; should we give a warning or log?
1120 % Many times it won't matter.
1121 \else
1122 % The expandable \pdfescapestring primitive escapes parentheses,
1123 % backslashes, and other special chars.
1124 \xdef#1{\pdfescapestring{#1}}%
1128 \newhelp\nopdfimagehelp{Texinfo supports .png, .jpg, .jpeg, and .pdf images
1129 with PDF output, and none of those formats could be found. (.eps cannot
1130 be supported due to the design of the PDF format; use regular TeX (DVI
1131 output) for that.)}
1133 \ifpdf
1135 % Color manipulation macros using ideas from pdfcolor.tex,
1136 % except using rgb instead of cmyk; the latter is said to render as a
1137 % very dark gray on-screen and a very dark halftone in print, instead
1138 % of actual black. The dark red here is dark enough to print on paper as
1139 % nearly black, but still distinguishable for online viewing. We use
1140 % black by default, though.
1141 \def\rgbDarkRed{0.50 0.09 0.12}
1142 \def\rgbBlack{0 0 0}
1144 % k sets the color for filling (usual text, etc.);
1145 % K sets the color for stroking (thin rules, e.g., normal _'s).
1146 \def\pdfsetcolor#1{\pdfliteral{#1 rg #1 RG}}
1148 % Set color, and create a mark which defines \thiscolor accordingly,
1149 % so that \makeheadline knows which color to restore.
1150 \def\setcolor#1{%
1151 \xdef\lastcolordefs{\gdef\noexpand\thiscolor{#1}}%
1152 \domark
1153 \pdfsetcolor{#1}%
1156 \def\maincolor{\rgbBlack}
1157 \pdfsetcolor{\maincolor}
1158 \edef\thiscolor{\maincolor}
1159 \def\lastcolordefs{}
1161 \def\makefootline{%
1162 \baselineskip24pt
1163 \line{\pdfsetcolor{\maincolor}\the\footline}%
1166 \def\makeheadline{%
1167 \vbox to 0pt{%
1168 \vskip-22.5pt
1169 \line{%
1170 \vbox to8.5pt{}%
1171 % Extract \thiscolor definition from the marks.
1172 \getcolormarks
1173 % Typeset the headline with \maincolor, then restore the color.
1174 \pdfsetcolor{\maincolor}\the\headline\pdfsetcolor{\thiscolor}%
1176 \vss
1178 \nointerlineskip
1182 \pdfcatalog{/PageMode /UseOutlines}
1184 % #1 is image name, #2 width (might be empty/whitespace), #3 height (ditto).
1185 \def\dopdfimage#1#2#3{%
1186 \def\pdfimagewidth{#2}\setbox0 = \hbox{\ignorespaces #2}%
1187 \def\pdfimageheight{#3}\setbox2 = \hbox{\ignorespaces #3}%
1189 % pdftex (and the PDF format) support .pdf, .png, .jpg (among
1190 % others). Let's try in that order, PDF first since if
1191 % someone has a scalable image, presumably better to use that than a
1192 % bitmap.
1193 \let\pdfimgext=\empty
1194 \begingroup
1195 \openin 1 #1.pdf \ifeof 1
1196 \openin 1 #1.PDF \ifeof 1
1197 \openin 1 #1.png \ifeof 1
1198 \openin 1 #1.jpg \ifeof 1
1199 \openin 1 #1.jpeg \ifeof 1
1200 \openin 1 #1.JPG \ifeof 1
1201 \errhelp = \nopdfimagehelp
1202 \errmessage{Could not find image file #1 for pdf}%
1203 \else \gdef\pdfimgext{JPG}%
1205 \else \gdef\pdfimgext{jpeg}%
1207 \else \gdef\pdfimgext{jpg}%
1209 \else \gdef\pdfimgext{png}%
1211 \else \gdef\pdfimgext{PDF}%
1213 \else \gdef\pdfimgext{pdf}%
1215 \closein 1
1216 \endgroup
1218 % without \immediate, ancient pdftex seg faults when the same image is
1219 % included twice. (Version 3.14159-pre-1.0-unofficial-20010704.)
1220 \ifnum\pdftexversion < 14
1221 \immediate\pdfimage
1222 \else
1223 \immediate\pdfximage
1225 \ifdim \wd0 >0pt width \pdfimagewidth \fi
1226 \ifdim \wd2 >0pt height \pdfimageheight \fi
1227 \ifnum\pdftexversion<13
1228 #1.\pdfimgext
1229 \else
1230 {#1.\pdfimgext}%
1232 \ifnum\pdftexversion < 14 \else
1233 \pdfrefximage \pdflastximage
1234 \fi}
1236 \def\pdfmkdest#1{{%
1237 % We have to set dummies so commands such as @code, and characters
1238 % such as \, aren't expanded when present in a section title.
1239 \indexnofonts
1240 \turnoffactive
1241 \makevalueexpandable
1242 \def\pdfdestname{#1}%
1243 \txiescapepdf\pdfdestname
1244 \safewhatsit{\pdfdest name{\pdfdestname} xyz}%
1247 % used to mark target names; must be expandable.
1248 \def\pdfmkpgn#1{#1}
1250 % by default, use black for everything.
1251 \def\urlcolor{\rgbBlack}
1252 \def\linkcolor{\rgbBlack}
1253 \def\endlink{\setcolor{\maincolor}\pdfendlink}
1255 % Adding outlines to PDF; macros for calculating structure of outlines
1256 % come from Petr Olsak
1257 \def\expnumber#1{\expandafter\ifx\csname#1\endcsname\relax 0%
1258 \else \csname#1\endcsname \fi}
1259 \def\advancenumber#1{\tempnum=\expnumber{#1}\relax
1260 \advance\tempnum by 1
1261 \expandafter\xdef\csname#1\endcsname{\the\tempnum}}
1263 % #1 is the section text, which is what will be displayed in the
1264 % outline by the pdf viewer. #2 is the pdf expression for the number
1265 % of subentries (or empty, for subsubsections). #3 is the node text,
1266 % which might be empty if this toc entry had no corresponding node.
1267 % #4 is the page number
1269 \def\dopdfoutline#1#2#3#4{%
1270 % Generate a link to the node text if that exists; else, use the
1271 % page number. We could generate a destination for the section
1272 % text in the case where a section has no node, but it doesn't
1273 % seem worth the trouble, since most documents are normally structured.
1274 \edef\pdfoutlinedest{#3}%
1275 \ifx\pdfoutlinedest\empty
1276 \def\pdfoutlinedest{#4}%
1277 \else
1278 \txiescapepdf\pdfoutlinedest
1281 % Also escape PDF chars in the display string.
1282 \edef\pdfoutlinetext{#1}%
1283 \txiescapepdf\pdfoutlinetext
1285 \pdfoutline goto name{\pdfmkpgn{\pdfoutlinedest}}#2{\pdfoutlinetext}%
1288 \def\pdfmakeoutlines{%
1289 \begingroup
1290 % Read toc silently, to get counts of subentries for \pdfoutline.
1291 \def\partentry##1##2##3##4{}% ignore parts in the outlines
1292 \def\numchapentry##1##2##3##4{%
1293 \def\thischapnum{##2}%
1294 \def\thissecnum{0}%
1295 \def\thissubsecnum{0}%
1297 \def\numsecentry##1##2##3##4{%
1298 \advancenumber{chap\thischapnum}%
1299 \def\thissecnum{##2}%
1300 \def\thissubsecnum{0}%
1302 \def\numsubsecentry##1##2##3##4{%
1303 \advancenumber{sec\thissecnum}%
1304 \def\thissubsecnum{##2}%
1306 \def\numsubsubsecentry##1##2##3##4{%
1307 \advancenumber{subsec\thissubsecnum}%
1309 \def\thischapnum{0}%
1310 \def\thissecnum{0}%
1311 \def\thissubsecnum{0}%
1313 % use \def rather than \let here because we redefine \chapentry et
1314 % al. a second time, below.
1315 \def\appentry{\numchapentry}%
1316 \def\appsecentry{\numsecentry}%
1317 \def\appsubsecentry{\numsubsecentry}%
1318 \def\appsubsubsecentry{\numsubsubsecentry}%
1319 \def\unnchapentry{\numchapentry}%
1320 \def\unnsecentry{\numsecentry}%
1321 \def\unnsubsecentry{\numsubsecentry}%
1322 \def\unnsubsubsecentry{\numsubsubsecentry}%
1323 \readdatafile{toc}%
1325 % Read toc second time, this time actually producing the outlines.
1326 % The `-' means take the \expnumber as the absolute number of
1327 % subentries, which we calculated on our first read of the .toc above.
1329 % We use the node names as the destinations.
1330 \def\numchapentry##1##2##3##4{%
1331 \dopdfoutline{##1}{count-\expnumber{chap##2}}{##3}{##4}}%
1332 \def\numsecentry##1##2##3##4{%
1333 \dopdfoutline{##1}{count-\expnumber{sec##2}}{##3}{##4}}%
1334 \def\numsubsecentry##1##2##3##4{%
1335 \dopdfoutline{##1}{count-\expnumber{subsec##2}}{##3}{##4}}%
1336 \def\numsubsubsecentry##1##2##3##4{% count is always zero
1337 \dopdfoutline{##1}{}{##3}{##4}}%
1339 % PDF outlines are displayed using system fonts, instead of
1340 % document fonts. Therefore we cannot use special characters,
1341 % since the encoding is unknown. For example, the eogonek from
1342 % Latin 2 (0xea) gets translated to a | character. Info from
1343 % Staszek Wawrykiewicz, 19 Jan 2004 04:09:24 +0100.
1345 % TODO this right, we have to translate 8-bit characters to
1346 % their "best" equivalent, based on the @documentencoding. Too
1347 % much work for too little return. Just use the ASCII equivalents
1348 % we use for the index sort strings.
1350 \indexnofonts
1351 \setupdatafile
1352 % We can have normal brace characters in the PDF outlines, unlike
1353 % Texinfo index files. So set that up.
1354 \def\{{\lbracecharliteral}%
1355 \def\}{\rbracecharliteral}%
1356 \catcode`\\=\active \otherbackslash
1357 \input \tocreadfilename
1358 \endgroup
1360 {\catcode`[=1 \catcode`]=2
1361 \catcode`{=\other \catcode`}=\other
1362 \gdef\lbracecharliteral[{]%
1363 \gdef\rbracecharliteral[}]%
1366 \def\skipspaces#1{\def\PP{#1}\def\D{|}%
1367 \ifx\PP\D\let\nextsp\relax
1368 \else\let\nextsp\skipspaces
1369 \addtokens{\filename}{\PP}%
1370 \advance\filenamelength by 1
1372 \nextsp}
1373 \def\getfilename#1{%
1374 \filenamelength=0
1375 % If we don't expand the argument now, \skipspaces will get
1376 % snagged on things like "@value{foo}".
1377 \edef\temp{#1}%
1378 \expandafter\skipspaces\temp|\relax
1380 \ifnum\pdftexversion < 14
1381 \let \startlink \pdfannotlink
1382 \else
1383 \let \startlink \pdfstartlink
1385 % make a live url in pdf output.
1386 \def\pdfurl#1{%
1387 \begingroup
1388 % it seems we really need yet another set of dummies; have not
1389 % tried to figure out what each command should do in the context
1390 % of @url. for now, just make @/ a no-op, that's the only one
1391 % people have actually reported a problem with.
1393 \normalturnoffactive
1394 \def\@{@}%
1395 \let\/=\empty
1396 \makevalueexpandable
1397 % do we want to go so far as to use \indexnofonts instead of just
1398 % special-casing \var here?
1399 \def\var##1{##1}%
1401 \leavevmode\setcolor{\urlcolor}%
1402 \startlink attr{/Border [0 0 0]}%
1403 user{/Subtype /Link /A << /S /URI /URI (#1) >>}%
1404 \endgroup}
1405 \def\pdfgettoks#1.{\setbox\boxA=\hbox{\toksA={#1.}\toksB={}\maketoks}}
1406 \def\addtokens#1#2{\edef\addtoks{\noexpand#1={\the#1#2}}\addtoks}
1407 \def\adn#1{\addtokens{\toksC}{#1}\global\countA=1\let\next=\maketoks}
1408 \def\poptoks#1#2|ENDTOKS|{\let\first=#1\toksD={#1}\toksA={#2}}
1409 \def\maketoks{%
1410 \expandafter\poptoks\the\toksA|ENDTOKS|\relax
1411 \ifx\first0\adn0
1412 \else\ifx\first1\adn1 \else\ifx\first2\adn2 \else\ifx\first3\adn3
1413 \else\ifx\first4\adn4 \else\ifx\first5\adn5 \else\ifx\first6\adn6
1414 \else\ifx\first7\adn7 \else\ifx\first8\adn8 \else\ifx\first9\adn9
1415 \else
1416 \ifnum0=\countA\else\makelink\fi
1417 \ifx\first.\let\next=\done\else
1418 \let\next=\maketoks
1419 \addtokens{\toksB}{\the\toksD}
1420 \ifx\first,\addtokens{\toksB}{\space}\fi
1422 \fi\fi\fi\fi\fi\fi\fi\fi\fi\fi
1423 \next}
1424 \def\makelink{\addtokens{\toksB}%
1425 {\noexpand\pdflink{\the\toksC}}\toksC={}\global\countA=0}
1426 \def\pdflink#1{%
1427 \startlink attr{/Border [0 0 0]} goto name{\pdfmkpgn{#1}}
1428 \setcolor{\linkcolor}#1\endlink}
1429 \def\done{\edef\st{\global\noexpand\toksA={\the\toksB}}\st}
1430 \else
1431 % non-pdf mode
1432 \let\pdfmkdest = \gobble
1433 \let\pdfurl = \gobble
1434 \let\endlink = \relax
1435 \let\setcolor = \gobble
1436 \let\pdfsetcolor = \gobble
1437 \let\pdfmakeoutlines = \relax
1438 \fi % \ifx\pdfoutput
1441 \message{fonts,}
1443 % Change the current font style to #1, remembering it in \curfontstyle.
1444 % For now, we do not accumulate font styles: @b{@i{foo}} prints foo in
1445 % italics, not bold italics.
1447 \def\setfontstyle#1{%
1448 \def\curfontstyle{#1}% not as a control sequence, because we are \edef'd.
1449 \csname ten#1\endcsname % change the current font
1452 % Select #1 fonts with the current style.
1454 \def\selectfonts#1{\csname #1fonts\endcsname \csname\curfontstyle\endcsname}
1456 \def\rm{\fam=0 \setfontstyle{rm}}
1457 \def\it{\fam=\itfam \setfontstyle{it}}
1458 \def\sl{\fam=\slfam \setfontstyle{sl}}
1459 \def\bf{\fam=\bffam \setfontstyle{bf}}\def\bfstylename{bf}
1460 \def\tt{\fam=\ttfam \setfontstyle{tt}}
1462 % Unfortunately, we have to override this for titles and the like, since
1463 % in those cases "rm" is bold. Sigh.
1464 \def\rmisbold{\rm\def\curfontstyle{bf}}
1466 % Texinfo sort of supports the sans serif font style, which plain TeX does not.
1467 % So we set up a \sf.
1468 \newfam\sffam
1469 \def\sf{\fam=\sffam \setfontstyle{sf}}
1470 \let\li = \sf % Sometimes we call it \li, not \sf.
1472 % We don't need math for this font style.
1473 \def\ttsl{\setfontstyle{ttsl}}
1476 % Set the baselineskip to #1, and the lineskip and strut size
1477 % correspondingly. There is no deep meaning behind these magic numbers
1478 % used as factors; they just match (closely enough) what Knuth defined.
1480 \def\lineskipfactor{.08333}
1481 \def\strutheightpercent{.70833}
1482 \def\strutdepthpercent {.29167}
1484 % can get a sort of poor man's double spacing by redefining this.
1485 \def\baselinefactor{1}
1487 \newdimen\textleading
1488 \def\setleading#1{%
1489 \dimen0 = #1\relax
1490 \normalbaselineskip = \baselinefactor\dimen0
1491 \normallineskip = \lineskipfactor\normalbaselineskip
1492 \normalbaselines
1493 \setbox\strutbox =\hbox{%
1494 \vrule width0pt height\strutheightpercent\baselineskip
1495 depth \strutdepthpercent \baselineskip
1499 % PDF CMaps. See also LaTeX's t1.cmap.
1501 % do nothing with this by default.
1502 \expandafter\let\csname cmapOT1\endcsname\gobble
1503 \expandafter\let\csname cmapOT1IT\endcsname\gobble
1504 \expandafter\let\csname cmapOT1TT\endcsname\gobble
1506 % if we are producing pdf, and we have \pdffontattr, then define cmaps.
1507 % (\pdffontattr was introduced many years ago, but people still run
1508 % older pdftex's; it's easy to conditionalize, so we do.)
1509 \ifpdf \ifx\pdffontattr\thisisundefined \else
1510 \begingroup
1511 \catcode`\^^M=\active \def^^M{^^J}% Output line endings as the ^^J char.
1512 \catcode`\%=12 \immediate\pdfobj stream {%!PS-Adobe-3.0 Resource-CMap
1513 %%DocumentNeededResources: ProcSet (CIDInit)
1514 %%IncludeResource: ProcSet (CIDInit)
1515 %%BeginResource: CMap (TeX-OT1-0)
1516 %%Title: (TeX-OT1-0 TeX OT1 0)
1517 %%Version: 1.000
1518 %%EndComments
1519 /CIDInit /ProcSet findresource begin
1520 12 dict begin
1521 begincmap
1522 /CIDSystemInfo
1523 << /Registry (TeX)
1524 /Ordering (OT1)
1525 /Supplement 0
1526 >> def
1527 /CMapName /TeX-OT1-0 def
1528 /CMapType 2 def
1529 1 begincodespacerange
1530 <00> <7F>
1531 endcodespacerange
1532 8 beginbfrange
1533 <00> <01> <0393>
1534 <09> <0A> <03A8>
1535 <23> <26> <0023>
1536 <28> <3B> <0028>
1537 <3F> <5B> <003F>
1538 <5D> <5E> <005D>
1539 <61> <7A> <0061>
1540 <7B> <7C> <2013>
1541 endbfrange
1542 40 beginbfchar
1543 <02> <0398>
1544 <03> <039B>
1545 <04> <039E>
1546 <05> <03A0>
1547 <06> <03A3>
1548 <07> <03D2>
1549 <08> <03A6>
1550 <0B> <00660066>
1551 <0C> <00660069>
1552 <0D> <0066006C>
1553 <0E> <006600660069>
1554 <0F> <00660066006C>
1555 <10> <0131>
1556 <11> <0237>
1557 <12> <0060>
1558 <13> <00B4>
1559 <14> <02C7>
1560 <15> <02D8>
1561 <16> <00AF>
1562 <17> <02DA>
1563 <18> <00B8>
1564 <19> <00DF>
1565 <1A> <00E6>
1566 <1B> <0153>
1567 <1C> <00F8>
1568 <1D> <00C6>
1569 <1E> <0152>
1570 <1F> <00D8>
1571 <21> <0021>
1572 <22> <201D>
1573 <27> <2019>
1574 <3C> <00A1>
1575 <3D> <003D>
1576 <3E> <00BF>
1577 <5C> <201C>
1578 <5F> <02D9>
1579 <60> <2018>
1580 <7D> <02DD>
1581 <7E> <007E>
1582 <7F> <00A8>
1583 endbfchar
1584 endcmap
1585 CMapName currentdict /CMap defineresource pop
1588 %%EndResource
1589 %%EOF
1590 }\endgroup
1591 \expandafter\edef\csname cmapOT1\endcsname#1{%
1592 \pdffontattr#1{/ToUnicode \the\pdflastobj\space 0 R}%
1595 % \cmapOT1IT
1596 \begingroup
1597 \catcode`\^^M=\active \def^^M{^^J}% Output line endings as the ^^J char.
1598 \catcode`\%=12 \immediate\pdfobj stream {%!PS-Adobe-3.0 Resource-CMap
1599 %%DocumentNeededResources: ProcSet (CIDInit)
1600 %%IncludeResource: ProcSet (CIDInit)
1601 %%BeginResource: CMap (TeX-OT1IT-0)
1602 %%Title: (TeX-OT1IT-0 TeX OT1IT 0)
1603 %%Version: 1.000
1604 %%EndComments
1605 /CIDInit /ProcSet findresource begin
1606 12 dict begin
1607 begincmap
1608 /CIDSystemInfo
1609 << /Registry (TeX)
1610 /Ordering (OT1IT)
1611 /Supplement 0
1612 >> def
1613 /CMapName /TeX-OT1IT-0 def
1614 /CMapType 2 def
1615 1 begincodespacerange
1616 <00> <7F>
1617 endcodespacerange
1618 8 beginbfrange
1619 <00> <01> <0393>
1620 <09> <0A> <03A8>
1621 <25> <26> <0025>
1622 <28> <3B> <0028>
1623 <3F> <5B> <003F>
1624 <5D> <5E> <005D>
1625 <61> <7A> <0061>
1626 <7B> <7C> <2013>
1627 endbfrange
1628 42 beginbfchar
1629 <02> <0398>
1630 <03> <039B>
1631 <04> <039E>
1632 <05> <03A0>
1633 <06> <03A3>
1634 <07> <03D2>
1635 <08> <03A6>
1636 <0B> <00660066>
1637 <0C> <00660069>
1638 <0D> <0066006C>
1639 <0E> <006600660069>
1640 <0F> <00660066006C>
1641 <10> <0131>
1642 <11> <0237>
1643 <12> <0060>
1644 <13> <00B4>
1645 <14> <02C7>
1646 <15> <02D8>
1647 <16> <00AF>
1648 <17> <02DA>
1649 <18> <00B8>
1650 <19> <00DF>
1651 <1A> <00E6>
1652 <1B> <0153>
1653 <1C> <00F8>
1654 <1D> <00C6>
1655 <1E> <0152>
1656 <1F> <00D8>
1657 <21> <0021>
1658 <22> <201D>
1659 <23> <0023>
1660 <24> <00A3>
1661 <27> <2019>
1662 <3C> <00A1>
1663 <3D> <003D>
1664 <3E> <00BF>
1665 <5C> <201C>
1666 <5F> <02D9>
1667 <60> <2018>
1668 <7D> <02DD>
1669 <7E> <007E>
1670 <7F> <00A8>
1671 endbfchar
1672 endcmap
1673 CMapName currentdict /CMap defineresource pop
1676 %%EndResource
1677 %%EOF
1678 }\endgroup
1679 \expandafter\edef\csname cmapOT1IT\endcsname#1{%
1680 \pdffontattr#1{/ToUnicode \the\pdflastobj\space 0 R}%
1683 % \cmapOT1TT
1684 \begingroup
1685 \catcode`\^^M=\active \def^^M{^^J}% Output line endings as the ^^J char.
1686 \catcode`\%=12 \immediate\pdfobj stream {%!PS-Adobe-3.0 Resource-CMap
1687 %%DocumentNeededResources: ProcSet (CIDInit)
1688 %%IncludeResource: ProcSet (CIDInit)
1689 %%BeginResource: CMap (TeX-OT1TT-0)
1690 %%Title: (TeX-OT1TT-0 TeX OT1TT 0)
1691 %%Version: 1.000
1692 %%EndComments
1693 /CIDInit /ProcSet findresource begin
1694 12 dict begin
1695 begincmap
1696 /CIDSystemInfo
1697 << /Registry (TeX)
1698 /Ordering (OT1TT)
1699 /Supplement 0
1700 >> def
1701 /CMapName /TeX-OT1TT-0 def
1702 /CMapType 2 def
1703 1 begincodespacerange
1704 <00> <7F>
1705 endcodespacerange
1706 5 beginbfrange
1707 <00> <01> <0393>
1708 <09> <0A> <03A8>
1709 <21> <26> <0021>
1710 <28> <5F> <0028>
1711 <61> <7E> <0061>
1712 endbfrange
1713 32 beginbfchar
1714 <02> <0398>
1715 <03> <039B>
1716 <04> <039E>
1717 <05> <03A0>
1718 <06> <03A3>
1719 <07> <03D2>
1720 <08> <03A6>
1721 <0B> <2191>
1722 <0C> <2193>
1723 <0D> <0027>
1724 <0E> <00A1>
1725 <0F> <00BF>
1726 <10> <0131>
1727 <11> <0237>
1728 <12> <0060>
1729 <13> <00B4>
1730 <14> <02C7>
1731 <15> <02D8>
1732 <16> <00AF>
1733 <17> <02DA>
1734 <18> <00B8>
1735 <19> <00DF>
1736 <1A> <00E6>
1737 <1B> <0153>
1738 <1C> <00F8>
1739 <1D> <00C6>
1740 <1E> <0152>
1741 <1F> <00D8>
1742 <20> <2423>
1743 <27> <2019>
1744 <60> <2018>
1745 <7F> <00A8>
1746 endbfchar
1747 endcmap
1748 CMapName currentdict /CMap defineresource pop
1751 %%EndResource
1752 %%EOF
1753 }\endgroup
1754 \expandafter\edef\csname cmapOT1TT\endcsname#1{%
1755 \pdffontattr#1{/ToUnicode \the\pdflastobj\space 0 R}%
1757 \fi\fi
1760 % Set the font macro #1 to the font named \fontprefix#2.
1761 % #3 is the font's design size, #4 is a scale factor, #5 is the CMap
1762 % encoding (only OT1, OT1IT and OT1TT are allowed, or empty to omit).
1763 % Example:
1764 % #1 = \textrm
1765 % #2 = \rmshape
1766 % #3 = 10
1767 % #4 = \mainmagstep
1768 % #5 = OT1
1770 \def\setfont#1#2#3#4#5{%
1771 \font#1=\fontprefix#2#3 scaled #4
1772 \csname cmap#5\endcsname#1%
1774 % This is what gets called when #5 of \setfont is empty.
1775 \let\cmap\gobble
1777 % (end of cmaps)
1779 % Use cm as the default font prefix.
1780 % To specify the font prefix, you must define \fontprefix
1781 % before you read in texinfo.tex.
1782 \ifx\fontprefix\thisisundefined
1783 \def\fontprefix{cm}
1785 % Support font families that don't use the same naming scheme as CM.
1786 \def\rmshape{r}
1787 \def\rmbshape{bx} % where the normal face is bold
1788 \def\bfshape{b}
1789 \def\bxshape{bx}
1790 \def\ttshape{tt}
1791 \def\ttbshape{tt}
1792 \def\ttslshape{sltt}
1793 \def\itshape{ti}
1794 \def\itbshape{bxti}
1795 \def\slshape{sl}
1796 \def\slbshape{bxsl}
1797 \def\sfshape{ss}
1798 \def\sfbshape{ss}
1799 \def\scshape{csc}
1800 \def\scbshape{csc}
1802 % Definitions for a main text size of 11pt. (The default in Texinfo.)
1804 \def\definetextfontsizexi{%
1805 % Text fonts (11.2pt, magstep1).
1806 \def\textnominalsize{11pt}
1807 \edef\mainmagstep{\magstephalf}
1808 \setfont\textrm\rmshape{10}{\mainmagstep}{OT1}
1809 \setfont\texttt\ttshape{10}{\mainmagstep}{OT1TT}
1810 \setfont\textbf\bfshape{10}{\mainmagstep}{OT1}
1811 \setfont\textit\itshape{10}{\mainmagstep}{OT1IT}
1812 \setfont\textsl\slshape{10}{\mainmagstep}{OT1}
1813 \setfont\textsf\sfshape{10}{\mainmagstep}{OT1}
1814 \setfont\textsc\scshape{10}{\mainmagstep}{OT1}
1815 \setfont\textttsl\ttslshape{10}{\mainmagstep}{OT1TT}
1816 \font\texti=cmmi10 scaled \mainmagstep
1817 \font\textsy=cmsy10 scaled \mainmagstep
1818 \def\textecsize{1095}
1820 % A few fonts for @defun names and args.
1821 \setfont\defbf\bfshape{10}{\magstep1}{OT1}
1822 \setfont\deftt\ttshape{10}{\magstep1}{OT1TT}
1823 \setfont\defttsl\ttslshape{10}{\magstep1}{OT1TT}
1824 \def\df{\let\tentt=\deftt \let\tenbf = \defbf \let\tenttsl=\defttsl \bf}
1826 % Fonts for indices, footnotes, small examples (9pt).
1827 \def\smallnominalsize{9pt}
1828 \setfont\smallrm\rmshape{9}{1000}{OT1}
1829 \setfont\smalltt\ttshape{9}{1000}{OT1TT}
1830 \setfont\smallbf\bfshape{10}{900}{OT1}
1831 \setfont\smallit\itshape{9}{1000}{OT1IT}
1832 \setfont\smallsl\slshape{9}{1000}{OT1}
1833 \setfont\smallsf\sfshape{9}{1000}{OT1}
1834 \setfont\smallsc\scshape{10}{900}{OT1}
1835 \setfont\smallttsl\ttslshape{10}{900}{OT1TT}
1836 \font\smalli=cmmi9
1837 \font\smallsy=cmsy9
1838 \def\smallecsize{0900}
1840 % Fonts for small examples (8pt).
1841 \def\smallernominalsize{8pt}
1842 \setfont\smallerrm\rmshape{8}{1000}{OT1}
1843 \setfont\smallertt\ttshape{8}{1000}{OT1TT}
1844 \setfont\smallerbf\bfshape{10}{800}{OT1}
1845 \setfont\smallerit\itshape{8}{1000}{OT1IT}
1846 \setfont\smallersl\slshape{8}{1000}{OT1}
1847 \setfont\smallersf\sfshape{8}{1000}{OT1}
1848 \setfont\smallersc\scshape{10}{800}{OT1}
1849 \setfont\smallerttsl\ttslshape{10}{800}{OT1TT}
1850 \font\smalleri=cmmi8
1851 \font\smallersy=cmsy8
1852 \def\smallerecsize{0800}
1854 % Fonts for title page (20.4pt):
1855 \def\titlenominalsize{20pt}
1856 \setfont\titlerm\rmbshape{12}{\magstep3}{OT1}
1857 \setfont\titleit\itbshape{10}{\magstep4}{OT1IT}
1858 \setfont\titlesl\slbshape{10}{\magstep4}{OT1}
1859 \setfont\titlett\ttbshape{12}{\magstep3}{OT1TT}
1860 \setfont\titlettsl\ttslshape{10}{\magstep4}{OT1TT}
1861 \setfont\titlesf\sfbshape{17}{\magstep1}{OT1}
1862 \let\titlebf=\titlerm
1863 \setfont\titlesc\scbshape{10}{\magstep4}{OT1}
1864 \font\titlei=cmmi12 scaled \magstep3
1865 \font\titlesy=cmsy10 scaled \magstep4
1866 \def\titleecsize{2074}
1868 % Chapter (and unnumbered) fonts (17.28pt).
1869 \def\chapnominalsize{17pt}
1870 \setfont\chaprm\rmbshape{12}{\magstep2}{OT1}
1871 \setfont\chapit\itbshape{10}{\magstep3}{OT1IT}
1872 \setfont\chapsl\slbshape{10}{\magstep3}{OT1}
1873 \setfont\chaptt\ttbshape{12}{\magstep2}{OT1TT}
1874 \setfont\chapttsl\ttslshape{10}{\magstep3}{OT1TT}
1875 \setfont\chapsf\sfbshape{17}{1000}{OT1}
1876 \let\chapbf=\chaprm
1877 \setfont\chapsc\scbshape{10}{\magstep3}{OT1}
1878 \font\chapi=cmmi12 scaled \magstep2
1879 \font\chapsy=cmsy10 scaled \magstep3
1880 \def\chapecsize{1728}
1882 % Section fonts (14.4pt).
1883 \def\secnominalsize{14pt}
1884 \setfont\secrm\rmbshape{12}{\magstep1}{OT1}
1885 \setfont\secit\itbshape{10}{\magstep2}{OT1IT}
1886 \setfont\secsl\slbshape{10}{\magstep2}{OT1}
1887 \setfont\sectt\ttbshape{12}{\magstep1}{OT1TT}
1888 \setfont\secttsl\ttslshape{10}{\magstep2}{OT1TT}
1889 \setfont\secsf\sfbshape{12}{\magstep1}{OT1}
1890 \let\secbf\secrm
1891 \setfont\secsc\scbshape{10}{\magstep2}{OT1}
1892 \font\seci=cmmi12 scaled \magstep1
1893 \font\secsy=cmsy10 scaled \magstep2
1894 \def\sececsize{1440}
1896 % Subsection fonts (13.15pt).
1897 \def\ssecnominalsize{13pt}
1898 \setfont\ssecrm\rmbshape{12}{\magstephalf}{OT1}
1899 \setfont\ssecit\itbshape{10}{1315}{OT1IT}
1900 \setfont\ssecsl\slbshape{10}{1315}{OT1}
1901 \setfont\ssectt\ttbshape{12}{\magstephalf}{OT1TT}
1902 \setfont\ssecttsl\ttslshape{10}{1315}{OT1TT}
1903 \setfont\ssecsf\sfbshape{12}{\magstephalf}{OT1}
1904 \let\ssecbf\ssecrm
1905 \setfont\ssecsc\scbshape{10}{1315}{OT1}
1906 \font\sseci=cmmi12 scaled \magstephalf
1907 \font\ssecsy=cmsy10 scaled 1315
1908 \def\ssececsize{1200}
1910 % Reduced fonts for @acro in text (10pt).
1911 \def\reducednominalsize{10pt}
1912 \setfont\reducedrm\rmshape{10}{1000}{OT1}
1913 \setfont\reducedtt\ttshape{10}{1000}{OT1TT}
1914 \setfont\reducedbf\bfshape{10}{1000}{OT1}
1915 \setfont\reducedit\itshape{10}{1000}{OT1IT}
1916 \setfont\reducedsl\slshape{10}{1000}{OT1}
1917 \setfont\reducedsf\sfshape{10}{1000}{OT1}
1918 \setfont\reducedsc\scshape{10}{1000}{OT1}
1919 \setfont\reducedttsl\ttslshape{10}{1000}{OT1TT}
1920 \font\reducedi=cmmi10
1921 \font\reducedsy=cmsy10
1922 \def\reducedecsize{1000}
1924 \textleading = 13.2pt % line spacing for 11pt CM
1925 \textfonts % reset the current fonts
1927 } % end of 11pt text font size definitions, \definetextfontsizexi
1930 % Definitions to make the main text be 10pt Computer Modern, with
1931 % section, chapter, etc., sizes following suit. This is for the GNU
1932 % Press printing of the Emacs 22 manual. Maybe other manuals in the
1933 % future. Used with @smallbook, which sets the leading to 12pt.
1935 \def\definetextfontsizex{%
1936 % Text fonts (10pt).
1937 \def\textnominalsize{10pt}
1938 \edef\mainmagstep{1000}
1939 \setfont\textrm\rmshape{10}{\mainmagstep}{OT1}
1940 \setfont\texttt\ttshape{10}{\mainmagstep}{OT1TT}
1941 \setfont\textbf\bfshape{10}{\mainmagstep}{OT1}
1942 \setfont\textit\itshape{10}{\mainmagstep}{OT1IT}
1943 \setfont\textsl\slshape{10}{\mainmagstep}{OT1}
1944 \setfont\textsf\sfshape{10}{\mainmagstep}{OT1}
1945 \setfont\textsc\scshape{10}{\mainmagstep}{OT1}
1946 \setfont\textttsl\ttslshape{10}{\mainmagstep}{OT1TT}
1947 \font\texti=cmmi10 scaled \mainmagstep
1948 \font\textsy=cmsy10 scaled \mainmagstep
1949 \def\textecsize{1000}
1951 % A few fonts for @defun names and args.
1952 \setfont\defbf\bfshape{10}{\magstephalf}{OT1}
1953 \setfont\deftt\ttshape{10}{\magstephalf}{OT1TT}
1954 \setfont\defttsl\ttslshape{10}{\magstephalf}{OT1TT}
1955 \def\df{\let\tentt=\deftt \let\tenbf = \defbf \let\tenttsl=\defttsl \bf}
1957 % Fonts for indices, footnotes, small examples (9pt).
1958 \def\smallnominalsize{9pt}
1959 \setfont\smallrm\rmshape{9}{1000}{OT1}
1960 \setfont\smalltt\ttshape{9}{1000}{OT1TT}
1961 \setfont\smallbf\bfshape{10}{900}{OT1}
1962 \setfont\smallit\itshape{9}{1000}{OT1IT}
1963 \setfont\smallsl\slshape{9}{1000}{OT1}
1964 \setfont\smallsf\sfshape{9}{1000}{OT1}
1965 \setfont\smallsc\scshape{10}{900}{OT1}
1966 \setfont\smallttsl\ttslshape{10}{900}{OT1TT}
1967 \font\smalli=cmmi9
1968 \font\smallsy=cmsy9
1969 \def\smallecsize{0900}
1971 % Fonts for small examples (8pt).
1972 \def\smallernominalsize{8pt}
1973 \setfont\smallerrm\rmshape{8}{1000}{OT1}
1974 \setfont\smallertt\ttshape{8}{1000}{OT1TT}
1975 \setfont\smallerbf\bfshape{10}{800}{OT1}
1976 \setfont\smallerit\itshape{8}{1000}{OT1IT}
1977 \setfont\smallersl\slshape{8}{1000}{OT1}
1978 \setfont\smallersf\sfshape{8}{1000}{OT1}
1979 \setfont\smallersc\scshape{10}{800}{OT1}
1980 \setfont\smallerttsl\ttslshape{10}{800}{OT1TT}
1981 \font\smalleri=cmmi8
1982 \font\smallersy=cmsy8
1983 \def\smallerecsize{0800}
1985 % Fonts for title page (20.4pt):
1986 \def\titlenominalsize{20pt}
1987 \setfont\titlerm\rmbshape{12}{\magstep3}{OT1}
1988 \setfont\titleit\itbshape{10}{\magstep4}{OT1IT}
1989 \setfont\titlesl\slbshape{10}{\magstep4}{OT1}
1990 \setfont\titlett\ttbshape{12}{\magstep3}{OT1TT}
1991 \setfont\titlettsl\ttslshape{10}{\magstep4}{OT1TT}
1992 \setfont\titlesf\sfbshape{17}{\magstep1}{OT1}
1993 \let\titlebf=\titlerm
1994 \setfont\titlesc\scbshape{10}{\magstep4}{OT1}
1995 \font\titlei=cmmi12 scaled \magstep3
1996 \font\titlesy=cmsy10 scaled \magstep4
1997 \def\titleecsize{2074}
1999 % Chapter fonts (14.4pt).
2000 \def\chapnominalsize{14pt}
2001 \setfont\chaprm\rmbshape{12}{\magstep1}{OT1}
2002 \setfont\chapit\itbshape{10}{\magstep2}{OT1IT}
2003 \setfont\chapsl\slbshape{10}{\magstep2}{OT1}
2004 \setfont\chaptt\ttbshape{12}{\magstep1}{OT1TT}
2005 \setfont\chapttsl\ttslshape{10}{\magstep2}{OT1TT}
2006 \setfont\chapsf\sfbshape{12}{\magstep1}{OT1}
2007 \let\chapbf\chaprm
2008 \setfont\chapsc\scbshape{10}{\magstep2}{OT1}
2009 \font\chapi=cmmi12 scaled \magstep1
2010 \font\chapsy=cmsy10 scaled \magstep2
2011 \def\chapecsize{1440}
2013 % Section fonts (12pt).
2014 \def\secnominalsize{12pt}
2015 \setfont\secrm\rmbshape{12}{1000}{OT1}
2016 \setfont\secit\itbshape{10}{\magstep1}{OT1IT}
2017 \setfont\secsl\slbshape{10}{\magstep1}{OT1}
2018 \setfont\sectt\ttbshape{12}{1000}{OT1TT}
2019 \setfont\secttsl\ttslshape{10}{\magstep1}{OT1TT}
2020 \setfont\secsf\sfbshape{12}{1000}{OT1}
2021 \let\secbf\secrm
2022 \setfont\secsc\scbshape{10}{\magstep1}{OT1}
2023 \font\seci=cmmi12
2024 \font\secsy=cmsy10 scaled \magstep1
2025 \def\sececsize{1200}
2027 % Subsection fonts (10pt).
2028 \def\ssecnominalsize{10pt}
2029 \setfont\ssecrm\rmbshape{10}{1000}{OT1}
2030 \setfont\ssecit\itbshape{10}{1000}{OT1IT}
2031 \setfont\ssecsl\slbshape{10}{1000}{OT1}
2032 \setfont\ssectt\ttbshape{10}{1000}{OT1TT}
2033 \setfont\ssecttsl\ttslshape{10}{1000}{OT1TT}
2034 \setfont\ssecsf\sfbshape{10}{1000}{OT1}
2035 \let\ssecbf\ssecrm
2036 \setfont\ssecsc\scbshape{10}{1000}{OT1}
2037 \font\sseci=cmmi10
2038 \font\ssecsy=cmsy10
2039 \def\ssececsize{1000}
2041 % Reduced fonts for @acro in text (9pt).
2042 \def\reducednominalsize{9pt}
2043 \setfont\reducedrm\rmshape{9}{1000}{OT1}
2044 \setfont\reducedtt\ttshape{9}{1000}{OT1TT}
2045 \setfont\reducedbf\bfshape{10}{900}{OT1}
2046 \setfont\reducedit\itshape{9}{1000}{OT1IT}
2047 \setfont\reducedsl\slshape{9}{1000}{OT1}
2048 \setfont\reducedsf\sfshape{9}{1000}{OT1}
2049 \setfont\reducedsc\scshape{10}{900}{OT1}
2050 \setfont\reducedttsl\ttslshape{10}{900}{OT1TT}
2051 \font\reducedi=cmmi9
2052 \font\reducedsy=cmsy9
2053 \def\reducedecsize{0900}
2055 \divide\parskip by 2 % reduce space between paragraphs
2056 \textleading = 12pt % line spacing for 10pt CM
2057 \textfonts % reset the current fonts
2059 } % end of 10pt text font size definitions, \definetextfontsizex
2062 % We provide the user-level command
2063 % @fonttextsize 10
2064 % (or 11) to redefine the text font size. pt is assumed.
2066 \def\xiword{11}
2067 \def\xword{10}
2068 \def\xwordpt{10pt}
2070 \parseargdef\fonttextsize{%
2071 \def\textsizearg{#1}%
2072 %\wlog{doing @fonttextsize \textsizearg}%
2074 % Set \globaldefs so that documents can use this inside @tex, since
2075 % makeinfo 4.8 does not support it, but we need it nonetheless.
2077 \begingroup \globaldefs=1
2078 \ifx\textsizearg\xword \definetextfontsizex
2079 \else \ifx\textsizearg\xiword \definetextfontsizexi
2080 \else
2081 \errhelp=\EMsimple
2082 \errmessage{@fonttextsize only supports `10' or `11', not `\textsizearg'}
2083 \fi\fi
2084 \endgroup
2087 % In order for the font changes to affect most math symbols and letters,
2088 % we have to define the \textfont of the standard families. We don't
2089 % bother to reset \scriptfont and \scriptscriptfont; awaiting user need.
2091 \def\resetmathfonts{%
2092 \textfont0=\tenrm \textfont1=\teni \textfont2=\tensy
2093 \textfont\itfam=\tenit \textfont\slfam=\tensl \textfont\bffam=\tenbf
2094 \textfont\ttfam=\tentt \textfont\sffam=\tensf
2097 % The font-changing commands redefine the meanings of \tenSTYLE, instead
2098 % of just \STYLE. We do this because \STYLE needs to also set the
2099 % current \fam for math mode. Our \STYLE (e.g., \rm) commands hardwire
2100 % \tenSTYLE to set the current font.
2102 % Each font-changing command also sets the names \lsize (one size lower)
2103 % and \lllsize (three sizes lower). These relative commands are used
2104 % in, e.g., the LaTeX logo and acronyms.
2106 % This all needs generalizing, badly.
2108 \def\textfonts{%
2109 \let\tenrm=\textrm \let\tenit=\textit \let\tensl=\textsl
2110 \let\tenbf=\textbf \let\tentt=\texttt \let\smallcaps=\textsc
2111 \let\tensf=\textsf \let\teni=\texti \let\tensy=\textsy
2112 \let\tenttsl=\textttsl
2113 \def\curfontsize{text}%
2114 \def\lsize{reduced}\def\lllsize{smaller}%
2115 \resetmathfonts \setleading{\textleading}}
2116 \def\titlefonts{%
2117 \let\tenrm=\titlerm \let\tenit=\titleit \let\tensl=\titlesl
2118 \let\tenbf=\titlebf \let\tentt=\titlett \let\smallcaps=\titlesc
2119 \let\tensf=\titlesf \let\teni=\titlei \let\tensy=\titlesy
2120 \let\tenttsl=\titlettsl
2121 \def\curfontsize{title}%
2122 \def\lsize{chap}\def\lllsize{subsec}%
2123 \resetmathfonts \setleading{27pt}}
2124 \def\titlefont#1{{\titlefonts\rmisbold #1}}
2125 \def\chapfonts{%
2126 \let\tenrm=\chaprm \let\tenit=\chapit \let\tensl=\chapsl
2127 \let\tenbf=\chapbf \let\tentt=\chaptt \let\smallcaps=\chapsc
2128 \let\tensf=\chapsf \let\teni=\chapi \let\tensy=\chapsy
2129 \let\tenttsl=\chapttsl
2130 \def\curfontsize{chap}%
2131 \def\lsize{sec}\def\lllsize{text}%
2132 \resetmathfonts \setleading{19pt}}
2133 \def\secfonts{%
2134 \let\tenrm=\secrm \let\tenit=\secit \let\tensl=\secsl
2135 \let\tenbf=\secbf \let\tentt=\sectt \let\smallcaps=\secsc
2136 \let\tensf=\secsf \let\teni=\seci \let\tensy=\secsy
2137 \let\tenttsl=\secttsl
2138 \def\curfontsize{sec}%
2139 \def\lsize{subsec}\def\lllsize{reduced}%
2140 \resetmathfonts \setleading{17pt}}
2141 \def\subsecfonts{%
2142 \let\tenrm=\ssecrm \let\tenit=\ssecit \let\tensl=\ssecsl
2143 \let\tenbf=\ssecbf \let\tentt=\ssectt \let\smallcaps=\ssecsc
2144 \let\tensf=\ssecsf \let\teni=\sseci \let\tensy=\ssecsy
2145 \let\tenttsl=\ssecttsl
2146 \def\curfontsize{ssec}%
2147 \def\lsize{text}\def\lllsize{small}%
2148 \resetmathfonts \setleading{15pt}}
2149 \let\subsubsecfonts = \subsecfonts
2150 \def\reducedfonts{%
2151 \let\tenrm=\reducedrm \let\tenit=\reducedit \let\tensl=\reducedsl
2152 \let\tenbf=\reducedbf \let\tentt=\reducedtt \let\reducedcaps=\reducedsc
2153 \let\tensf=\reducedsf \let\teni=\reducedi \let\tensy=\reducedsy
2154 \let\tenttsl=\reducedttsl
2155 \def\curfontsize{reduced}%
2156 \def\lsize{small}\def\lllsize{smaller}%
2157 \resetmathfonts \setleading{10.5pt}}
2158 \def\smallfonts{%
2159 \let\tenrm=\smallrm \let\tenit=\smallit \let\tensl=\smallsl
2160 \let\tenbf=\smallbf \let\tentt=\smalltt \let\smallcaps=\smallsc
2161 \let\tensf=\smallsf \let\teni=\smalli \let\tensy=\smallsy
2162 \let\tenttsl=\smallttsl
2163 \def\curfontsize{small}%
2164 \def\lsize{smaller}\def\lllsize{smaller}%
2165 \resetmathfonts \setleading{10.5pt}}
2166 \def\smallerfonts{%
2167 \let\tenrm=\smallerrm \let\tenit=\smallerit \let\tensl=\smallersl
2168 \let\tenbf=\smallerbf \let\tentt=\smallertt \let\smallcaps=\smallersc
2169 \let\tensf=\smallersf \let\teni=\smalleri \let\tensy=\smallersy
2170 \let\tenttsl=\smallerttsl
2171 \def\curfontsize{smaller}%
2172 \def\lsize{smaller}\def\lllsize{smaller}%
2173 \resetmathfonts \setleading{9.5pt}}
2175 % Fonts for short table of contents.
2176 \setfont\shortcontrm\rmshape{12}{1000}{OT1}
2177 \setfont\shortcontbf\bfshape{10}{\magstep1}{OT1} % no cmb12
2178 \setfont\shortcontsl\slshape{12}{1000}{OT1}
2179 \setfont\shortconttt\ttshape{12}{1000}{OT1TT}
2181 % Define these just so they can be easily changed for other fonts.
2182 \def\angleleft{$\langle$}
2183 \def\angleright{$\rangle$}
2185 % Set the fonts to use with the @small... environments.
2186 \let\smallexamplefonts = \smallfonts
2188 % About \smallexamplefonts. If we use \smallfonts (9pt), @smallexample
2189 % can fit this many characters:
2190 % 8.5x11=86 smallbook=72 a4=90 a5=69
2191 % If we use \scriptfonts (8pt), then we can fit this many characters:
2192 % 8.5x11=90+ smallbook=80 a4=90+ a5=77
2193 % For me, subjectively, the few extra characters that fit aren't worth
2194 % the additional smallness of 8pt. So I'm making the default 9pt.
2196 % By the way, for comparison, here's what fits with @example (10pt):
2197 % 8.5x11=71 smallbook=60 a4=75 a5=58
2198 % --karl, 24jan03.
2200 % Set up the default fonts, so we can use them for creating boxes.
2202 \definetextfontsizexi
2205 \message{markup,}
2207 % Check if we are currently using a typewriter font. Since all the
2208 % Computer Modern typewriter fonts have zero interword stretch (and
2209 % shrink), and it is reasonable to expect all typewriter fonts to have
2210 % this property, we can check that font parameter.
2212 \def\ifmonospace{\ifdim\fontdimen3\font=0pt }
2214 % Markup style infrastructure. \defmarkupstylesetup\INITMACRO will
2215 % define and register \INITMACRO to be called on markup style changes.
2216 % \INITMACRO can check \currentmarkupstyle for the innermost
2217 % style and the set of \ifmarkupSTYLE switches for all styles
2218 % currently in effect.
2219 \newif\ifmarkupvar
2220 \newif\ifmarkupsamp
2221 \newif\ifmarkupkey
2222 %\newif\ifmarkupfile % @file == @samp.
2223 %\newif\ifmarkupoption % @option == @samp.
2224 \newif\ifmarkupcode
2225 \newif\ifmarkupkbd
2226 %\newif\ifmarkupenv % @env == @code.
2227 %\newif\ifmarkupcommand % @command == @code.
2228 \newif\ifmarkuptex % @tex (and part of @math, for now).
2229 \newif\ifmarkupexample
2230 \newif\ifmarkupverb
2231 \newif\ifmarkupverbatim
2233 \let\currentmarkupstyle\empty
2235 \def\setupmarkupstyle#1{%
2236 \csname markup#1true\endcsname
2237 \def\currentmarkupstyle{#1}%
2238 \markupstylesetup
2241 \let\markupstylesetup\empty
2243 \def\defmarkupstylesetup#1{%
2244 \expandafter\def\expandafter\markupstylesetup
2245 \expandafter{\markupstylesetup #1}%
2246 \def#1%
2249 % Markup style setup for left and right quotes.
2250 \defmarkupstylesetup\markupsetuplq{%
2251 \expandafter\let\expandafter \temp
2252 \csname markupsetuplq\currentmarkupstyle\endcsname
2253 \ifx\temp\relax \markupsetuplqdefault \else \temp \fi
2256 \defmarkupstylesetup\markupsetuprq{%
2257 \expandafter\let\expandafter \temp
2258 \csname markupsetuprq\currentmarkupstyle\endcsname
2259 \ifx\temp\relax \markupsetuprqdefault \else \temp \fi
2263 \catcode`\'=\active
2264 \catcode`\`=\active
2266 \gdef\markupsetuplqdefault{\let`\lq}
2267 \gdef\markupsetuprqdefault{\let'\rq}
2269 \gdef\markupsetcodequoteleft{\let`\codequoteleft}
2270 \gdef\markupsetcodequoteright{\let'\codequoteright}
2273 \let\markupsetuplqcode \markupsetcodequoteleft
2274 \let\markupsetuprqcode \markupsetcodequoteright
2276 \let\markupsetuplqexample \markupsetcodequoteleft
2277 \let\markupsetuprqexample \markupsetcodequoteright
2279 \let\markupsetuplqkbd \markupsetcodequoteleft
2280 \let\markupsetuprqkbd \markupsetcodequoteright
2282 \let\markupsetuplqsamp \markupsetcodequoteleft
2283 \let\markupsetuprqsamp \markupsetcodequoteright
2285 \let\markupsetuplqverb \markupsetcodequoteleft
2286 \let\markupsetuprqverb \markupsetcodequoteright
2288 \let\markupsetuplqverbatim \markupsetcodequoteleft
2289 \let\markupsetuprqverbatim \markupsetcodequoteright
2291 % Allow an option to not use regular directed right quote/apostrophe
2292 % (char 0x27), but instead the undirected quote from cmtt (char 0x0d).
2293 % The undirected quote is ugly, so don't make it the default, but it
2294 % works for pasting with more pdf viewers (at least evince), the
2295 % lilypond developers report. xpdf does work with the regular 0x27.
2297 \def\codequoteright{%
2298 \expandafter\ifx\csname SETtxicodequoteundirected\endcsname\relax
2299 \expandafter\ifx\csname SETcodequoteundirected\endcsname\relax
2301 \else \char'15 \fi
2302 \else \char'15 \fi
2305 % and a similar option for the left quote char vs. a grave accent.
2306 % Modern fonts display ASCII 0x60 as a grave accent, so some people like
2307 % the code environments to do likewise.
2309 \def\codequoteleft{%
2310 \expandafter\ifx\csname SETtxicodequotebacktick\endcsname\relax
2311 \expandafter\ifx\csname SETcodequotebacktick\endcsname\relax
2312 % [Knuth] pp. 380,381,391
2313 % \relax disables Spanish ligatures ?` and !` of \tt font.
2314 \relax`%
2315 \else \char'22 \fi
2316 \else \char'22 \fi
2319 % Commands to set the quote options.
2321 \parseargdef\codequoteundirected{%
2322 \def\temp{#1}%
2323 \ifx\temp\onword
2324 \expandafter\let\csname SETtxicodequoteundirected\endcsname
2325 = t%
2326 \else\ifx\temp\offword
2327 \expandafter\let\csname SETtxicodequoteundirected\endcsname
2328 = \relax
2329 \else
2330 \errhelp = \EMsimple
2331 \errmessage{Unknown @codequoteundirected value `\temp', must be on|off}%
2332 \fi\fi
2335 \parseargdef\codequotebacktick{%
2336 \def\temp{#1}%
2337 \ifx\temp\onword
2338 \expandafter\let\csname SETtxicodequotebacktick\endcsname
2339 = t%
2340 \else\ifx\temp\offword
2341 \expandafter\let\csname SETtxicodequotebacktick\endcsname
2342 = \relax
2343 \else
2344 \errhelp = \EMsimple
2345 \errmessage{Unknown @codequotebacktick value `\temp', must be on|off}%
2346 \fi\fi
2349 % [Knuth] pp. 380,381,391, disable Spanish ligatures ?` and !` of \tt font.
2350 \def\noligaturesquoteleft{\relax\lq}
2352 % Count depth in font-changes, for error checks
2353 \newcount\fontdepth \fontdepth=0
2355 % Font commands.
2357 % #1 is the font command (\sl or \it), #2 is the text to slant.
2358 % If we are in a monospaced environment, however, 1) always use \ttsl,
2359 % and 2) do not add an italic correction.
2360 \def\dosmartslant#1#2{%
2361 \ifusingtt
2362 {{\ttsl #2}\let\next=\relax}%
2363 {\def\next{{#1#2}\futurelet\next\smartitaliccorrection}}%
2364 \next
2366 \def\smartslanted{\dosmartslant\sl}
2367 \def\smartitalic{\dosmartslant\it}
2369 % Output an italic correction unless \next (presumed to be the following
2370 % character) is such as not to need one.
2371 \def\smartitaliccorrection{%
2372 \ifx\next,%
2373 \else\ifx\next-%
2374 \else\ifx\next.%
2375 \else\ifx\next\.%
2376 \else\ifx\next\comma%
2377 \else\ptexslash
2378 \fi\fi\fi\fi\fi
2379 \aftersmartic
2382 % Unconditional use \ttsl, and no ic. @var is set to this for defuns.
2383 \def\ttslanted#1{{\ttsl #1}}
2385 % @cite is like \smartslanted except unconditionally use \sl. We never want
2386 % ttsl for book titles, do we?
2387 \def\cite#1{{\sl #1}\futurelet\next\smartitaliccorrection}
2389 \def\aftersmartic{}
2390 \def\var#1{%
2391 \let\saveaftersmartic = \aftersmartic
2392 \def\aftersmartic{\null\let\aftersmartic=\saveaftersmartic}%
2393 \smartslanted{#1}%
2396 \let\i=\smartitalic
2397 \let\slanted=\smartslanted
2398 \let\dfn=\smartslanted
2399 \let\emph=\smartitalic
2401 % Explicit font changes: @r, @sc, undocumented @ii.
2402 \def\r#1{{\rm #1}} % roman font
2403 \def\sc#1{{\smallcaps#1}} % smallcaps font
2404 \def\ii#1{{\it #1}} % italic font
2406 % @b, explicit bold. Also @strong.
2407 \def\b#1{{\bf #1}}
2408 \let\strong=\b
2410 % @sansserif, explicit sans.
2411 \def\sansserif#1{{\sf #1}}
2413 % We can't just use \exhyphenpenalty, because that only has effect at
2414 % the end of a paragraph. Restore normal hyphenation at the end of the
2415 % group within which \nohyphenation is presumably called.
2417 \def\nohyphenation{\hyphenchar\font = -1 \aftergroup\restorehyphenation}
2418 \def\restorehyphenation{\hyphenchar\font = `- }
2420 % Set sfcode to normal for the chars that usually have another value.
2421 % Can't use plain's \frenchspacing because it uses the `\x notation, and
2422 % sometimes \x has an active definition that messes things up.
2424 \catcode`@=11
2425 \def\plainfrenchspacing{%
2426 \sfcode\dotChar =\@m \sfcode\questChar=\@m \sfcode\exclamChar=\@m
2427 \sfcode\colonChar=\@m \sfcode\semiChar =\@m \sfcode\commaChar =\@m
2428 \def\endofsentencespacefactor{1000}% for @. and friends
2430 \def\plainnonfrenchspacing{%
2431 \sfcode`\.3000\sfcode`\?3000\sfcode`\!3000
2432 \sfcode`\:2000\sfcode`\;1500\sfcode`\,1250
2433 \def\endofsentencespacefactor{3000}% for @. and friends
2435 \catcode`@=\other
2436 \def\endofsentencespacefactor{3000}% default
2438 % @t, explicit typewriter.
2439 \def\t#1{%
2440 {\tt \rawbackslash \plainfrenchspacing #1}%
2441 \null
2444 % @samp.
2445 \def\samp#1{{\setupmarkupstyle{samp}\lq\tclose{#1}\rq\null}}
2447 % @indicateurl is \samp, that is, with quotes.
2448 \let\indicateurl=\samp
2450 % @code (and similar) prints in typewriter, but with spaces the same
2451 % size as normal in the surrounding text, without hyphenation, etc.
2452 % This is a subroutine for that.
2453 \def\tclose#1{%
2455 % Change normal interword space to be same as for the current font.
2456 \spaceskip = \fontdimen2\font
2458 % Switch to typewriter.
2461 % But `\ ' produces the large typewriter interword space.
2462 \def\ {{\spaceskip = 0pt{} }}%
2464 % Turn off hyphenation.
2465 \nohyphenation
2467 \rawbackslash
2468 \plainfrenchspacing
2471 \null % reset spacefactor to 1000
2474 % We *must* turn on hyphenation at `-' and `_' in @code.
2475 % (But see \codedashfinish below.)
2476 % Otherwise, it is too hard to avoid overfull hboxes
2477 % in the Emacs manual, the Library manual, etc.
2479 % Unfortunately, TeX uses one parameter (\hyphenchar) to control
2480 % both hyphenation at - and hyphenation within words.
2481 % We must therefore turn them both off (\tclose does that)
2482 % and arrange explicitly to hyphenate at a dash. -- rms.
2484 \catcode`\-=\active \catcode`\_=\active
2485 \catcode`\'=\active \catcode`\`=\active
2486 \global\let'=\rq \global\let`=\lq % default definitions
2488 \global\def\code{\begingroup
2489 \setupmarkupstyle{code}%
2490 % The following should really be moved into \setupmarkupstyle handlers.
2491 \catcode\dashChar=\active \catcode\underChar=\active
2492 \ifallowcodebreaks
2493 \let-\codedash
2494 \let_\codeunder
2495 \else
2496 \let-\normaldash
2497 \let_\realunder
2499 % Given -foo (with a single dash), we do not want to allow a break
2500 % after the hyphen.
2501 \global\let\codedashprev=\codedash
2503 \codex
2506 \gdef\codedash{\futurelet\next\codedashfinish}
2507 \gdef\codedashfinish{%
2508 \normaldash % always output the dash character itself.
2510 % Now, output a discretionary to allow a line break, unless
2511 % (a) the next character is a -, or
2512 % (b) the preceding character is a -.
2513 % E.g., given --posix, we do not want to allow a break after either -.
2514 % Given --foo-bar, we do want to allow a break between the - and the b.
2515 \ifx\next\codedash \else
2516 \ifx\codedashprev\codedash
2517 \else \discretionary{}{}{}\fi
2519 % we need the space after the = for the case when \next itself is a
2520 % space token; it would get swallowed otherwise. As in @code{- a}.
2521 \global\let\codedashprev= \next
2524 \def\normaldash{-}
2526 \def\codex #1{\tclose{#1}\endgroup}
2528 \def\codeunder{%
2529 % this is all so @math{@code{var_name}+1} can work. In math mode, _
2530 % is "active" (mathcode"8000) and \normalunderscore (or \char95, etc.)
2531 % will therefore expand the active definition of _, which is us
2532 % (inside @code that is), therefore an endless loop.
2533 \ifusingtt{\ifmmode
2534 \mathchar"075F % class 0=ordinary, family 7=ttfam, pos 0x5F=_.
2535 \else\normalunderscore \fi
2536 \discretionary{}{}{}}%
2537 {\_}%
2540 % An additional complication: the above will allow breaks after, e.g.,
2541 % each of the four underscores in __typeof__. This is bad.
2542 % @allowcodebreaks provides a document-level way to turn breaking at -
2543 % and _ on and off.
2545 \newif\ifallowcodebreaks \allowcodebreakstrue
2547 \def\keywordtrue{true}
2548 \def\keywordfalse{false}
2550 \parseargdef\allowcodebreaks{%
2551 \def\txiarg{#1}%
2552 \ifx\txiarg\keywordtrue
2553 \allowcodebreakstrue
2554 \else\ifx\txiarg\keywordfalse
2555 \allowcodebreaksfalse
2556 \else
2557 \errhelp = \EMsimple
2558 \errmessage{Unknown @allowcodebreaks option `\txiarg', must be true|false}%
2559 \fi\fi
2562 % For @command, @env, @file, @option quotes seem unnecessary,
2563 % so use \code rather than \samp.
2564 \let\command=\code
2565 \let\env=\code
2566 \let\file=\code
2567 \let\option=\code
2569 % @uref (abbreviation for `urlref') aka @url takes an optional
2570 % (comma-separated) second argument specifying the text to display and
2571 % an optional third arg as text to display instead of (rather than in
2572 % addition to) the url itself. First (mandatory) arg is the url.
2574 % TeX-only option to allow changing PDF output to show only the second
2575 % arg (if given), and not the url (which is then just the link target).
2576 \newif\ifurefurlonlylink
2578 % The main macro is \urefbreak, which allows breaking at expected
2579 % places within the url. (There used to be another version, which
2580 % didn't support automatic breaking.)
2581 \def\urefbreak{\begingroup \urefcatcodes \dourefbreak}
2582 \let\uref=\urefbreak
2584 \def\dourefbreak#1{\urefbreakfinish #1,,,\finish}
2585 \def\urefbreakfinish#1,#2,#3,#4\finish{% doesn't work in @example
2586 \unsepspaces
2587 \pdfurl{#1}%
2588 \setbox0 = \hbox{\ignorespaces #3}%
2589 \ifdim\wd0 > 0pt
2590 \unhbox0 % third arg given, show only that
2591 \else
2592 \setbox0 = \hbox{\ignorespaces #2}% look for second arg
2593 \ifdim\wd0 > 0pt
2594 \ifpdf
2595 \ifurefurlonlylink
2596 % PDF plus option to not display url, show just arg
2597 \unhbox0
2598 \else
2599 % PDF, normally display both arg and url for consistency,
2600 % visibility, if the pdf is eventually used to print, etc.
2601 \unhbox0\ (\urefcode{#1})%
2603 \else
2604 \unhbox0\ (\urefcode{#1})% DVI, always show arg and url
2606 \else
2607 \urefcode{#1}% only url given, so show it
2610 \endlink
2611 \endgroup}
2613 % Allow line breaks around only a few characters (only).
2614 \def\urefcatcodes{%
2615 \catcode\ampChar=\active \catcode\dotChar=\active
2616 \catcode\hashChar=\active \catcode\questChar=\active
2617 \catcode\slashChar=\active
2620 \urefcatcodes
2622 \global\def\urefcode{\begingroup
2623 \setupmarkupstyle{code}%
2624 \urefcatcodes
2625 \let&\urefcodeamp
2626 \let.\urefcodedot
2627 \let#\urefcodehash
2628 \let?\urefcodequest
2629 \let/\urefcodeslash
2630 \codex
2633 % By default, they are just regular characters.
2634 \global\def&{\normalamp}
2635 \global\def.{\normaldot}
2636 \global\def#{\normalhash}
2637 \global\def?{\normalquest}
2638 \global\def/{\normalslash}
2641 % we put a little stretch before and after the breakable chars, to help
2642 % line breaking of long url's. The unequal skips make look better in
2643 % cmtt at least, especially for dots.
2644 \def\urefprestretchamount{.13em}
2645 \def\urefpoststretchamount{.1em}
2646 \def\urefprestretch{\urefprebreak \hskip0pt plus\urefprestretchamount\relax}
2647 \def\urefpoststretch{\urefpostbreak \hskip0pt plus\urefprestretchamount\relax}
2649 \def\urefcodeamp{\urefprestretch \&\urefpoststretch}
2650 \def\urefcodedot{\urefprestretch .\urefpoststretch}
2651 \def\urefcodehash{\urefprestretch \#\urefpoststretch}
2652 \def\urefcodequest{\urefprestretch ?\urefpoststretch}
2653 \def\urefcodeslash{\futurelet\next\urefcodeslashfinish}
2655 \catcode`\/=\active
2656 \global\def\urefcodeslashfinish{%
2657 \urefprestretch \slashChar
2658 % Allow line break only after the final / in a sequence of
2659 % slashes, to avoid line break between the slashes in http://.
2660 \ifx\next/\else \urefpoststretch \fi
2664 % One more complication: by default we'll break after the special
2665 % characters, but some people like to break before the special chars, so
2666 % allow that. Also allow no breaking at all, for manual control.
2668 \parseargdef\urefbreakstyle{%
2669 \def\txiarg{#1}%
2670 \ifx\txiarg\wordnone
2671 \def\urefprebreak{\nobreak}\def\urefpostbreak{\nobreak}
2672 \else\ifx\txiarg\wordbefore
2673 \def\urefprebreak{\allowbreak}\def\urefpostbreak{\nobreak}
2674 \else\ifx\txiarg\wordafter
2675 \def\urefprebreak{\nobreak}\def\urefpostbreak{\allowbreak}
2676 \else
2677 \errhelp = \EMsimple
2678 \errmessage{Unknown @urefbreakstyle setting `\txiarg'}%
2679 \fi\fi\fi
2681 \def\wordafter{after}
2682 \def\wordbefore{before}
2683 \def\wordnone{none}
2685 \urefbreakstyle after
2687 % @url synonym for @uref, since that's how everyone uses it.
2689 \let\url=\uref
2691 % rms does not like angle brackets --karl, 17may97.
2692 % So now @email is just like @uref, unless we are pdf.
2694 %\def\email#1{\angleleft{\tt #1}\angleright}
2695 \ifpdf
2696 \def\email#1{\doemail#1,,\finish}
2697 \def\doemail#1,#2,#3\finish{\begingroup
2698 \unsepspaces
2699 \pdfurl{mailto:#1}%
2700 \setbox0 = \hbox{\ignorespaces #2}%
2701 \ifdim\wd0>0pt\unhbox0\else\code{#1}\fi
2702 \endlink
2703 \endgroup}
2704 \else
2705 \let\email=\uref
2708 % @kbdinputstyle -- arg is `distinct' (@kbd uses slanted tty font always),
2709 % `example' (@kbd uses ttsl only inside of @example and friends),
2710 % or `code' (@kbd uses normal tty font always).
2711 \parseargdef\kbdinputstyle{%
2712 \def\txiarg{#1}%
2713 \ifx\txiarg\worddistinct
2714 \gdef\kbdexamplefont{\ttsl}\gdef\kbdfont{\ttsl}%
2715 \else\ifx\txiarg\wordexample
2716 \gdef\kbdexamplefont{\ttsl}\gdef\kbdfont{\tt}%
2717 \else\ifx\txiarg\wordcode
2718 \gdef\kbdexamplefont{\tt}\gdef\kbdfont{\tt}%
2719 \else
2720 \errhelp = \EMsimple
2721 \errmessage{Unknown @kbdinputstyle setting `\txiarg'}%
2722 \fi\fi\fi
2724 \def\worddistinct{distinct}
2725 \def\wordexample{example}
2726 \def\wordcode{code}
2728 % Default is `distinct'.
2729 \kbdinputstyle distinct
2731 % @kbd is like @code, except that if the argument is just one @key command,
2732 % then @kbd has no effect.
2733 \def\kbd#1{{\def\look{#1}\expandafter\kbdsub\look??\par}}
2735 \def\xkey{\key}
2736 \def\kbdsub#1#2#3\par{%
2737 \def\one{#1}\def\three{#3}\def\threex{??}%
2738 \ifx\one\xkey\ifx\threex\three \key{#2}%
2739 \else{\tclose{\kbdfont\setupmarkupstyle{kbd}\look}}\fi
2740 \else{\tclose{\kbdfont\setupmarkupstyle{kbd}\look}}\fi
2743 % definition of @key that produces a lozenge. Doesn't adjust to text size.
2744 %\setfont\keyrm\rmshape{8}{1000}{OT1}
2745 %\font\keysy=cmsy9
2746 %\def\key#1{{\keyrm\textfont2=\keysy \leavevmode\hbox{%
2747 % \raise0.4pt\hbox{\angleleft}\kern-.08em\vtop{%
2748 % \vbox{\hrule\kern-0.4pt
2749 % \hbox{\raise0.4pt\hbox{\vphantom{\angleleft}}#1}}%
2750 % \kern-0.4pt\hrule}%
2751 % \kern-.06em\raise0.4pt\hbox{\angleright}}}}
2753 % definition of @key with no lozenge. If the current font is already
2754 % monospace, don't change it; that way, we respect @kbdinputstyle. But
2755 % if it isn't monospace, then use \tt.
2757 \def\key#1{{\setupmarkupstyle{key}%
2758 \nohyphenation
2759 \ifmonospace\else\tt\fi
2760 #1}\null}
2762 % @clicksequence{File @click{} Open ...}
2763 \def\clicksequence#1{\begingroup #1\endgroup}
2765 % @clickstyle @arrow (by default)
2766 \parseargdef\clickstyle{\def\click{#1}}
2767 \def\click{\arrow}
2769 % Typeset a dimension, e.g., `in' or `pt'. The only reason for the
2770 % argument is to make the input look right: @dmn{pt} instead of @dmn{}pt.
2772 \def\dmn#1{\thinspace #1}
2774 % @l was never documented to mean ``switch to the Lisp font'',
2775 % and it is not used as such in any manual I can find. We need it for
2776 % Polish suppressed-l. --karl, 22sep96.
2777 %\def\l#1{{\li #1}\null}
2779 % @acronym for "FBI", "NATO", and the like.
2780 % We print this one point size smaller, since it's intended for
2781 % all-uppercase.
2783 \def\acronym#1{\doacronym #1,,\finish}
2784 \def\doacronym#1,#2,#3\finish{%
2785 {\selectfonts\lsize #1}%
2786 \def\temp{#2}%
2787 \ifx\temp\empty \else
2788 \space ({\unsepspaces \ignorespaces \temp \unskip})%
2790 \null % reset \spacefactor=1000
2793 % @abbr for "Comput. J." and the like.
2794 % No font change, but don't do end-of-sentence spacing.
2796 \def\abbr#1{\doabbr #1,,\finish}
2797 \def\doabbr#1,#2,#3\finish{%
2798 {\plainfrenchspacing #1}%
2799 \def\temp{#2}%
2800 \ifx\temp\empty \else
2801 \space ({\unsepspaces \ignorespaces \temp \unskip})%
2803 \null % reset \spacefactor=1000
2806 % @asis just yields its argument. Used with @table, for example.
2808 \def\asis#1{#1}
2810 % @math outputs its argument in math mode.
2812 % One complication: _ usually means subscripts, but it could also mean
2813 % an actual _ character, as in @math{@var{some_variable} + 1}. So make
2814 % _ active, and distinguish by seeing if the current family is \slfam,
2815 % which is what @var uses.
2817 \catcode`\_ = \active
2818 \gdef\mathunderscore{%
2819 \catcode`\_=\active
2820 \def_{\ifnum\fam=\slfam \_\else\sb\fi}%
2823 % Another complication: we want \\ (and @\) to output a math (or tt) \.
2824 % FYI, plain.tex uses \\ as a temporary control sequence (for no
2825 % particular reason), but this is not advertised and we don't care.
2827 % The \mathchar is class=0=ordinary, family=7=ttfam, position=5C=\.
2828 \def\mathbackslash{\ifnum\fam=\ttfam \mathchar"075C \else\backslash \fi}
2830 \def\math{%
2831 \tex
2832 \mathunderscore
2833 \let\\ = \mathbackslash
2834 \mathactive
2835 % make the texinfo accent commands work in math mode
2836 \let\"=\ddot
2837 \let\'=\acute
2838 \let\==\bar
2839 \let\^=\hat
2840 \let\`=\grave
2841 \let\u=\breve
2842 \let\v=\check
2843 \let\~=\tilde
2844 \let\dotaccent=\dot
2845 % have to provide another name for sup operator
2846 \let\mathopsup=\sup
2847 $\finishmath
2849 \def\finishmath#1{#1$\endgroup} % Close the group opened by \tex.
2851 % Some active characters (such as <) are spaced differently in math.
2852 % We have to reset their definitions in case the @math was an argument
2853 % to a command which sets the catcodes (such as @item or @section).
2856 \catcode`^ = \active
2857 \catcode`< = \active
2858 \catcode`> = \active
2859 \catcode`+ = \active
2860 \catcode`' = \active
2861 \gdef\mathactive{%
2862 \let^ = \ptexhat
2863 \let< = \ptexless
2864 \let> = \ptexgtr
2865 \let+ = \ptexplus
2866 \let' = \ptexquoteright
2870 % for @sub and @sup, if in math mode, just do a normal sub/superscript.
2871 % If in text, use math to place as sub/superscript, but switch
2872 % into text mode, with smaller fonts. This is a different font than the
2873 % one used for real math sub/superscripts (8pt vs. 7pt), but let's not
2874 % fix it (significant additions to font machinery) until someone notices.
2876 \def\sub{\ifmmode \expandafter\sb \else \expandafter\finishsub\fi}
2877 \def\finishsub#1{$\sb{\hbox{\selectfonts\lllsize #1}}$}%
2879 \def\sup{\ifmmode \expandafter\ptexsp \else \expandafter\finishsup\fi}
2880 \def\finishsup#1{$\ptexsp{\hbox{\selectfonts\lllsize #1}}$}%
2882 % ctrl is no longer a Texinfo command, but leave this definition for fun.
2883 \def\ctrl #1{{\tt \rawbackslash \hat}#1}
2885 % @inlinefmt{FMTNAME,PROCESSED-TEXT} and @inlineraw{FMTNAME,RAW-TEXT}.
2886 % Ignore unless FMTNAME == tex; then it is like @iftex and @tex,
2887 % except specified as a normal braced arg, so no newlines to worry about.
2889 \def\outfmtnametex{tex}
2891 \long\def\inlinefmt#1{\doinlinefmt #1,\finish}
2892 \long\def\doinlinefmt#1,#2,\finish{%
2893 \def\inlinefmtname{#1}%
2894 \ifx\inlinefmtname\outfmtnametex \ignorespaces #2\fi
2897 % @inlinefmtifelse{FMTNAME,THEN-TEXT,ELSE-TEXT} expands THEN-TEXT if
2898 % FMTNAME is tex, else ELSE-TEXT.
2899 \long\def\inlinefmtifelse#1{\doinlinefmtifelse #1,,,\finish}
2900 \long\def\doinlinefmtifelse#1,#2,#3,#4,\finish{%
2901 \def\inlinefmtname{#1}%
2902 \ifx\inlinefmtname\outfmtnametex \ignorespaces #2\else \ignorespaces #3\fi
2905 % For raw, must switch into @tex before parsing the argument, to avoid
2906 % setting catcodes prematurely. Doing it this way means that, for
2907 % example, @inlineraw{html, foo{bar} gets a parse error instead of being
2908 % ignored. But this isn't important because if people want a literal
2909 % *right* brace they would have to use a command anyway, so they may as
2910 % well use a command to get a left brace too. We could re-use the
2911 % delimiter character idea from \verb, but it seems like overkill.
2913 \long\def\inlineraw{\tex \doinlineraw}
2914 \long\def\doinlineraw#1{\doinlinerawtwo #1,\finish}
2915 \def\doinlinerawtwo#1,#2,\finish{%
2916 \def\inlinerawname{#1}%
2917 \ifx\inlinerawname\outfmtnametex \ignorespaces #2\fi
2918 \endgroup % close group opened by \tex.
2921 % @inlineifset{VAR, TEXT} expands TEXT if VAR is @set.
2923 \long\def\inlineifset#1{\doinlineifset #1,\finish}
2924 \long\def\doinlineifset#1,#2,\finish{%
2925 \def\inlinevarname{#1}%
2926 \expandafter\ifx\csname SET\inlinevarname\endcsname\relax
2927 \else\ignorespaces#2\fi
2930 % @inlineifclear{VAR, TEXT} expands TEXT if VAR is not @set.
2932 \long\def\inlineifclear#1{\doinlineifclear #1,\finish}
2933 \long\def\doinlineifclear#1,#2,\finish{%
2934 \def\inlinevarname{#1}%
2935 \expandafter\ifx\csname SET\inlinevarname\endcsname\relax \ignorespaces#2\fi
2939 \message{glyphs,}
2940 % and logos.
2942 % @@ prints an @, as does @atchar{}.
2943 \def\@{\char64 }
2944 \let\atchar=\@
2946 % @{ @} @lbracechar{} @rbracechar{} all generate brace characters.
2947 % Unless we're in typewriter, use \ecfont because the CM text fonts do
2948 % not have braces, and we don't want to switch into math.
2949 \def\mylbrace{{\ifmonospace\else\ecfont\fi \char123}}
2950 \def\myrbrace{{\ifmonospace\else\ecfont\fi \char125}}
2951 \let\{=\mylbrace \let\lbracechar=\{
2952 \let\}=\myrbrace \let\rbracechar=\}
2953 \begingroup
2954 % Definitions to produce \{ and \} commands for indices,
2955 % and @{ and @} for the aux/toc files.
2956 \catcode`\{ = \other \catcode`\} = \other
2957 \catcode`\[ = 1 \catcode`\] = 2
2958 \catcode`\! = 0 \catcode`\\ = \other
2959 !gdef!lbracecmd[\{]%
2960 !gdef!rbracecmd[\}]%
2961 !gdef!lbraceatcmd[@{]%
2962 !gdef!rbraceatcmd[@}]%
2963 !endgroup
2965 % @comma{} to avoid , parsing problems.
2966 \let\comma = ,
2968 % Accents: @, @dotaccent @ringaccent @ubaraccent @udotaccent
2969 % Others are defined by plain TeX: @` @' @" @^ @~ @= @u @v @H.
2970 \let\, = \ptexc
2971 \let\dotaccent = \ptexdot
2972 \def\ringaccent#1{{\accent23 #1}}
2973 \let\tieaccent = \ptext
2974 \let\ubaraccent = \ptexb
2975 \let\udotaccent = \d
2977 % Other special characters: @questiondown @exclamdown @ordf @ordm
2978 % Plain TeX defines: @AA @AE @O @OE @L (plus lowercase versions) @ss.
2979 \def\questiondown{?`}
2980 \def\exclamdown{!`}
2981 \def\ordf{\leavevmode\raise1ex\hbox{\selectfonts\lllsize \underbar{a}}}
2982 \def\ordm{\leavevmode\raise1ex\hbox{\selectfonts\lllsize \underbar{o}}}
2984 % Dotless i and dotless j, used for accents.
2985 \def\imacro{i}
2986 \def\jmacro{j}
2987 \def\dotless#1{%
2988 \def\temp{#1}%
2989 \ifx\temp\imacro \ifmmode\imath \else\ptexi \fi
2990 \else\ifx\temp\jmacro \ifmmode\jmath \else\j \fi
2991 \else \errmessage{@dotless can be used only with i or j}%
2992 \fi\fi
2995 % The \TeX{} logo, as in plain, but resetting the spacing so that a
2996 % period following counts as ending a sentence. (Idea found in latex.)
2998 \edef\TeX{\TeX \spacefactor=1000 }
3000 % @LaTeX{} logo. Not quite the same results as the definition in
3001 % latex.ltx, since we use a different font for the raised A; it's most
3002 % convenient for us to use an explicitly smaller font, rather than using
3003 % the \scriptstyle font (since we don't reset \scriptstyle and
3004 % \scriptscriptstyle).
3006 \def\LaTeX{%
3007 L\kern-.36em
3008 {\setbox0=\hbox{T}%
3009 \vbox to \ht0{\hbox{%
3010 \ifx\textnominalsize\xwordpt
3011 % for 10pt running text, \lllsize (8pt) is too small for the A in LaTeX.
3012 % Revert to plain's \scriptsize, which is 7pt.
3013 \count255=\the\fam $\fam\count255 \scriptstyle A$%
3014 \else
3015 % For 11pt, we can use our lllsize.
3016 \selectfonts\lllsize A%
3019 \vss
3021 \kern-.15em
3022 \TeX
3025 % Some math mode symbols. Define \ensuremath to switch into math mode
3026 % unless we are already there. Expansion tricks may not be needed here,
3027 % but safer, and can't hurt.
3028 \def\ensuremath{\ifmmode \expandafter\asis \else\expandafter\ensuredmath \fi}
3029 \def\ensuredmath#1{$\relax#1$}
3031 \def\bullet{\ensuremath\ptexbullet}
3032 \def\geq{\ensuremath\ge}
3033 \def\leq{\ensuremath\le}
3034 \def\minus{\ensuremath-}
3036 % @dots{} outputs an ellipsis using the current font.
3037 % We do .5em per period so that it has the same spacing in the cm
3038 % typewriter fonts as three actual period characters; on the other hand,
3039 % in other typewriter fonts three periods are wider than 1.5em. So do
3040 % whichever is larger.
3042 \def\dots{%
3043 \leavevmode
3044 \setbox0=\hbox{...}% get width of three periods
3045 \ifdim\wd0 > 1.5em
3046 \dimen0 = \wd0
3047 \else
3048 \dimen0 = 1.5em
3050 \hbox to \dimen0{%
3051 \hskip 0pt plus.25fil
3052 .\hskip 0pt plus1fil
3053 .\hskip 0pt plus1fil
3054 .\hskip 0pt plus.5fil
3058 % @enddots{} is an end-of-sentence ellipsis.
3060 \def\enddots{%
3061 \dots
3062 \spacefactor=\endofsentencespacefactor
3065 % @point{}, @result{}, @expansion{}, @print{}, @equiv{}.
3067 % Since these characters are used in examples, they should be an even number of
3068 % \tt widths. Each \tt character is 1en, so two makes it 1em.
3070 \def\point{$\star$}
3071 \def\arrow{\leavevmode\raise.05ex\hbox to 1em{\hfil$\rightarrow$\hfil}}
3072 \def\result{\leavevmode\raise.05ex\hbox to 1em{\hfil$\Rightarrow$\hfil}}
3073 \def\expansion{\leavevmode\hbox to 1em{\hfil$\mapsto$\hfil}}
3074 \def\print{\leavevmode\lower.1ex\hbox to 1em{\hfil$\dashv$\hfil}}
3075 \def\equiv{\leavevmode\hbox to 1em{\hfil$\ptexequiv$\hfil}}
3077 % The @error{} command.
3078 % Adapted from the TeXbook's \boxit.
3080 \newbox\errorbox
3082 {\tentt \global\dimen0 = 3em}% Width of the box.
3083 \dimen2 = .55pt % Thickness of rules
3084 % The text. (`r' is open on the right, `e' somewhat less so on the left.)
3085 \setbox0 = \hbox{\kern-.75pt \reducedsf \putworderror\kern-1.5pt}
3087 \setbox\errorbox=\hbox to \dimen0{\hfil
3088 \hsize = \dimen0 \advance\hsize by -5.8pt % Space to left+right.
3089 \advance\hsize by -2\dimen2 % Rules.
3090 \vbox{%
3091 \hrule height\dimen2
3092 \hbox{\vrule width\dimen2 \kern3pt % Space to left of text.
3093 \vtop{\kern2.4pt \box0 \kern2.4pt}% Space above/below.
3094 \kern3pt\vrule width\dimen2}% Space to right.
3095 \hrule height\dimen2}
3096 \hfil}
3098 \def\error{\leavevmode\lower.7ex\copy\errorbox}
3100 % @pounds{} is a sterling sign, which Knuth put in the CM italic font.
3102 \def\pounds{{\it\$}}
3104 % @euro{} comes from a separate font, depending on the current style.
3105 % We use the free feym* fonts from the eurosym package by Henrik
3106 % Theiling, which support regular, slanted, bold and bold slanted (and
3107 % "outlined" (blackboard board, sort of) versions, which we don't need).
3108 % It is available from http://www.ctan.org/tex-archive/fonts/eurosym.
3110 % Although only regular is the truly official Euro symbol, we ignore
3111 % that. The Euro is designed to be slightly taller than the regular
3112 % font height.
3114 % feymr - regular
3115 % feymo - slanted
3116 % feybr - bold
3117 % feybo - bold slanted
3119 % There is no good (free) typewriter version, to my knowledge.
3120 % A feymr10 euro is ~7.3pt wide, while a normal cmtt10 char is ~5.25pt wide.
3121 % Hmm.
3123 % Also doesn't work in math. Do we need to do math with euro symbols?
3124 % Hope not.
3127 \def\euro{{\eurofont e}}
3128 \def\eurofont{%
3129 % We set the font at each command, rather than predefining it in
3130 % \textfonts and the other font-switching commands, so that
3131 % installations which never need the symbol don't have to have the
3132 % font installed.
3134 % There is only one designed size (nominal 10pt), so we always scale
3135 % that to the current nominal size.
3137 % By the way, simply using "at 1em" works for cmr10 and the like, but
3138 % does not work for cmbx10 and other extended/shrunken fonts.
3140 \def\eurosize{\csname\curfontsize nominalsize\endcsname}%
3142 \ifx\curfontstyle\bfstylename
3143 % bold:
3144 \font\thiseurofont = \ifusingit{feybo10}{feybr10} at \eurosize
3145 \else
3146 % regular:
3147 \font\thiseurofont = \ifusingit{feymo10}{feymr10} at \eurosize
3149 \thiseurofont
3152 % Glyphs from the EC fonts. We don't use \let for the aliases, because
3153 % sometimes we redefine the original macro, and the alias should reflect
3154 % the redefinition.
3156 % Use LaTeX names for the Icelandic letters.
3157 \def\DH{{\ecfont \char"D0}} % Eth
3158 \def\dh{{\ecfont \char"F0}} % eth
3159 \def\TH{{\ecfont \char"DE}} % Thorn
3160 \def\th{{\ecfont \char"FE}} % thorn
3162 \def\guillemetleft{{\ecfont \char"13}}
3163 \def\guillemotleft{\guillemetleft}
3164 \def\guillemetright{{\ecfont \char"14}}
3165 \def\guillemotright{\guillemetright}
3166 \def\guilsinglleft{{\ecfont \char"0E}}
3167 \def\guilsinglright{{\ecfont \char"0F}}
3168 \def\quotedblbase{{\ecfont \char"12}}
3169 \def\quotesinglbase{{\ecfont \char"0D}}
3171 % This positioning is not perfect (see the ogonek LaTeX package), but
3172 % we have the precomposed glyphs for the most common cases. We put the
3173 % tests to use those glyphs in the single \ogonek macro so we have fewer
3174 % dummy definitions to worry about for index entries, etc.
3176 % ogonek is also used with other letters in Lithuanian (IOU), but using
3177 % the precomposed glyphs for those is not so easy since they aren't in
3178 % the same EC font.
3179 \def\ogonek#1{{%
3180 \def\temp{#1}%
3181 \ifx\temp\macrocharA\Aogonek
3182 \else\ifx\temp\macrochara\aogonek
3183 \else\ifx\temp\macrocharE\Eogonek
3184 \else\ifx\temp\macrochare\eogonek
3185 \else
3186 \ecfont \setbox0=\hbox{#1}%
3187 \ifdim\ht0=1ex\accent"0C #1%
3188 \else\ooalign{\unhbox0\crcr\hidewidth\char"0C \hidewidth}%
3190 \fi\fi\fi\fi
3193 \def\Aogonek{{\ecfont \char"81}}\def\macrocharA{A}
3194 \def\aogonek{{\ecfont \char"A1}}\def\macrochara{a}
3195 \def\Eogonek{{\ecfont \char"86}}\def\macrocharE{E}
3196 \def\eogonek{{\ecfont \char"A6}}\def\macrochare{e}
3198 % Use the ec* fonts (cm-super in outline format) for non-CM glyphs.
3199 \def\ecfont{%
3200 % We can't distinguish serif/sans and italic/slanted, but this
3201 % is used for crude hacks anyway (like adding French and German
3202 % quotes to documents typeset with CM, where we lose kerning), so
3203 % hopefully nobody will notice/care.
3204 \edef\ecsize{\csname\curfontsize ecsize\endcsname}%
3205 \edef\nominalsize{\csname\curfontsize nominalsize\endcsname}%
3206 \ifmonospace
3207 % typewriter:
3208 \font\thisecfont = ectt\ecsize \space at \nominalsize
3209 \else
3210 \ifx\curfontstyle\bfstylename
3211 % bold:
3212 \font\thisecfont = ecb\ifusingit{i}{x}\ecsize \space at \nominalsize
3213 \else
3214 % regular:
3215 \font\thisecfont = ec\ifusingit{ti}{rm}\ecsize \space at \nominalsize
3218 \thisecfont
3221 % @registeredsymbol - R in a circle. The font for the R should really
3222 % be smaller yet, but lllsize is the best we can do for now.
3223 % Adapted from the plain.tex definition of \copyright.
3225 \def\registeredsymbol{%
3226 $^{{\ooalign{\hfil\raise.07ex\hbox{\selectfonts\lllsize R}%
3227 \hfil\crcr\Orb}}%
3231 % @textdegree - the normal degrees sign.
3233 \def\textdegree{$^\circ$}
3235 % Laurent Siebenmann reports \Orb undefined with:
3236 % Textures 1.7.7 (preloaded format=plain 93.10.14) (68K) 16 APR 2004 02:38
3237 % so we'll define it if necessary.
3239 \ifx\Orb\thisisundefined
3240 \def\Orb{\mathhexbox20D}
3243 % Quotes.
3244 \chardef\quotedblleft="5C
3245 \chardef\quotedblright=`\"
3246 \chardef\quoteleft=`\`
3247 \chardef\quoteright=`\'
3250 \message{page headings,}
3252 \newskip\titlepagetopglue \titlepagetopglue = 1.5in
3253 \newskip\titlepagebottomglue \titlepagebottomglue = 2pc
3255 % First the title page. Must do @settitle before @titlepage.
3256 \newif\ifseenauthor
3257 \newif\iffinishedtitlepage
3259 % Do an implicit @contents or @shortcontents after @end titlepage if the
3260 % user says @setcontentsaftertitlepage or @setshortcontentsaftertitlepage.
3262 \newif\ifsetcontentsaftertitlepage
3263 \let\setcontentsaftertitlepage = \setcontentsaftertitlepagetrue
3264 \newif\ifsetshortcontentsaftertitlepage
3265 \let\setshortcontentsaftertitlepage = \setshortcontentsaftertitlepagetrue
3267 \parseargdef\shorttitlepage{%
3268 \begingroup \hbox{}\vskip 1.5in \chaprm \centerline{#1}%
3269 \endgroup\page\hbox{}\page}
3271 \envdef\titlepage{%
3272 % Open one extra group, as we want to close it in the middle of \Etitlepage.
3273 \begingroup
3274 \parindent=0pt \textfonts
3275 % Leave some space at the very top of the page.
3276 \vglue\titlepagetopglue
3277 % No rule at page bottom unless we print one at the top with @title.
3278 \finishedtitlepagetrue
3280 % Most title ``pages'' are actually two pages long, with space
3281 % at the top of the second. We don't want the ragged left on the second.
3282 \let\oldpage = \page
3283 \def\page{%
3284 \iffinishedtitlepage\else
3285 \finishtitlepage
3287 \let\page = \oldpage
3288 \page
3289 \null
3293 \def\Etitlepage{%
3294 \iffinishedtitlepage\else
3295 \finishtitlepage
3297 % It is important to do the page break before ending the group,
3298 % because the headline and footline are only empty inside the group.
3299 % If we use the new definition of \page, we always get a blank page
3300 % after the title page, which we certainly don't want.
3301 \oldpage
3302 \endgroup
3304 % Need this before the \...aftertitlepage checks so that if they are
3305 % in effect the toc pages will come out with page numbers.
3306 \HEADINGSon
3308 % If they want short, they certainly want long too.
3309 \ifsetshortcontentsaftertitlepage
3310 \shortcontents
3311 \contents
3312 \global\let\shortcontents = \relax
3313 \global\let\contents = \relax
3316 \ifsetcontentsaftertitlepage
3317 \contents
3318 \global\let\contents = \relax
3319 \global\let\shortcontents = \relax
3323 \def\finishtitlepage{%
3324 \vskip4pt \hrule height 2pt width \hsize
3325 \vskip\titlepagebottomglue
3326 \finishedtitlepagetrue
3329 % Settings used for typesetting titles: no hyphenation, no indentation,
3330 % don't worry much about spacing, ragged right. This should be used
3331 % inside a \vbox, and fonts need to be set appropriately first. Because
3332 % it is always used for titles, nothing else, we call \rmisbold. \par
3333 % should be specified before the end of the \vbox, since a vbox is a group.
3335 \def\raggedtitlesettings{%
3336 \rmisbold
3337 \hyphenpenalty=10000
3338 \parindent=0pt
3339 \tolerance=5000
3340 \ptexraggedright
3343 % Macros to be used within @titlepage:
3345 \let\subtitlerm=\tenrm
3346 \def\subtitlefont{\subtitlerm \normalbaselineskip = 13pt \normalbaselines}
3348 \parseargdef\title{%
3349 \checkenv\titlepage
3350 \vbox{\titlefonts \raggedtitlesettings #1\par}%
3351 % print a rule at the page bottom also.
3352 \finishedtitlepagefalse
3353 \vskip4pt \hrule height 4pt width \hsize \vskip4pt
3356 \parseargdef\subtitle{%
3357 \checkenv\titlepage
3358 {\subtitlefont \rightline{#1}}%
3361 % @author should come last, but may come many times.
3362 % It can also be used inside @quotation.
3364 \parseargdef\author{%
3365 \def\temp{\quotation}%
3366 \ifx\thisenv\temp
3367 \def\quotationauthor{#1}% printed in \Equotation.
3368 \else
3369 \checkenv\titlepage
3370 \ifseenauthor\else \vskip 0pt plus 1filll \seenauthortrue \fi
3371 {\secfonts\rmisbold \leftline{#1}}%
3376 % Set up page headings and footings.
3378 \let\thispage=\folio
3380 \newtoks\evenheadline % headline on even pages
3381 \newtoks\oddheadline % headline on odd pages
3382 \newtoks\evenfootline % footline on even pages
3383 \newtoks\oddfootline % footline on odd pages
3385 % Now make TeX use those variables
3386 \headline={{\textfonts\rm \ifodd\pageno \the\oddheadline
3387 \else \the\evenheadline \fi}}
3388 \footline={{\textfonts\rm \ifodd\pageno \the\oddfootline
3389 \else \the\evenfootline \fi}\HEADINGShook}
3390 \let\HEADINGShook=\relax
3392 % Commands to set those variables.
3393 % For example, this is what @headings on does
3394 % @evenheading @thistitle|@thispage|@thischapter
3395 % @oddheading @thischapter|@thispage|@thistitle
3396 % @evenfooting @thisfile||
3397 % @oddfooting ||@thisfile
3400 \def\evenheading{\parsearg\evenheadingxxx}
3401 \def\evenheadingxxx #1{\evenheadingyyy #1\|\|\|\|\finish}
3402 \def\evenheadingyyy #1\|#2\|#3\|#4\finish{%
3403 \global\evenheadline={\rlap{\centerline{#2}}\line{#1\hfil#3}}}
3405 \def\oddheading{\parsearg\oddheadingxxx}
3406 \def\oddheadingxxx #1{\oddheadingyyy #1\|\|\|\|\finish}
3407 \def\oddheadingyyy #1\|#2\|#3\|#4\finish{%
3408 \global\oddheadline={\rlap{\centerline{#2}}\line{#1\hfil#3}}}
3410 \parseargdef\everyheading{\oddheadingxxx{#1}\evenheadingxxx{#1}}%
3412 \def\evenfooting{\parsearg\evenfootingxxx}
3413 \def\evenfootingxxx #1{\evenfootingyyy #1\|\|\|\|\finish}
3414 \def\evenfootingyyy #1\|#2\|#3\|#4\finish{%
3415 \global\evenfootline={\rlap{\centerline{#2}}\line{#1\hfil#3}}}
3417 \def\oddfooting{\parsearg\oddfootingxxx}
3418 \def\oddfootingxxx #1{\oddfootingyyy #1\|\|\|\|\finish}
3419 \def\oddfootingyyy #1\|#2\|#3\|#4\finish{%
3420 \global\oddfootline = {\rlap{\centerline{#2}}\line{#1\hfil#3}}%
3422 % Leave some space for the footline. Hopefully ok to assume
3423 % @evenfooting will not be used by itself.
3424 \global\advance\pageheight by -12pt
3425 \global\advance\vsize by -12pt
3428 \parseargdef\everyfooting{\oddfootingxxx{#1}\evenfootingxxx{#1}}
3430 % @evenheadingmarks top \thischapter <- chapter at the top of a page
3431 % @evenheadingmarks bottom \thischapter <- chapter at the bottom of a page
3433 % The same set of arguments for:
3435 % @oddheadingmarks
3436 % @evenfootingmarks
3437 % @oddfootingmarks
3438 % @everyheadingmarks
3439 % @everyfootingmarks
3441 \def\evenheadingmarks{\headingmarks{even}{heading}}
3442 \def\oddheadingmarks{\headingmarks{odd}{heading}}
3443 \def\evenfootingmarks{\headingmarks{even}{footing}}
3444 \def\oddfootingmarks{\headingmarks{odd}{footing}}
3445 \def\everyheadingmarks#1 {\headingmarks{even}{heading}{#1}
3446 \headingmarks{odd}{heading}{#1} }
3447 \def\everyfootingmarks#1 {\headingmarks{even}{footing}{#1}
3448 \headingmarks{odd}{footing}{#1} }
3449 % #1 = even/odd, #2 = heading/footing, #3 = top/bottom.
3450 \def\headingmarks#1#2#3 {%
3451 \expandafter\let\expandafter\temp \csname get#3headingmarks\endcsname
3452 \global\expandafter\let\csname get#1#2marks\endcsname \temp
3455 \everyheadingmarks bottom
3456 \everyfootingmarks bottom
3458 % @headings double turns headings on for double-sided printing.
3459 % @headings single turns headings on for single-sided printing.
3460 % @headings off turns them off.
3461 % @headings on same as @headings double, retained for compatibility.
3462 % @headings after turns on double-sided headings after this page.
3463 % @headings doubleafter turns on double-sided headings after this page.
3464 % @headings singleafter turns on single-sided headings after this page.
3465 % By default, they are off at the start of a document,
3466 % and turned `on' after @end titlepage.
3468 \def\headings #1 {\csname HEADINGS#1\endcsname}
3470 \def\headingsoff{% non-global headings elimination
3471 \evenheadline={\hfil}\evenfootline={\hfil}%
3472 \oddheadline={\hfil}\oddfootline={\hfil}%
3475 \def\HEADINGSoff{{\globaldefs=1 \headingsoff}} % global setting
3476 \HEADINGSoff % it's the default
3478 % When we turn headings on, set the page number to 1.
3479 % For double-sided printing, put current file name in lower left corner,
3480 % chapter name on inside top of right hand pages, document
3481 % title on inside top of left hand pages, and page numbers on outside top
3482 % edge of all pages.
3483 \def\HEADINGSdouble{%
3484 \global\pageno=1
3485 \global\evenfootline={\hfil}
3486 \global\oddfootline={\hfil}
3487 \global\evenheadline={\line{\folio\hfil\thistitle}}
3488 \global\oddheadline={\line{\thischapter\hfil\folio}}
3489 \global\let\contentsalignmacro = \chapoddpage
3491 \let\contentsalignmacro = \chappager
3493 % For single-sided printing, chapter title goes across top left of page,
3494 % page number on top right.
3495 \def\HEADINGSsingle{%
3496 \global\pageno=1
3497 \global\evenfootline={\hfil}
3498 \global\oddfootline={\hfil}
3499 \global\evenheadline={\line{\thischapter\hfil\folio}}
3500 \global\oddheadline={\line{\thischapter\hfil\folio}}
3501 \global\let\contentsalignmacro = \chappager
3503 \def\HEADINGSon{\HEADINGSdouble}
3505 \def\HEADINGSafter{\let\HEADINGShook=\HEADINGSdoublex}
3506 \let\HEADINGSdoubleafter=\HEADINGSafter
3507 \def\HEADINGSdoublex{%
3508 \global\evenfootline={\hfil}
3509 \global\oddfootline={\hfil}
3510 \global\evenheadline={\line{\folio\hfil\thistitle}}
3511 \global\oddheadline={\line{\thischapter\hfil\folio}}
3512 \global\let\contentsalignmacro = \chapoddpage
3515 \def\HEADINGSsingleafter{\let\HEADINGShook=\HEADINGSsinglex}
3516 \def\HEADINGSsinglex{%
3517 \global\evenfootline={\hfil}
3518 \global\oddfootline={\hfil}
3519 \global\evenheadline={\line{\thischapter\hfil\folio}}
3520 \global\oddheadline={\line{\thischapter\hfil\folio}}
3521 \global\let\contentsalignmacro = \chappager
3524 % Subroutines used in generating headings
3525 % This produces Day Month Year style of output.
3526 % Only define if not already defined, in case a txi-??.tex file has set
3527 % up a different format (e.g., txi-cs.tex does this).
3528 \ifx\today\thisisundefined
3529 \def\today{%
3530 \number\day\space
3531 \ifcase\month
3532 \or\putwordMJan\or\putwordMFeb\or\putwordMMar\or\putwordMApr
3533 \or\putwordMMay\or\putwordMJun\or\putwordMJul\or\putwordMAug
3534 \or\putwordMSep\or\putwordMOct\or\putwordMNov\or\putwordMDec
3536 \space\number\year}
3539 % @settitle line... specifies the title of the document, for headings.
3540 % It generates no output of its own.
3541 \def\thistitle{\putwordNoTitle}
3542 \def\settitle{\parsearg{\gdef\thistitle}}
3545 \message{tables,}
3546 % Tables -- @table, @ftable, @vtable, @item(x).
3548 % default indentation of table text
3549 \newdimen\tableindent \tableindent=.8in
3550 % default indentation of @itemize and @enumerate text
3551 \newdimen\itemindent \itemindent=.3in
3552 % margin between end of table item and start of table text.
3553 \newdimen\itemmargin \itemmargin=.1in
3555 % used internally for \itemindent minus \itemmargin
3556 \newdimen\itemmax
3558 % Note @table, @ftable, and @vtable define @item, @itemx, etc., with
3559 % these defs.
3560 % They also define \itemindex
3561 % to index the item name in whatever manner is desired (perhaps none).
3563 \newif\ifitemxneedsnegativevskip
3565 \def\itemxpar{\par\ifitemxneedsnegativevskip\nobreak\vskip-\parskip\nobreak\fi}
3567 \def\internalBitem{\smallbreak \parsearg\itemzzz}
3568 \def\internalBitemx{\itemxpar \parsearg\itemzzz}
3570 \def\itemzzz #1{\begingroup %
3571 \advance\hsize by -\rightskip
3572 \advance\hsize by -\tableindent
3573 \setbox0=\hbox{\itemindicate{#1}}%
3574 \itemindex{#1}%
3575 \nobreak % This prevents a break before @itemx.
3577 % If the item text does not fit in the space we have, put it on a line
3578 % by itself, and do not allow a page break either before or after that
3579 % line. We do not start a paragraph here because then if the next
3580 % command is, e.g., @kindex, the whatsit would get put into the
3581 % horizontal list on a line by itself, resulting in extra blank space.
3582 \ifdim \wd0>\itemmax
3584 % Make this a paragraph so we get the \parskip glue and wrapping,
3585 % but leave it ragged-right.
3586 \begingroup
3587 \advance\leftskip by-\tableindent
3588 \advance\hsize by\tableindent
3589 \advance\rightskip by0pt plus1fil\relax
3590 \leavevmode\unhbox0\par
3591 \endgroup
3593 % We're going to be starting a paragraph, but we don't want the
3594 % \parskip glue -- logically it's part of the @item we just started.
3595 \nobreak \vskip-\parskip
3597 % Stop a page break at the \parskip glue coming up. However, if
3598 % what follows is an environment such as @example, there will be no
3599 % \parskip glue; then the negative vskip we just inserted would
3600 % cause the example and the item to crash together. So we use this
3601 % bizarre value of 10001 as a signal to \aboveenvbreak to insert
3602 % \parskip glue after all. Section titles are handled this way also.
3604 \penalty 10001
3605 \endgroup
3606 \itemxneedsnegativevskipfalse
3607 \else
3608 % The item text fits into the space. Start a paragraph, so that the
3609 % following text (if any) will end up on the same line.
3610 \noindent
3611 % Do this with kerns and \unhbox so that if there is a footnote in
3612 % the item text, it can migrate to the main vertical list and
3613 % eventually be printed.
3614 \nobreak\kern-\tableindent
3615 \dimen0 = \itemmax \advance\dimen0 by \itemmargin \advance\dimen0 by -\wd0
3616 \unhbox0
3617 \nobreak\kern\dimen0
3618 \endgroup
3619 \itemxneedsnegativevskiptrue
3623 \def\item{\errmessage{@item while not in a list environment}}
3624 \def\itemx{\errmessage{@itemx while not in a list environment}}
3626 % @table, @ftable, @vtable.
3627 \envdef\table{%
3628 \let\itemindex\gobble
3629 \tablecheck{table}%
3631 \envdef\ftable{%
3632 \def\itemindex ##1{\doind {fn}{\code{##1}}}%
3633 \tablecheck{ftable}%
3635 \envdef\vtable{%
3636 \def\itemindex ##1{\doind {vr}{\code{##1}}}%
3637 \tablecheck{vtable}%
3639 \def\tablecheck#1{%
3640 \ifnum \the\catcode`\^^M=\active
3641 \endgroup
3642 \errmessage{This command won't work in this context; perhaps the problem is
3643 that we are \inenvironment\thisenv}%
3644 \def\next{\doignore{#1}}%
3645 \else
3646 \let\next\tablex
3648 \next
3650 \def\tablex#1{%
3651 \def\itemindicate{#1}%
3652 \parsearg\tabley
3654 \def\tabley#1{%
3656 \makevalueexpandable
3657 \edef\temp{\noexpand\tablez #1\space\space\space}%
3658 \expandafter
3659 }\temp \endtablez
3661 \def\tablez #1 #2 #3 #4\endtablez{%
3662 \aboveenvbreak
3663 \ifnum 0#1>0 \advance \leftskip by #1\mil \fi
3664 \ifnum 0#2>0 \tableindent=#2\mil \fi
3665 \ifnum 0#3>0 \advance \rightskip by #3\mil \fi
3666 \itemmax=\tableindent
3667 \advance \itemmax by -\itemmargin
3668 \advance \leftskip by \tableindent
3669 \exdentamount=\tableindent
3670 \parindent = 0pt
3671 \parskip = \smallskipamount
3672 \ifdim \parskip=0pt \parskip=2pt \fi
3673 \let\item = \internalBitem
3674 \let\itemx = \internalBitemx
3676 \def\Etable{\endgraf\afterenvbreak}
3677 \let\Eftable\Etable
3678 \let\Evtable\Etable
3679 \let\Eitemize\Etable
3680 \let\Eenumerate\Etable
3682 % This is the counter used by @enumerate, which is really @itemize
3684 \newcount \itemno
3686 \envdef\itemize{\parsearg\doitemize}
3688 \def\doitemize#1{%
3689 \aboveenvbreak
3690 \itemmax=\itemindent
3691 \advance\itemmax by -\itemmargin
3692 \advance\leftskip by \itemindent
3693 \exdentamount=\itemindent
3694 \parindent=0pt
3695 \parskip=\smallskipamount
3696 \ifdim\parskip=0pt \parskip=2pt \fi
3698 % Try typesetting the item mark so that if the document erroneously says
3699 % something like @itemize @samp (intending @table), there's an error
3700 % right away at the @itemize. It's not the best error message in the
3701 % world, but it's better than leaving it to the @item. This means if
3702 % the user wants an empty mark, they have to say @w{} not just @w.
3703 \def\itemcontents{#1}%
3704 \setbox0 = \hbox{\itemcontents}%
3706 % @itemize with no arg is equivalent to @itemize @bullet.
3707 \ifx\itemcontents\empty\def\itemcontents{\bullet}\fi
3709 \let\item=\itemizeitem
3712 % Definition of @item while inside @itemize and @enumerate.
3714 \def\itemizeitem{%
3715 \advance\itemno by 1 % for enumerations
3716 {\let\par=\endgraf \smallbreak}% reasonable place to break
3718 % If the document has an @itemize directly after a section title, a
3719 % \nobreak will be last on the list, and \sectionheading will have
3720 % done a \vskip-\parskip. In that case, we don't want to zero
3721 % parskip, or the item text will crash with the heading. On the
3722 % other hand, when there is normal text preceding the item (as there
3723 % usually is), we do want to zero parskip, or there would be too much
3724 % space. In that case, we won't have a \nobreak before. At least
3725 % that's the theory.
3726 \ifnum\lastpenalty<10000 \parskip=0in \fi
3727 \noindent
3728 \hbox to 0pt{\hss \itemcontents \kern\itemmargin}%
3730 \vadjust{\penalty 1200}}% not good to break after first line of item.
3731 \flushcr
3734 % \splitoff TOKENS\endmark defines \first to be the first token in
3735 % TOKENS, and \rest to be the remainder.
3737 \def\splitoff#1#2\endmark{\def\first{#1}\def\rest{#2}}%
3739 % Allow an optional argument of an uppercase letter, lowercase letter,
3740 % or number, to specify the first label in the enumerated list. No
3741 % argument is the same as `1'.
3743 \envparseargdef\enumerate{\enumeratey #1 \endenumeratey}
3744 \def\enumeratey #1 #2\endenumeratey{%
3745 % If we were given no argument, pretend we were given `1'.
3746 \def\thearg{#1}%
3747 \ifx\thearg\empty \def\thearg{1}\fi
3749 % Detect if the argument is a single token. If so, it might be a
3750 % letter. Otherwise, the only valid thing it can be is a number.
3751 % (We will always have one token, because of the test we just made.
3752 % This is a good thing, since \splitoff doesn't work given nothing at
3753 % all -- the first parameter is undelimited.)
3754 \expandafter\splitoff\thearg\endmark
3755 \ifx\rest\empty
3756 % Only one token in the argument. It could still be anything.
3757 % A ``lowercase letter'' is one whose \lccode is nonzero.
3758 % An ``uppercase letter'' is one whose \lccode is both nonzero, and
3759 % not equal to itself.
3760 % Otherwise, we assume it's a number.
3762 % We need the \relax at the end of the \ifnum lines to stop TeX from
3763 % continuing to look for a <number>.
3765 \ifnum\lccode\expandafter`\thearg=0\relax
3766 \numericenumerate % a number (we hope)
3767 \else
3768 % It's a letter.
3769 \ifnum\lccode\expandafter`\thearg=\expandafter`\thearg\relax
3770 \lowercaseenumerate % lowercase letter
3771 \else
3772 \uppercaseenumerate % uppercase letter
3775 \else
3776 % Multiple tokens in the argument. We hope it's a number.
3777 \numericenumerate
3781 % An @enumerate whose labels are integers. The starting integer is
3782 % given in \thearg.
3784 \def\numericenumerate{%
3785 \itemno = \thearg
3786 \startenumeration{\the\itemno}%
3789 % The starting (lowercase) letter is in \thearg.
3790 \def\lowercaseenumerate{%
3791 \itemno = \expandafter`\thearg
3792 \startenumeration{%
3793 % Be sure we're not beyond the end of the alphabet.
3794 \ifnum\itemno=0
3795 \errmessage{No more lowercase letters in @enumerate; get a bigger
3796 alphabet}%
3798 \char\lccode\itemno
3802 % The starting (uppercase) letter is in \thearg.
3803 \def\uppercaseenumerate{%
3804 \itemno = \expandafter`\thearg
3805 \startenumeration{%
3806 % Be sure we're not beyond the end of the alphabet.
3807 \ifnum\itemno=0
3808 \errmessage{No more uppercase letters in @enumerate; get a bigger
3809 alphabet}
3811 \char\uccode\itemno
3815 % Call \doitemize, adding a period to the first argument and supplying the
3816 % common last two arguments. Also subtract one from the initial value in
3817 % \itemno, since @item increments \itemno.
3819 \def\startenumeration#1{%
3820 \advance\itemno by -1
3821 \doitemize{#1.}\flushcr
3824 % @alphaenumerate and @capsenumerate are abbreviations for giving an arg
3825 % to @enumerate.
3827 \def\alphaenumerate{\enumerate{a}}
3828 \def\capsenumerate{\enumerate{A}}
3829 \def\Ealphaenumerate{\Eenumerate}
3830 \def\Ecapsenumerate{\Eenumerate}
3833 % @multitable macros
3834 % Amy Hendrickson, 8/18/94, 3/6/96
3836 % @multitable ... @end multitable will make as many columns as desired.
3837 % Contents of each column will wrap at width given in preamble. Width
3838 % can be specified either with sample text given in a template line,
3839 % or in percent of \hsize, the current width of text on page.
3841 % Table can continue over pages but will only break between lines.
3843 % To make preamble:
3845 % Either define widths of columns in terms of percent of \hsize:
3846 % @multitable @columnfractions .25 .3 .45
3847 % @item ...
3849 % Numbers following @columnfractions are the percent of the total
3850 % current hsize to be used for each column. You may use as many
3851 % columns as desired.
3854 % Or use a template:
3855 % @multitable {Column 1 template} {Column 2 template} {Column 3 template}
3856 % @item ...
3857 % using the widest term desired in each column.
3859 % Each new table line starts with @item, each subsequent new column
3860 % starts with @tab. Empty columns may be produced by supplying @tab's
3861 % with nothing between them for as many times as empty columns are needed,
3862 % ie, @tab@tab@tab will produce two empty columns.
3864 % @item, @tab do not need to be on their own lines, but it will not hurt
3865 % if they are.
3867 % Sample multitable:
3869 % @multitable {Column 1 template} {Column 2 template} {Column 3 template}
3870 % @item first col stuff @tab second col stuff @tab third col
3871 % @item
3872 % first col stuff
3873 % @tab
3874 % second col stuff
3875 % @tab
3876 % third col
3877 % @item first col stuff @tab second col stuff
3878 % @tab Many paragraphs of text may be used in any column.
3880 % They will wrap at the width determined by the template.
3881 % @item@tab@tab This will be in third column.
3882 % @end multitable
3884 % Default dimensions may be reset by user.
3885 % @multitableparskip is vertical space between paragraphs in table.
3886 % @multitableparindent is paragraph indent in table.
3887 % @multitablecolmargin is horizontal space to be left between columns.
3888 % @multitablelinespace is space to leave between table items, baseline
3889 % to baseline.
3890 % 0pt means it depends on current normal line spacing.
3892 \newskip\multitableparskip
3893 \newskip\multitableparindent
3894 \newdimen\multitablecolspace
3895 \newskip\multitablelinespace
3896 \multitableparskip=0pt
3897 \multitableparindent=6pt
3898 \multitablecolspace=12pt
3899 \multitablelinespace=0pt
3901 % Macros used to set up halign preamble:
3903 \let\endsetuptable\relax
3904 \def\xendsetuptable{\endsetuptable}
3905 \let\columnfractions\relax
3906 \def\xcolumnfractions{\columnfractions}
3907 \newif\ifsetpercent
3909 % #1 is the @columnfraction, usually a decimal number like .5, but might
3910 % be just 1. We just use it, whatever it is.
3912 \def\pickupwholefraction#1 {%
3913 \global\advance\colcount by 1
3914 \expandafter\xdef\csname col\the\colcount\endcsname{#1\hsize}%
3915 \setuptable
3918 \newcount\colcount
3919 \def\setuptable#1{%
3920 \def\firstarg{#1}%
3921 \ifx\firstarg\xendsetuptable
3922 \let\go = \relax
3923 \else
3924 \ifx\firstarg\xcolumnfractions
3925 \global\setpercenttrue
3926 \else
3927 \ifsetpercent
3928 \let\go\pickupwholefraction
3929 \else
3930 \global\advance\colcount by 1
3931 \setbox0=\hbox{#1\unskip\space}% Add a normal word space as a
3932 % separator; typically that is always in the input, anyway.
3933 \expandafter\xdef\csname col\the\colcount\endcsname{\the\wd0}%
3936 \ifx\go\pickupwholefraction
3937 % Put the argument back for the \pickupwholefraction call, so
3938 % we'll always have a period there to be parsed.
3939 \def\go{\pickupwholefraction#1}%
3940 \else
3941 \let\go = \setuptable
3942 \fi%
3947 % multitable-only commands.
3949 % @headitem starts a heading row, which we typeset in bold. Assignments
3950 % have to be global since we are inside the implicit group of an
3951 % alignment entry. \everycr below resets \everytab so we don't have to
3952 % undo it ourselves.
3953 \def\headitemfont{\b}% for people to use in the template row; not changeable
3954 \def\headitem{%
3955 \checkenv\multitable
3956 \crcr
3957 \gdef\headitemcrhook{\nobreak}% attempt to avoid page break after headings
3958 \global\everytab={\bf}% can't use \headitemfont since the parsing differs
3959 \the\everytab % for the first item
3962 % default for tables with no headings.
3963 \let\headitemcrhook=\relax
3965 % A \tab used to include \hskip1sp. But then the space in a template
3966 % line is not enough. That is bad. So let's go back to just `&' until
3967 % we again encounter the problem the 1sp was intended to solve.
3968 % --karl, nathan@acm.org, 20apr99.
3969 \def\tab{\checkenv\multitable &\the\everytab}%
3971 % @multitable ... @end multitable definitions:
3973 \newtoks\everytab % insert after every tab.
3975 \envdef\multitable{%
3976 \vskip\parskip
3977 \startsavinginserts
3979 % @item within a multitable starts a normal row.
3980 % We use \def instead of \let so that if one of the multitable entries
3981 % contains an @itemize, we don't choke on the \item (seen as \crcr aka
3982 % \endtemplate) expanding \doitemize.
3983 \def\item{\crcr}%
3985 \tolerance=9500
3986 \hbadness=9500
3987 \setmultitablespacing
3988 \parskip=\multitableparskip
3989 \parindent=\multitableparindent
3990 \overfullrule=0pt
3991 \global\colcount=0
3993 \everycr = {%
3994 \noalign{%
3995 \global\everytab={}% Reset from possible headitem.
3996 \global\colcount=0 % Reset the column counter.
3998 % Check for saved footnotes, etc.:
3999 \checkinserts
4001 % Perhaps a \nobreak, then reset:
4002 \headitemcrhook
4003 \global\let\headitemcrhook=\relax
4007 \parsearg\domultitable
4009 \def\domultitable#1{%
4010 % To parse everything between @multitable and @item:
4011 \setuptable#1 \endsetuptable
4013 % This preamble sets up a generic column definition, which will
4014 % be used as many times as user calls for columns.
4015 % \vtop will set a single line and will also let text wrap and
4016 % continue for many paragraphs if desired.
4017 \halign\bgroup &%
4018 \global\advance\colcount by 1
4019 \multistrut
4020 \vtop{%
4021 % Use the current \colcount to find the correct column width:
4022 \hsize=\expandafter\csname col\the\colcount\endcsname
4024 % In order to keep entries from bumping into each other
4025 % we will add a \leftskip of \multitablecolspace to all columns after
4026 % the first one.
4028 % If a template has been used, we will add \multitablecolspace
4029 % to the width of each template entry.
4031 % If the user has set preamble in terms of percent of \hsize we will
4032 % use that dimension as the width of the column, and the \leftskip
4033 % will keep entries from bumping into each other. Table will start at
4034 % left margin and final column will justify at right margin.
4036 % Make sure we don't inherit \rightskip from the outer environment.
4037 \rightskip=0pt
4038 \ifnum\colcount=1
4039 % The first column will be indented with the surrounding text.
4040 \advance\hsize by\leftskip
4041 \else
4042 \ifsetpercent \else
4043 % If user has not set preamble in terms of percent of \hsize
4044 % we will advance \hsize by \multitablecolspace.
4045 \advance\hsize by \multitablecolspace
4047 % In either case we will make \leftskip=\multitablecolspace:
4048 \leftskip=\multitablecolspace
4050 % Ignoring space at the beginning and end avoids an occasional spurious
4051 % blank line, when TeX decides to break the line at the space before the
4052 % box from the multistrut, so the strut ends up on a line by itself.
4053 % For example:
4054 % @multitable @columnfractions .11 .89
4055 % @item @code{#}
4056 % @tab Legal holiday which is valid in major parts of the whole country.
4057 % Is automatically provided with highlighting sequences respectively
4058 % marking characters.
4059 \noindent\ignorespaces##\unskip\multistrut
4060 }\cr
4062 \def\Emultitable{%
4063 \crcr
4064 \egroup % end the \halign
4065 \global\setpercentfalse
4068 \def\setmultitablespacing{%
4069 \def\multistrut{\strut}% just use the standard line spacing
4071 % Compute \multitablelinespace (if not defined by user) for use in
4072 % \multitableparskip calculation. We used define \multistrut based on
4073 % this, but (ironically) that caused the spacing to be off.
4074 % See bug-texinfo report from Werner Lemberg, 31 Oct 2004 12:52:20 +0100.
4075 \ifdim\multitablelinespace=0pt
4076 \setbox0=\vbox{X}\global\multitablelinespace=\the\baselineskip
4077 \global\advance\multitablelinespace by-\ht0
4079 % Test to see if parskip is larger than space between lines of
4080 % table. If not, do nothing.
4081 % If so, set to same dimension as multitablelinespace.
4082 \ifdim\multitableparskip>\multitablelinespace
4083 \global\multitableparskip=\multitablelinespace
4084 \global\advance\multitableparskip-7pt % to keep parskip somewhat smaller
4085 % than skip between lines in the table.
4086 \fi%
4087 \ifdim\multitableparskip=0pt
4088 \global\multitableparskip=\multitablelinespace
4089 \global\advance\multitableparskip-7pt % to keep parskip somewhat smaller
4090 % than skip between lines in the table.
4091 \fi}
4094 \message{conditionals,}
4096 % @iftex, @ifnotdocbook, @ifnothtml, @ifnotinfo, @ifnotplaintext,
4097 % @ifnotxml always succeed. They currently do nothing; we don't
4098 % attempt to check whether the conditionals are properly nested. But we
4099 % have to remember that they are conditionals, so that @end doesn't
4100 % attempt to close an environment group.
4102 \def\makecond#1{%
4103 \expandafter\let\csname #1\endcsname = \relax
4104 \expandafter\let\csname iscond.#1\endcsname = 1
4106 \makecond{iftex}
4107 \makecond{ifnotdocbook}
4108 \makecond{ifnothtml}
4109 \makecond{ifnotinfo}
4110 \makecond{ifnotplaintext}
4111 \makecond{ifnotxml}
4113 % Ignore @ignore, @ifhtml, @ifinfo, and the like.
4115 \def\direntry{\doignore{direntry}}
4116 \def\documentdescription{\doignore{documentdescription}}
4117 \def\docbook{\doignore{docbook}}
4118 \def\html{\doignore{html}}
4119 \def\ifdocbook{\doignore{ifdocbook}}
4120 \def\ifhtml{\doignore{ifhtml}}
4121 \def\ifinfo{\doignore{ifinfo}}
4122 \def\ifnottex{\doignore{ifnottex}}
4123 \def\ifplaintext{\doignore{ifplaintext}}
4124 \def\ifxml{\doignore{ifxml}}
4125 \def\ignore{\doignore{ignore}}
4126 \def\menu{\doignore{menu}}
4127 \def\xml{\doignore{xml}}
4129 % Ignore text until a line `@end #1', keeping track of nested conditionals.
4131 % A count to remember the depth of nesting.
4132 \newcount\doignorecount
4134 \def\doignore#1{\begingroup
4135 % Scan in ``verbatim'' mode:
4136 \obeylines
4137 \catcode`\@ = \other
4138 \catcode`\{ = \other
4139 \catcode`\} = \other
4141 % Make sure that spaces turn into tokens that match what \doignoretext wants.
4142 \spaceisspace
4144 % Count number of #1's that we've seen.
4145 \doignorecount = 0
4147 % Swallow text until we reach the matching `@end #1'.
4148 \dodoignore{#1}%
4151 { \catcode`_=11 % We want to use \_STOP_ which cannot appear in texinfo source.
4152 \obeylines %
4154 \gdef\dodoignore#1{%
4155 % #1 contains the command name as a string, e.g., `ifinfo'.
4157 % Define a command to find the next `@end #1'.
4158 \long\def\doignoretext##1^^M@end #1{%
4159 \doignoretextyyy##1^^M@#1\_STOP_}%
4161 % And this command to find another #1 command, at the beginning of a
4162 % line. (Otherwise, we would consider a line `@c @ifset', for
4163 % example, to count as an @ifset for nesting.)
4164 \long\def\doignoretextyyy##1^^M@#1##2\_STOP_{\doignoreyyy{##2}\_STOP_}%
4166 % And now expand that command.
4167 \doignoretext ^^M%
4171 \def\doignoreyyy#1{%
4172 \def\temp{#1}%
4173 \ifx\temp\empty % Nothing found.
4174 \let\next\doignoretextzzz
4175 \else % Found a nested condition, ...
4176 \advance\doignorecount by 1
4177 \let\next\doignoretextyyy % ..., look for another.
4178 % If we're here, #1 ends with ^^M\ifinfo (for example).
4180 \next #1% the token \_STOP_ is present just after this macro.
4183 % We have to swallow the remaining "\_STOP_".
4185 \def\doignoretextzzz#1{%
4186 \ifnum\doignorecount = 0 % We have just found the outermost @end.
4187 \let\next\enddoignore
4188 \else % Still inside a nested condition.
4189 \advance\doignorecount by -1
4190 \let\next\doignoretext % Look for the next @end.
4192 \next
4195 % Finish off ignored text.
4196 { \obeylines%
4197 % Ignore anything after the last `@end #1'; this matters in verbatim
4198 % environments, where otherwise the newline after an ignored conditional
4199 % would result in a blank line in the output.
4200 \gdef\enddoignore#1^^M{\endgroup\ignorespaces}%
4204 % @set VAR sets the variable VAR to an empty value.
4205 % @set VAR REST-OF-LINE sets VAR to the value REST-OF-LINE.
4207 % Since we want to separate VAR from REST-OF-LINE (which might be
4208 % empty), we can't just use \parsearg; we have to insert a space of our
4209 % own to delimit the rest of the line, and then take it out again if we
4210 % didn't need it.
4211 % We rely on the fact that \parsearg sets \catcode`\ =10.
4213 \parseargdef\set{\setyyy#1 \endsetyyy}
4214 \def\setyyy#1 #2\endsetyyy{%
4216 \makevalueexpandable
4217 \def\temp{#2}%
4218 \edef\next{\gdef\makecsname{SET#1}}%
4219 \ifx\temp\empty
4220 \next{}%
4221 \else
4222 \setzzz#2\endsetzzz
4226 % Remove the trailing space \setxxx inserted.
4227 \def\setzzz#1 \endsetzzz{\next{#1}}
4229 % @clear VAR clears (i.e., unsets) the variable VAR.
4231 \parseargdef\clear{%
4233 \makevalueexpandable
4234 \global\expandafter\let\csname SET#1\endcsname=\relax
4238 % @value{foo} gets the text saved in variable foo.
4239 \def\value{\begingroup\makevalueexpandable\valuexxx}
4240 \def\valuexxx#1{\expandablevalue{#1}\endgroup}
4242 \catcode`\-=\active \catcode`\_=\active
4244 \gdef\makevalueexpandable{%
4245 \let\value = \expandablevalue
4246 % We don't want these characters active, ...
4247 \catcode`\-=\other \catcode`\_=\other
4248 % ..., but we might end up with active ones in the argument if
4249 % we're called from @code, as @code{@value{foo-bar_}}, though.
4250 % So \let them to their normal equivalents.
4251 \let-\normaldash \let_\normalunderscore
4255 % We have this subroutine so that we can handle at least some @value's
4256 % properly in indexes (we call \makevalueexpandable in \indexdummies).
4257 % The command has to be fully expandable (if the variable is set), since
4258 % the result winds up in the index file. This means that if the
4259 % variable's value contains other Texinfo commands, it's almost certain
4260 % it will fail (although perhaps we could fix that with sufficient work
4261 % to do a one-level expansion on the result, instead of complete).
4263 % Unfortunately, this has the consequence that when _ is in the *value*
4264 % of an @set, it does not print properly in the roman fonts (get the cmr
4265 % dot accent at position 126 instead). No fix comes to mind, and it's
4266 % been this way since 2003 or earlier, so just ignore it.
4268 \def\expandablevalue#1{%
4269 \expandafter\ifx\csname SET#1\endcsname\relax
4270 {[No value for ``#1'']}%
4271 \message{Variable `#1', used in @value, is not set.}%
4272 \else
4273 \csname SET#1\endcsname
4277 % @ifset VAR ... @end ifset reads the `...' iff VAR has been defined
4278 % with @set.
4280 % To get the special treatment we need for `@end ifset,' we call
4281 % \makecond and then redefine.
4283 \makecond{ifset}
4284 \def\ifset{\parsearg{\doifset{\let\next=\ifsetfail}}}
4285 \def\doifset#1#2{%
4287 \makevalueexpandable
4288 \let\next=\empty
4289 \expandafter\ifx\csname SET#2\endcsname\relax
4290 #1% If not set, redefine \next.
4292 \expandafter
4293 }\next
4295 \def\ifsetfail{\doignore{ifset}}
4297 % @ifclear VAR ... @end executes the `...' iff VAR has never been
4298 % defined with @set, or has been undefined with @clear.
4300 % The `\else' inside the `\doifset' parameter is a trick to reuse the
4301 % above code: if the variable is not set, do nothing, if it is set,
4302 % then redefine \next to \ifclearfail.
4304 \makecond{ifclear}
4305 \def\ifclear{\parsearg{\doifset{\else \let\next=\ifclearfail}}}
4306 \def\ifclearfail{\doignore{ifclear}}
4308 % @ifcommandisdefined CMD ... @end executes the `...' if CMD (written
4309 % without the @) is in fact defined. We can only feasibly check at the
4310 % TeX level, so something like `mathcode' is going to considered
4311 % defined even though it is not a Texinfo command.
4313 \makecond{ifcommanddefined}
4314 \def\ifcommanddefined{\parsearg{\doifcmddefined{\let\next=\ifcmddefinedfail}}}
4316 \def\doifcmddefined#1#2{{%
4317 \makevalueexpandable
4318 \let\next=\empty
4319 \expandafter\ifx\csname #2\endcsname\relax
4320 #1% If not defined, \let\next as above.
4322 \expandafter
4323 }\next
4325 \def\ifcmddefinedfail{\doignore{ifcommanddefined}}
4327 % @ifcommandnotdefined CMD ... handled similar to @ifclear above.
4328 \makecond{ifcommandnotdefined}
4329 \def\ifcommandnotdefined{%
4330 \parsearg{\doifcmddefined{\else \let\next=\ifcmdnotdefinedfail}}}
4331 \def\ifcmdnotdefinedfail{\doignore{ifcommandnotdefined}}
4333 % Set the `txicommandconditionals' variable, so documents have a way to
4334 % test if the @ifcommand...defined conditionals are available.
4335 \set txicommandconditionals
4337 % @dircategory CATEGORY -- specify a category of the dir file
4338 % which this file should belong to. Ignore this in TeX.
4339 \let\dircategory=\comment
4341 % @defininfoenclose.
4342 \let\definfoenclose=\comment
4345 \message{indexing,}
4346 % Index generation facilities
4348 % Define \newwrite to be identical to plain tex's \newwrite
4349 % except not \outer, so it can be used within macros and \if's.
4350 \edef\newwrite{\makecsname{ptexnewwrite}}
4352 % \newindex {foo} defines an index named foo.
4353 % It automatically defines \fooindex such that
4354 % \fooindex ...rest of line... puts an entry in the index foo.
4355 % It also defines \fooindfile to be the number of the output channel for
4356 % the file that accumulates this index. The file's extension is foo.
4357 % The name of an index should be no more than 2 characters long
4358 % for the sake of vms.
4360 \def\newindex#1{%
4361 \iflinks
4362 \expandafter\newwrite \csname#1indfile\endcsname
4363 \openout \csname#1indfile\endcsname \jobname.#1 % Open the file
4365 \expandafter\xdef\csname#1index\endcsname{% % Define @#1index
4366 \noexpand\doindex{#1}}
4369 % @defindex foo == \newindex{foo}
4371 \def\defindex{\parsearg\newindex}
4373 % Define @defcodeindex, like @defindex except put all entries in @code.
4375 \def\defcodeindex{\parsearg\newcodeindex}
4377 \def\newcodeindex#1{%
4378 \iflinks
4379 \expandafter\newwrite \csname#1indfile\endcsname
4380 \openout \csname#1indfile\endcsname \jobname.#1
4382 \expandafter\xdef\csname#1index\endcsname{%
4383 \noexpand\docodeindex{#1}}%
4387 % @synindex foo bar makes index foo feed into index bar.
4388 % Do this instead of @defindex foo if you don't want it as a separate index.
4390 % @syncodeindex foo bar similar, but put all entries made for index foo
4391 % inside @code.
4393 \def\synindex#1 #2 {\dosynindex\doindex{#1}{#2}}
4394 \def\syncodeindex#1 #2 {\dosynindex\docodeindex{#1}{#2}}
4396 % #1 is \doindex or \docodeindex, #2 the index getting redefined (foo),
4397 % #3 the target index (bar).
4398 \def\dosynindex#1#2#3{%
4399 % Only do \closeout if we haven't already done it, else we'll end up
4400 % closing the target index.
4401 \expandafter \ifx\csname donesynindex#2\endcsname \relax
4402 % The \closeout helps reduce unnecessary open files; the limit on the
4403 % Acorn RISC OS is a mere 16 files.
4404 \expandafter\closeout\csname#2indfile\endcsname
4405 \expandafter\let\csname donesynindex#2\endcsname = 1
4407 % redefine \fooindfile:
4408 \expandafter\let\expandafter\temp\expandafter=\csname#3indfile\endcsname
4409 \expandafter\let\csname#2indfile\endcsname=\temp
4410 % redefine \fooindex:
4411 \expandafter\xdef\csname#2index\endcsname{\noexpand#1{#3}}%
4414 % Define \doindex, the driver for all \fooindex macros.
4415 % Argument #1 is generated by the calling \fooindex macro,
4416 % and it is "foo", the name of the index.
4418 % \doindex just uses \parsearg; it calls \doind for the actual work.
4419 % This is because \doind is more useful to call from other macros.
4421 % There is also \dosubind {index}{topic}{subtopic}
4422 % which makes an entry in a two-level index such as the operation index.
4424 \def\doindex#1{\edef\indexname{#1}\parsearg\singleindexer}
4425 \def\singleindexer #1{\doind{\indexname}{#1}}
4427 % like the previous two, but they put @code around the argument.
4428 \def\docodeindex#1{\edef\indexname{#1}\parsearg\singlecodeindexer}
4429 \def\singlecodeindexer #1{\doind{\indexname}{\code{#1}}}
4431 % Take care of Texinfo commands that can appear in an index entry.
4432 % Since there are some commands we want to expand, and others we don't,
4433 % we have to laboriously prevent expansion for those that we don't.
4435 \def\indexdummies{%
4436 \escapechar = `\\ % use backslash in output files.
4437 \def\@{@}% change to @@ when we switch to @ as escape char in index files.
4438 \def\ {\realbackslash\space }%
4440 % Need these unexpandable (because we define \tt as a dummy)
4441 % definitions when @{ or @} appear in index entry text. Also, more
4442 % complicated, when \tex is in effect and \{ is a \delimiter again.
4443 % We can't use \lbracecmd and \rbracecmd because texindex assumes
4444 % braces and backslashes are used only as delimiters. Perhaps we
4445 % should use @lbracechar and @rbracechar?
4446 \def\{{{\tt\char123}}%
4447 \def\}{{\tt\char125}}%
4449 % I don't entirely understand this, but when an index entry is
4450 % generated from a macro call, the \endinput which \scanmacro inserts
4451 % causes processing to be prematurely terminated. This is,
4452 % apparently, because \indexsorttmp is fully expanded, and \endinput
4453 % is an expandable command. The redefinition below makes \endinput
4454 % disappear altogether for that purpose -- although logging shows that
4455 % processing continues to some further point. On the other hand, it
4456 % seems \endinput does not hurt in the printed index arg, since that
4457 % is still getting written without apparent harm.
4459 % Sample source (mac-idx3.tex, reported by Graham Percival to
4460 % help-texinfo, 22may06):
4461 % @macro funindex {WORD}
4462 % @findex xyz
4463 % @end macro
4464 % ...
4465 % @funindex commtest
4466 % This is not enough to reproduce the bug, but it gives the flavor.
4468 % Sample whatsit resulting:
4469 % .@write3{\entry{xyz}{@folio }{@code {xyz@endinput }}}
4471 % So:
4472 \let\endinput = \empty
4474 % Do the redefinitions.
4475 \commondummies
4478 % For the aux and toc files, @ is the escape character. So we want to
4479 % redefine everything using @ as the escape character (instead of
4480 % \realbackslash, still used for index files). When everything uses @,
4481 % this will be simpler.
4483 \def\atdummies{%
4484 \def\@{@@}%
4485 \def\ {@ }%
4486 \let\{ = \lbraceatcmd
4487 \let\} = \rbraceatcmd
4489 % Do the redefinitions.
4490 \commondummies
4491 \otherbackslash
4494 % Called from \indexdummies and \atdummies.
4496 \def\commondummies{%
4497 % \definedummyword defines \#1 as \string\#1\space, thus effectively
4498 % preventing its expansion. This is used only for control words,
4499 % not control letters, because the \space would be incorrect for
4500 % control characters, but is needed to separate the control word
4501 % from whatever follows.
4503 % For control letters, we have \definedummyletter, which omits the
4504 % space.
4506 % These can be used both for control words that take an argument and
4507 % those that do not. If it is followed by {arg} in the input, then
4508 % that will dutifully get written to the index (or wherever).
4510 \def\definedummyword ##1{\def##1{\string##1\space}}%
4511 \def\definedummyletter##1{\def##1{\string##1}}%
4512 \let\definedummyaccent\definedummyletter
4514 \commondummiesnofonts
4516 \definedummyletter\_%
4517 \definedummyletter\-%
4519 % Non-English letters.
4520 \definedummyword\AA
4521 \definedummyword\AE
4522 \definedummyword\DH
4523 \definedummyword\L
4524 \definedummyword\O
4525 \definedummyword\OE
4526 \definedummyword\TH
4527 \definedummyword\aa
4528 \definedummyword\ae
4529 \definedummyword\dh
4530 \definedummyword\exclamdown
4531 \definedummyword\l
4532 \definedummyword\o
4533 \definedummyword\oe
4534 \definedummyword\ordf
4535 \definedummyword\ordm
4536 \definedummyword\questiondown
4537 \definedummyword\ss
4538 \definedummyword\th
4540 % Although these internal commands shouldn't show up, sometimes they do.
4541 \definedummyword\bf
4542 \definedummyword\gtr
4543 \definedummyword\hat
4544 \definedummyword\less
4545 \definedummyword\sf
4546 \definedummyword\sl
4547 \definedummyword\tclose
4548 \definedummyword\tt
4550 \definedummyword\LaTeX
4551 \definedummyword\TeX
4553 % Assorted special characters.
4554 \definedummyword\arrow
4555 \definedummyword\bullet
4556 \definedummyword\comma
4557 \definedummyword\copyright
4558 \definedummyword\registeredsymbol
4559 \definedummyword\dots
4560 \definedummyword\enddots
4561 \definedummyword\entrybreak
4562 \definedummyword\equiv
4563 \definedummyword\error
4564 \definedummyword\euro
4565 \definedummyword\expansion
4566 \definedummyword\geq
4567 \definedummyword\guillemetleft
4568 \definedummyword\guillemetright
4569 \definedummyword\guilsinglleft
4570 \definedummyword\guilsinglright
4571 \definedummyword\lbracechar
4572 \definedummyword\leq
4573 \definedummyword\mathopsup
4574 \definedummyword\minus
4575 \definedummyword\ogonek
4576 \definedummyword\pounds
4577 \definedummyword\point
4578 \definedummyword\print
4579 \definedummyword\quotedblbase
4580 \definedummyword\quotedblleft
4581 \definedummyword\quotedblright
4582 \definedummyword\quoteleft
4583 \definedummyword\quoteright
4584 \definedummyword\quotesinglbase
4585 \definedummyword\rbracechar
4586 \definedummyword\result
4587 \definedummyword\sub
4588 \definedummyword\sup
4589 \definedummyword\textdegree
4591 % We want to disable all macros so that they are not expanded by \write.
4592 \macrolist
4594 \normalturnoffactive
4596 % Handle some cases of @value -- where it does not contain any
4597 % (non-fully-expandable) commands.
4598 \makevalueexpandable
4601 % \commondummiesnofonts: common to \commondummies and \indexnofonts.
4603 \def\commondummiesnofonts{%
4604 % Control letters and accents.
4605 \definedummyletter\!%
4606 \definedummyaccent\"%
4607 \definedummyaccent\'%
4608 \definedummyletter\*%
4609 \definedummyaccent\,%
4610 \definedummyletter\.%
4611 \definedummyletter\/%
4612 \definedummyletter\:%
4613 \definedummyaccent\=%
4614 \definedummyletter\?%
4615 \definedummyaccent\^%
4616 \definedummyaccent\`%
4617 \definedummyaccent\~%
4618 \definedummyword\u
4619 \definedummyword\v
4620 \definedummyword\H
4621 \definedummyword\dotaccent
4622 \definedummyword\ogonek
4623 \definedummyword\ringaccent
4624 \definedummyword\tieaccent
4625 \definedummyword\ubaraccent
4626 \definedummyword\udotaccent
4627 \definedummyword\dotless
4629 % Texinfo font commands.
4630 \definedummyword\b
4631 \definedummyword\i
4632 \definedummyword\r
4633 \definedummyword\sansserif
4634 \definedummyword\sc
4635 \definedummyword\slanted
4636 \definedummyword\t
4638 % Commands that take arguments.
4639 \definedummyword\abbr
4640 \definedummyword\acronym
4641 \definedummyword\anchor
4642 \definedummyword\cite
4643 \definedummyword\code
4644 \definedummyword\command
4645 \definedummyword\dfn
4646 \definedummyword\dmn
4647 \definedummyword\email
4648 \definedummyword\emph
4649 \definedummyword\env
4650 \definedummyword\file
4651 \definedummyword\image
4652 \definedummyword\indicateurl
4653 \definedummyword\inforef
4654 \definedummyword\kbd
4655 \definedummyword\key
4656 \definedummyword\math
4657 \definedummyword\option
4658 \definedummyword\pxref
4659 \definedummyword\ref
4660 \definedummyword\samp
4661 \definedummyword\strong
4662 \definedummyword\tie
4663 \definedummyword\U
4664 \definedummyword\uref
4665 \definedummyword\url
4666 \definedummyword\var
4667 \definedummyword\verb
4668 \definedummyword\w
4669 \definedummyword\xref
4671 % Consider:
4672 % @macro mkind{arg1,arg2}
4673 % @cindex \arg2\
4674 % @end macro
4675 % @mkind{foo, bar}
4676 % The space after the comma will end up in the temporary definition
4677 % that we make for arg2 (see \parsemargdef ff.). We want all this to be
4678 % expanded for the sake of the index, so we end up just seeing "bar".
4679 \let\xeatspaces = \eatspaces
4682 % For testing: output @{ and @} in index sort strings as \{ and \}.
4683 \newif\ifusebracesinindexes
4685 % \indexnofonts is used when outputting the strings to sort the index
4686 % by, and when constructing control sequence names. It eliminates all
4687 % control sequences and just writes whatever the best ASCII sort string
4688 % would be for a given command (usually its argument).
4690 \def\indexnofonts{%
4691 % Accent commands should become @asis.
4692 \def\definedummyaccent##1{\let##1\asis}%
4693 % We can just ignore other control letters.
4694 \def\definedummyletter##1{\let##1\empty}%
4695 % All control words become @asis by default; overrides below.
4696 \let\definedummyword\definedummyaccent
4698 \commondummiesnofonts
4700 % Don't no-op \tt, since it isn't a user-level command
4701 % and is used in the definitions of the active chars like <, >, |, etc.
4702 % Likewise with the other plain tex font commands.
4703 %\let\tt=\asis
4705 \def\ { }%
4706 \def\@{@}%
4707 \def\_{\normalunderscore}%
4708 \def\-{}% @- shouldn't affect sorting
4710 % Unfortunately, texindex is not prepared to handle braces in the
4711 % content at all. So for index sorting, we map @{ and @} to strings
4712 % starting with |, since that ASCII character is between ASCII { and }.
4713 \ifusebracesinindexes
4714 \def\lbracechar{\lbracecmd}%
4715 \def\rbracechar{\rbracecmd}%
4716 \else
4717 \def\lbracechar{|a}%
4718 \def\rbracechar{|b}%
4720 \let\{=\lbracechar
4721 \let\}=\rbracechar
4724 % Non-English letters.
4725 \def\AA{AA}%
4726 \def\AE{AE}%
4727 \def\DH{DZZ}%
4728 \def\L{L}%
4729 \def\OE{OE}%
4730 \def\O{O}%
4731 \def\TH{ZZZ}%
4732 \def\aa{aa}%
4733 \def\ae{ae}%
4734 \def\dh{dzz}%
4735 \def\exclamdown{!}%
4736 \def\l{l}%
4737 \def\oe{oe}%
4738 \def\ordf{a}%
4739 \def\ordm{o}%
4740 \def\o{o}%
4741 \def\questiondown{?}%
4742 \def\ss{ss}%
4743 \def\th{zzz}%
4745 \def\LaTeX{LaTeX}%
4746 \def\TeX{TeX}%
4748 % Assorted special characters.
4749 % (The following {} will end up in the sort string, but that's ok.)
4750 \def\arrow{->}%
4751 \def\bullet{bullet}%
4752 \def\comma{,}%
4753 \def\copyright{copyright}%
4754 \def\dots{...}%
4755 \def\enddots{...}%
4756 \def\equiv{==}%
4757 \def\error{error}%
4758 \def\euro{euro}%
4759 \def\expansion{==>}%
4760 \def\geq{>=}%
4761 \def\guillemetleft{<<}%
4762 \def\guillemetright{>>}%
4763 \def\guilsinglleft{<}%
4764 \def\guilsinglright{>}%
4765 \def\leq{<=}%
4766 \def\minus{-}%
4767 \def\point{.}%
4768 \def\pounds{pounds}%
4769 \def\print{-|}%
4770 \def\quotedblbase{"}%
4771 \def\quotedblleft{"}%
4772 \def\quotedblright{"}%
4773 \def\quoteleft{`}%
4774 \def\quoteright{'}%
4775 \def\quotesinglbase{,}%
4776 \def\registeredsymbol{R}%
4777 \def\result{=>}%
4778 \def\textdegree{o}%
4780 \expandafter\ifx\csname SETtxiindexlquoteignore\endcsname\relax
4781 \else \indexlquoteignore \fi
4783 % We need to get rid of all macros, leaving only the arguments (if present).
4784 % Of course this is not nearly correct, but it is the best we can do for now.
4785 % makeinfo does not expand macros in the argument to @deffn, which ends up
4786 % writing an index entry, and texindex isn't prepared for an index sort entry
4787 % that starts with \.
4789 % Since macro invocations are followed by braces, we can just redefine them
4790 % to take a single TeX argument. The case of a macro invocation that
4791 % goes to end-of-line is not handled.
4793 \macrolist
4796 % Undocumented (for FSFS 2nd ed.): @set txiindexlquoteignore makes us
4797 % ignore left quotes in the sort term.
4798 {\catcode`\`=\active
4799 \gdef\indexlquoteignore{\let`=\empty}}
4801 \let\indexbackslash=0 %overridden during \printindex.
4802 \let\SETmarginindex=\relax % put index entries in margin (undocumented)?
4804 % Most index entries go through here, but \dosubind is the general case.
4805 % #1 is the index name, #2 is the entry text.
4806 \def\doind#1#2{\dosubind{#1}{#2}{}}
4808 % Workhorse for all \fooindexes.
4809 % #1 is name of index, #2 is stuff to put there, #3 is subentry --
4810 % empty if called from \doind, as we usually are (the main exception
4811 % is with most defuns, which call us directly).
4813 \def\dosubind#1#2#3{%
4814 \iflinks
4816 % Store the main index entry text (including the third arg).
4817 \toks0 = {#2}%
4818 % If third arg is present, precede it with a space.
4819 \def\thirdarg{#3}%
4820 \ifx\thirdarg\empty \else
4821 \toks0 = \expandafter{\the\toks0 \space #3}%
4824 \edef\writeto{\csname#1indfile\endcsname}%
4826 \safewhatsit\dosubindwrite
4831 % Write the entry in \toks0 to the index file:
4833 \def\dosubindwrite{%
4834 % Put the index entry in the margin if desired.
4835 \ifx\SETmarginindex\relax\else
4836 \insert\margin{\hbox{\vrule height8pt depth3pt width0pt \the\toks0}}%
4839 % Remember, we are within a group.
4840 \indexdummies % Must do this here, since \bf, etc expand at this stage
4841 \def\backslashcurfont{\indexbackslash}% \indexbackslash isn't defined now
4842 % so it will be output as is; and it will print as backslash.
4844 % Process the index entry with all font commands turned off, to
4845 % get the string to sort by.
4846 {\indexnofonts
4847 \edef\temp{\the\toks0}% need full expansion
4848 \xdef\indexsorttmp{\temp}%
4851 % Set up the complete index entry, with both the sort key and
4852 % the original text, including any font commands. We write
4853 % three arguments to \entry to the .?? file (four in the
4854 % subentry case), texindex reduces to two when writing the .??s
4855 % sorted result.
4856 \edef\temp{%
4857 \write\writeto{%
4858 \string\entry{\indexsorttmp}{\noexpand\folio}{\the\toks0}}%
4860 \temp
4863 % Take care of unwanted page breaks/skips around a whatsit:
4865 % If a skip is the last thing on the list now, preserve it
4866 % by backing up by \lastskip, doing the \write, then inserting
4867 % the skip again. Otherwise, the whatsit generated by the
4868 % \write or \pdfdest will make \lastskip zero. The result is that
4869 % sequences like this:
4870 % @end defun
4871 % @tindex whatever
4872 % @defun ...
4873 % will have extra space inserted, because the \medbreak in the
4874 % start of the @defun won't see the skip inserted by the @end of
4875 % the previous defun.
4877 % But don't do any of this if we're not in vertical mode. We
4878 % don't want to do a \vskip and prematurely end a paragraph.
4880 % Avoid page breaks due to these extra skips, too.
4882 % But wait, there is a catch there:
4883 % We'll have to check whether \lastskip is zero skip. \ifdim is not
4884 % sufficient for this purpose, as it ignores stretch and shrink parts
4885 % of the skip. The only way seems to be to check the textual
4886 % representation of the skip.
4888 % The following is almost like \def\zeroskipmacro{0.0pt} except that
4889 % the ``p'' and ``t'' characters have catcode \other, not 11 (letter).
4891 \edef\zeroskipmacro{\expandafter\the\csname z@skip\endcsname}
4893 \newskip\whatsitskip
4894 \newcount\whatsitpenalty
4896 % ..., ready, GO:
4898 \def\safewhatsit#1{\ifhmode
4900 \else
4901 % \lastskip and \lastpenalty cannot both be nonzero simultaneously.
4902 \whatsitskip = \lastskip
4903 \edef\lastskipmacro{\the\lastskip}%
4904 \whatsitpenalty = \lastpenalty
4906 % If \lastskip is nonzero, that means the last item was a
4907 % skip. And since a skip is discardable, that means this
4908 % -\whatsitskip glue we're inserting is preceded by a
4909 % non-discardable item, therefore it is not a potential
4910 % breakpoint, therefore no \nobreak needed.
4911 \ifx\lastskipmacro\zeroskipmacro
4912 \else
4913 \vskip-\whatsitskip
4918 \ifx\lastskipmacro\zeroskipmacro
4919 % If \lastskip was zero, perhaps the last item was a penalty, and
4920 % perhaps it was >=10000, e.g., a \nobreak. In that case, we want
4921 % to re-insert the same penalty (values >10000 are used for various
4922 % signals); since we just inserted a non-discardable item, any
4923 % following glue (such as a \parskip) would be a breakpoint. For example:
4924 % @deffn deffn-whatever
4925 % @vindex index-whatever
4926 % Description.
4927 % would allow a break between the index-whatever whatsit
4928 % and the "Description." paragraph.
4929 \ifnum\whatsitpenalty>9999 \penalty\whatsitpenalty \fi
4930 \else
4931 % On the other hand, if we had a nonzero \lastskip,
4932 % this make-up glue would be preceded by a non-discardable item
4933 % (the whatsit from the \write), so we must insert a \nobreak.
4934 \nobreak\vskip\whatsitskip
4936 \fi}
4938 % The index entry written in the file actually looks like
4939 % \entry {sortstring}{page}{topic}
4940 % or
4941 % \entry {sortstring}{page}{topic}{subtopic}
4942 % The texindex program reads in these files and writes files
4943 % containing these kinds of lines:
4944 % \initial {c}
4945 % before the first topic whose initial is c
4946 % \entry {topic}{pagelist}
4947 % for a topic that is used without subtopics
4948 % \primary {topic}
4949 % for the beginning of a topic that is used with subtopics
4950 % \secondary {subtopic}{pagelist}
4951 % for each subtopic.
4953 % Define the user-accessible indexing commands
4954 % @findex, @vindex, @kindex, @cindex.
4956 \def\findex {\fnindex}
4957 \def\kindex {\kyindex}
4958 \def\cindex {\cpindex}
4959 \def\vindex {\vrindex}
4960 \def\tindex {\tpindex}
4961 \def\pindex {\pgindex}
4963 \def\cindexsub {\begingroup\obeylines\cindexsub}
4964 {\obeylines %
4965 \gdef\cindexsub "#1" #2^^M{\endgroup %
4966 \dosubind{cp}{#2}{#1}}}
4968 % Define the macros used in formatting output of the sorted index material.
4970 % @printindex causes a particular index (the ??s file) to get printed.
4971 % It does not print any chapter heading (usually an @unnumbered).
4973 \parseargdef\printindex{\begingroup
4974 \dobreak \chapheadingskip{10000}%
4976 \smallfonts \rm
4977 \tolerance = 9500
4978 \plainfrenchspacing
4979 \everypar = {}% don't want the \kern\-parindent from indentation suppression.
4981 % See if the index file exists and is nonempty.
4982 % Change catcode of @ here so that if the index file contains
4983 % \initial {@}
4984 % as its first line, TeX doesn't complain about mismatched braces
4985 % (because it thinks @} is a control sequence).
4986 \catcode`\@ = 11
4987 \openin 1 \jobname.#1s
4988 \ifeof 1
4989 % \enddoublecolumns gets confused if there is no text in the index,
4990 % and it loses the chapter title and the aux file entries for the
4991 % index. The easiest way to prevent this problem is to make sure
4992 % there is some text.
4993 \putwordIndexNonexistent
4994 \else
4996 % If the index file exists but is empty, then \openin leaves \ifeof
4997 % false. We have to make TeX try to read something from the file, so
4998 % it can discover if there is anything in it.
4999 \read 1 to \temp
5000 \ifeof 1
5001 \putwordIndexIsEmpty
5002 \else
5003 % Index files are almost Texinfo source, but we use \ as the escape
5004 % character. It would be better to use @, but that's too big a change
5005 % to make right now.
5006 \def\indexbackslash{\backslashcurfont}%
5007 \catcode`\\ = 0
5008 \escapechar = `\\
5009 \begindoublecolumns
5010 \input \jobname.#1s
5011 \enddoublecolumns
5014 \closein 1
5015 \endgroup}
5017 % These macros are used by the sorted index file itself.
5018 % Change them to control the appearance of the index.
5020 \def\initial#1{{%
5021 % Some minor font changes for the special characters.
5022 \let\tentt=\sectt \let\tt=\sectt \let\sf=\sectt
5024 % Remove any glue we may have, we'll be inserting our own.
5025 \removelastskip
5027 % We like breaks before the index initials, so insert a bonus.
5028 \nobreak
5029 \vskip 0pt plus 3\baselineskip
5030 \penalty 0
5031 \vskip 0pt plus -3\baselineskip
5033 % Typeset the initial. Making this add up to a whole number of
5034 % baselineskips increases the chance of the dots lining up from column
5035 % to column. It still won't often be perfect, because of the stretch
5036 % we need before each entry, but it's better.
5038 % No shrink because it confuses \balancecolumns.
5039 \vskip 1.67\baselineskip plus .5\baselineskip
5040 \leftline{\secbf #1}%
5041 % Do our best not to break after the initial.
5042 \nobreak
5043 \vskip .33\baselineskip plus .1\baselineskip
5046 % \entry typesets a paragraph consisting of the text (#1), dot leaders, and
5047 % then page number (#2) flushed to the right margin. It is used for index
5048 % and table of contents entries. The paragraph is indented by \leftskip.
5050 % A straightforward implementation would start like this:
5051 % \def\entry#1#2{...
5052 % But this freezes the catcodes in the argument, and can cause problems to
5053 % @code, which sets - active. This problem was fixed by a kludge---
5054 % ``-'' was active throughout whole index, but this isn't really right.
5055 % The right solution is to prevent \entry from swallowing the whole text.
5056 % --kasal, 21nov03
5057 \def\entry{%
5058 \begingroup
5060 % Start a new paragraph if necessary, so our assignments below can't
5061 % affect previous text.
5062 \par
5064 % Do not fill out the last line with white space.
5065 \parfillskip = 0in
5067 % No extra space above this paragraph.
5068 \parskip = 0in
5070 % Do not prefer a separate line ending with a hyphen to fewer lines.
5071 \finalhyphendemerits = 0
5073 % \hangindent is only relevant when the entry text and page number
5074 % don't both fit on one line. In that case, bob suggests starting the
5075 % dots pretty far over on the line. Unfortunately, a large
5076 % indentation looks wrong when the entry text itself is broken across
5077 % lines. So we use a small indentation and put up with long leaders.
5079 % \hangafter is reset to 1 (which is the value we want) at the start
5080 % of each paragraph, so we need not do anything with that.
5081 \hangindent = 2em
5083 % When the entry text needs to be broken, just fill out the first line
5084 % with blank space.
5085 \rightskip = 0pt plus1fil
5087 % A bit of stretch before each entry for the benefit of balancing
5088 % columns.
5089 \vskip 0pt plus1pt
5091 % When reading the text of entry, convert explicit line breaks
5092 % from @* into spaces. The user might give these in long section
5093 % titles, for instance.
5094 \def\*{\unskip\space\ignorespaces}%
5095 \def\entrybreak{\hfil\break}%
5097 % Swallow the left brace of the text (first parameter):
5098 \afterassignment\doentry
5099 \let\temp =
5101 \def\entrybreak{\unskip\space\ignorespaces}%
5102 \def\doentry{%
5103 \bgroup % Instead of the swallowed brace.
5104 \noindent
5105 \aftergroup\finishentry
5106 % And now comes the text of the entry.
5108 \def\finishentry#1{%
5109 % #1 is the page number.
5111 % The following is kludged to not output a line of dots in the index if
5112 % there are no page numbers. The next person who breaks this will be
5113 % cursed by a Unix daemon.
5114 \setbox\boxA = \hbox{#1}%
5115 \ifdim\wd\boxA = 0pt
5117 \else
5119 % If we must, put the page number on a line of its own, and fill out
5120 % this line with blank space. (The \hfil is overwhelmed with the
5121 % fill leaders glue in \indexdotfill if the page number does fit.)
5122 \hfil\penalty50
5123 \null\nobreak\indexdotfill % Have leaders before the page number.
5125 % The `\ ' here is removed by the implicit \unskip that TeX does as
5126 % part of (the primitive) \par. Without it, a spurious underfull
5127 % \hbox ensues.
5128 \ifpdf
5129 \pdfgettoks#1.%
5130 \ \the\toksA
5131 \else
5132 \ #1%
5135 \par
5136 \endgroup
5139 % Like plain.tex's \dotfill, except uses up at least 1 em.
5140 \def\indexdotfill{\cleaders
5141 \hbox{$\mathsurround=0pt \mkern1.5mu.\mkern1.5mu$}\hskip 1em plus 1fill}
5143 \def\primary #1{\line{#1\hfil}}
5145 \newskip\secondaryindent \secondaryindent=0.5cm
5146 \def\secondary#1#2{{%
5147 \parfillskip=0in
5148 \parskip=0in
5149 \hangindent=1in
5150 \hangafter=1
5151 \noindent\hskip\secondaryindent\hbox{#1}\indexdotfill
5152 \ifpdf
5153 \pdfgettoks#2.\ \the\toksA % The page number ends the paragraph.
5154 \else
5157 \par
5160 % Define two-column mode, which we use to typeset indexes.
5161 % Adapted from the TeXbook, page 416, which is to say,
5162 % the manmac.tex format used to print the TeXbook itself.
5163 \catcode`\@=11
5165 \newbox\partialpage
5166 \newdimen\doublecolumnhsize
5168 \def\begindoublecolumns{\begingroup % ended by \enddoublecolumns
5169 % Grab any single-column material above us.
5170 \output = {%
5172 % Here is a possibility not foreseen in manmac: if we accumulate a
5173 % whole lot of material, we might end up calling this \output
5174 % routine twice in a row (see the doublecol-lose test, which is
5175 % essentially a couple of indexes with @setchapternewpage off). In
5176 % that case we just ship out what is in \partialpage with the normal
5177 % output routine. Generally, \partialpage will be empty when this
5178 % runs and this will be a no-op. See the indexspread.tex test case.
5179 \ifvoid\partialpage \else
5180 \onepageout{\pagecontents\partialpage}%
5183 \global\setbox\partialpage = \vbox{%
5184 % Unvbox the main output page.
5185 \unvbox\PAGE
5186 \kern-\topskip \kern\baselineskip
5189 \eject % run that output routine to set \partialpage
5191 % Use the double-column output routine for subsequent pages.
5192 \output = {\doublecolumnout}%
5194 % Change the page size parameters. We could do this once outside this
5195 % routine, in each of @smallbook, @afourpaper, and the default 8.5x11
5196 % format, but then we repeat the same computation. Repeating a couple
5197 % of assignments once per index is clearly meaningless for the
5198 % execution time, so we may as well do it in one place.
5200 % First we halve the line length, less a little for the gutter between
5201 % the columns. We compute the gutter based on the line length, so it
5202 % changes automatically with the paper format. The magic constant
5203 % below is chosen so that the gutter has the same value (well, +-<1pt)
5204 % as it did when we hard-coded it.
5206 % We put the result in a separate register, \doublecolumhsize, so we
5207 % can restore it in \pagesofar, after \hsize itself has (potentially)
5208 % been clobbered.
5210 \doublecolumnhsize = \hsize
5211 \advance\doublecolumnhsize by -.04154\hsize
5212 \divide\doublecolumnhsize by 2
5213 \hsize = \doublecolumnhsize
5215 % Double the \vsize as well. (We don't need a separate register here,
5216 % since nobody clobbers \vsize.)
5217 \vsize = 2\vsize
5220 % The double-column output routine for all double-column pages except
5221 % the last.
5223 \def\doublecolumnout{%
5224 \splittopskip=\topskip \splitmaxdepth=\maxdepth
5225 % Get the available space for the double columns -- the normal
5226 % (undoubled) page height minus any material left over from the
5227 % previous page.
5228 \dimen@ = \vsize
5229 \divide\dimen@ by 2
5230 \advance\dimen@ by -\ht\partialpage
5232 % box0 will be the left-hand column, box2 the right.
5233 \setbox0=\vsplit255 to\dimen@ \setbox2=\vsplit255 to\dimen@
5234 \onepageout\pagesofar
5235 \unvbox255
5236 \penalty\outputpenalty
5239 % Re-output the contents of the output page -- any previous material,
5240 % followed by the two boxes we just split, in box0 and box2.
5241 \def\pagesofar{%
5242 \unvbox\partialpage
5244 \hsize = \doublecolumnhsize
5245 \wd0=\hsize \wd2=\hsize
5246 \hbox to\pagewidth{\box0\hfil\box2}%
5249 % All done with double columns.
5250 \def\enddoublecolumns{%
5251 % The following penalty ensures that the page builder is exercised
5252 % _before_ we change the output routine. This is necessary in the
5253 % following situation:
5255 % The last section of the index consists only of a single entry.
5256 % Before this section, \pagetotal is less than \pagegoal, so no
5257 % break occurs before the last section starts. However, the last
5258 % section, consisting of \initial and the single \entry, does not
5259 % fit on the page and has to be broken off. Without the following
5260 % penalty the page builder will not be exercised until \eject
5261 % below, and by that time we'll already have changed the output
5262 % routine to the \balancecolumns version, so the next-to-last
5263 % double-column page will be processed with \balancecolumns, which
5264 % is wrong: The two columns will go to the main vertical list, with
5265 % the broken-off section in the recent contributions. As soon as
5266 % the output routine finishes, TeX starts reconsidering the page
5267 % break. The two columns and the broken-off section both fit on the
5268 % page, because the two columns now take up only half of the page
5269 % goal. When TeX sees \eject from below which follows the final
5270 % section, it invokes the new output routine that we've set after
5271 % \balancecolumns below; \onepageout will try to fit the two columns
5272 % and the final section into the vbox of \pageheight (see
5273 % \pagebody), causing an overfull box.
5275 % Note that glue won't work here, because glue does not exercise the
5276 % page builder, unlike penalties (see The TeXbook, pp. 280-281).
5277 \penalty0
5279 \output = {%
5280 % Split the last of the double-column material. Leave it on the
5281 % current page, no automatic page break.
5282 \balancecolumns
5284 % If we end up splitting too much material for the current page,
5285 % though, there will be another page break right after this \output
5286 % invocation ends. Having called \balancecolumns once, we do not
5287 % want to call it again. Therefore, reset \output to its normal
5288 % definition right away. (We hope \balancecolumns will never be
5289 % called on to balance too much material, but if it is, this makes
5290 % the output somewhat more palatable.)
5291 \global\output = {\onepageout{\pagecontents\PAGE}}%
5293 \eject
5294 \endgroup % started in \begindoublecolumns
5296 % \pagegoal was set to the doubled \vsize above, since we restarted
5297 % the current page. We're now back to normal single-column
5298 % typesetting, so reset \pagegoal to the normal \vsize (after the
5299 % \endgroup where \vsize got restored).
5300 \pagegoal = \vsize
5303 % Called at the end of the double column material.
5304 \def\balancecolumns{%
5305 \setbox0 = \vbox{\unvbox255}% like \box255 but more efficient, see p.120.
5306 \dimen@ = \ht0
5307 \advance\dimen@ by \topskip
5308 \advance\dimen@ by-\baselineskip
5309 \divide\dimen@ by 2 % target to split to
5310 %debug\message{final 2-column material height=\the\ht0, target=\the\dimen@.}%
5311 \splittopskip = \topskip
5312 % Loop until we get a decent breakpoint.
5314 \vbadness = 10000
5315 \loop
5316 \global\setbox3 = \copy0
5317 \global\setbox1 = \vsplit3 to \dimen@
5318 \ifdim\ht3>\dimen@
5319 \global\advance\dimen@ by 1pt
5320 \repeat
5322 %debug\message{split to \the\dimen@, column heights: \the\ht1, \the\ht3.}%
5323 \setbox0=\vbox to\dimen@{\unvbox1}%
5324 \setbox2=\vbox to\dimen@{\unvbox3}%
5326 \pagesofar
5328 \catcode`\@ = \other
5331 \message{sectioning,}
5332 % Chapters, sections, etc.
5334 % Let's start with @part.
5335 \outer\parseargdef\part{\partzzz{#1}}
5336 \def\partzzz#1{%
5337 \chapoddpage
5338 \null
5339 \vskip.3\vsize % move it down on the page a bit
5340 \begingroup
5341 \noindent \titlefonts\rmisbold #1\par % the text
5342 \let\lastnode=\empty % no node to associate with
5343 \writetocentry{part}{#1}{}% but put it in the toc
5344 \headingsoff % no headline or footline on the part page
5345 \chapoddpage
5346 \endgroup
5349 % \unnumberedno is an oxymoron. But we count the unnumbered
5350 % sections so that we can refer to them unambiguously in the pdf
5351 % outlines by their "section number". We avoid collisions with chapter
5352 % numbers by starting them at 10000. (If a document ever has 10000
5353 % chapters, we're in trouble anyway, I'm sure.)
5354 \newcount\unnumberedno \unnumberedno = 10000
5355 \newcount\chapno
5356 \newcount\secno \secno=0
5357 \newcount\subsecno \subsecno=0
5358 \newcount\subsubsecno \subsubsecno=0
5360 % This counter is funny since it counts through charcodes of letters A, B, ...
5361 \newcount\appendixno \appendixno = `\@
5363 % \def\appendixletter{\char\the\appendixno}
5364 % We do the following ugly conditional instead of the above simple
5365 % construct for the sake of pdftex, which needs the actual
5366 % letter in the expansion, not just typeset.
5368 \def\appendixletter{%
5369 \ifnum\appendixno=`A A%
5370 \else\ifnum\appendixno=`B B%
5371 \else\ifnum\appendixno=`C C%
5372 \else\ifnum\appendixno=`D D%
5373 \else\ifnum\appendixno=`E E%
5374 \else\ifnum\appendixno=`F F%
5375 \else\ifnum\appendixno=`G G%
5376 \else\ifnum\appendixno=`H H%
5377 \else\ifnum\appendixno=`I I%
5378 \else\ifnum\appendixno=`J J%
5379 \else\ifnum\appendixno=`K K%
5380 \else\ifnum\appendixno=`L L%
5381 \else\ifnum\appendixno=`M M%
5382 \else\ifnum\appendixno=`N N%
5383 \else\ifnum\appendixno=`O O%
5384 \else\ifnum\appendixno=`P P%
5385 \else\ifnum\appendixno=`Q Q%
5386 \else\ifnum\appendixno=`R R%
5387 \else\ifnum\appendixno=`S S%
5388 \else\ifnum\appendixno=`T T%
5389 \else\ifnum\appendixno=`U U%
5390 \else\ifnum\appendixno=`V V%
5391 \else\ifnum\appendixno=`W W%
5392 \else\ifnum\appendixno=`X X%
5393 \else\ifnum\appendixno=`Y Y%
5394 \else\ifnum\appendixno=`Z Z%
5395 % The \the is necessary, despite appearances, because \appendixletter is
5396 % expanded while writing the .toc file. \char\appendixno is not
5397 % expandable, thus it is written literally, thus all appendixes come out
5398 % with the same letter (or @) in the toc without it.
5399 \else\char\the\appendixno
5400 \fi\fi\fi\fi\fi\fi\fi\fi\fi\fi\fi\fi\fi
5401 \fi\fi\fi\fi\fi\fi\fi\fi\fi\fi\fi\fi\fi}
5403 % Each @chapter defines these (using marks) as the number+name, number
5404 % and name of the chapter. Page headings and footings can use
5405 % these. @section does likewise.
5406 \def\thischapter{}
5407 \def\thischapternum{}
5408 \def\thischaptername{}
5409 \def\thissection{}
5410 \def\thissectionnum{}
5411 \def\thissectionname{}
5413 \newcount\absseclevel % used to calculate proper heading level
5414 \newcount\secbase\secbase=0 % @raisesections/@lowersections modify this count
5416 % @raisesections: treat @section as chapter, @subsection as section, etc.
5417 \def\raisesections{\global\advance\secbase by -1}
5418 \let\up=\raisesections % original BFox name
5420 % @lowersections: treat @chapter as section, @section as subsection, etc.
5421 \def\lowersections{\global\advance\secbase by 1}
5422 \let\down=\lowersections % original BFox name
5424 % we only have subsub.
5425 \chardef\maxseclevel = 3
5427 % A numbered section within an unnumbered changes to unnumbered too.
5428 % To achieve this, remember the "biggest" unnum. sec. we are currently in:
5429 \chardef\unnlevel = \maxseclevel
5431 % Trace whether the current chapter is an appendix or not:
5432 % \chapheadtype is "N" or "A", unnumbered chapters are ignored.
5433 \def\chapheadtype{N}
5435 % Choose a heading macro
5436 % #1 is heading type
5437 % #2 is heading level
5438 % #3 is text for heading
5439 \def\genhead#1#2#3{%
5440 % Compute the abs. sec. level:
5441 \absseclevel=#2
5442 \advance\absseclevel by \secbase
5443 % Make sure \absseclevel doesn't fall outside the range:
5444 \ifnum \absseclevel < 0
5445 \absseclevel = 0
5446 \else
5447 \ifnum \absseclevel > 3
5448 \absseclevel = 3
5451 % The heading type:
5452 \def\headtype{#1}%
5453 \if \headtype U%
5454 \ifnum \absseclevel < \unnlevel
5455 \chardef\unnlevel = \absseclevel
5457 \else
5458 % Check for appendix sections:
5459 \ifnum \absseclevel = 0
5460 \edef\chapheadtype{\headtype}%
5461 \else
5462 \if \headtype A\if \chapheadtype N%
5463 \errmessage{@appendix... within a non-appendix chapter}%
5464 \fi\fi
5466 % Check for numbered within unnumbered:
5467 \ifnum \absseclevel > \unnlevel
5468 \def\headtype{U}%
5469 \else
5470 \chardef\unnlevel = 3
5473 % Now print the heading:
5474 \if \headtype U%
5475 \ifcase\absseclevel
5476 \unnumberedzzz{#3}%
5477 \or \unnumberedseczzz{#3}%
5478 \or \unnumberedsubseczzz{#3}%
5479 \or \unnumberedsubsubseczzz{#3}%
5481 \else
5482 \if \headtype A%
5483 \ifcase\absseclevel
5484 \appendixzzz{#3}%
5485 \or \appendixsectionzzz{#3}%
5486 \or \appendixsubseczzz{#3}%
5487 \or \appendixsubsubseczzz{#3}%
5489 \else
5490 \ifcase\absseclevel
5491 \chapterzzz{#3}%
5492 \or \seczzz{#3}%
5493 \or \numberedsubseczzz{#3}%
5494 \or \numberedsubsubseczzz{#3}%
5498 \suppressfirstparagraphindent
5501 % an interface:
5502 \def\numhead{\genhead N}
5503 \def\apphead{\genhead A}
5504 \def\unnmhead{\genhead U}
5506 % @chapter, @appendix, @unnumbered. Increment top-level counter, reset
5507 % all lower-level sectioning counters to zero.
5509 % Also set \chaplevelprefix, which we prepend to @float sequence numbers
5510 % (e.g., figures), q.v. By default (before any chapter), that is empty.
5511 \let\chaplevelprefix = \empty
5513 \outer\parseargdef\chapter{\numhead0{#1}} % normally numhead0 calls chapterzzz
5514 \def\chapterzzz#1{%
5515 % section resetting is \global in case the chapter is in a group, such
5516 % as an @include file.
5517 \global\secno=0 \global\subsecno=0 \global\subsubsecno=0
5518 \global\advance\chapno by 1
5520 % Used for \float.
5521 \gdef\chaplevelprefix{\the\chapno.}%
5522 \resetallfloatnos
5524 % \putwordChapter can contain complex things in translations.
5525 \toks0=\expandafter{\putwordChapter}%
5526 \message{\the\toks0 \space \the\chapno}%
5528 % Write the actual heading.
5529 \chapmacro{#1}{Ynumbered}{\the\chapno}%
5531 % So @section and the like are numbered underneath this chapter.
5532 \global\let\section = \numberedsec
5533 \global\let\subsection = \numberedsubsec
5534 \global\let\subsubsection = \numberedsubsubsec
5537 \outer\parseargdef\appendix{\apphead0{#1}} % normally calls appendixzzz
5539 \def\appendixzzz#1{%
5540 \global\secno=0 \global\subsecno=0 \global\subsubsecno=0
5541 \global\advance\appendixno by 1
5542 \gdef\chaplevelprefix{\appendixletter.}%
5543 \resetallfloatnos
5545 % \putwordAppendix can contain complex things in translations.
5546 \toks0=\expandafter{\putwordAppendix}%
5547 \message{\the\toks0 \space \appendixletter}%
5549 \chapmacro{#1}{Yappendix}{\appendixletter}%
5551 \global\let\section = \appendixsec
5552 \global\let\subsection = \appendixsubsec
5553 \global\let\subsubsection = \appendixsubsubsec
5556 % normally unnmhead0 calls unnumberedzzz:
5557 \outer\parseargdef\unnumbered{\unnmhead0{#1}}
5558 \def\unnumberedzzz#1{%
5559 \global\secno=0 \global\subsecno=0 \global\subsubsecno=0
5560 \global\advance\unnumberedno by 1
5562 % Since an unnumbered has no number, no prefix for figures.
5563 \global\let\chaplevelprefix = \empty
5564 \resetallfloatnos
5566 % This used to be simply \message{#1}, but TeX fully expands the
5567 % argument to \message. Therefore, if #1 contained @-commands, TeX
5568 % expanded them. For example, in `@unnumbered The @cite{Book}', TeX
5569 % expanded @cite (which turns out to cause errors because \cite is meant
5570 % to be executed, not expanded).
5572 % Anyway, we don't want the fully-expanded definition of @cite to appear
5573 % as a result of the \message, we just want `@cite' itself. We use
5574 % \the<toks register> to achieve this: TeX expands \the<toks> only once,
5575 % simply yielding the contents of <toks register>. (We also do this for
5576 % the toc entries.)
5577 \toks0 = {#1}%
5578 \message{(\the\toks0)}%
5580 \chapmacro{#1}{Ynothing}{\the\unnumberedno}%
5582 \global\let\section = \unnumberedsec
5583 \global\let\subsection = \unnumberedsubsec
5584 \global\let\subsubsection = \unnumberedsubsubsec
5587 % @centerchap is like @unnumbered, but the heading is centered.
5588 \outer\parseargdef\centerchap{%
5589 % Well, we could do the following in a group, but that would break
5590 % an assumption that \chapmacro is called at the outermost level.
5591 % Thus we are safer this way: --kasal, 24feb04
5592 \let\centerparametersmaybe = \centerparameters
5593 \unnmhead0{#1}%
5594 \let\centerparametersmaybe = \relax
5597 % @top is like @unnumbered.
5598 \let\top\unnumbered
5600 % Sections.
5602 \outer\parseargdef\numberedsec{\numhead1{#1}} % normally calls seczzz
5603 \def\seczzz#1{%
5604 \global\subsecno=0 \global\subsubsecno=0 \global\advance\secno by 1
5605 \sectionheading{#1}{sec}{Ynumbered}{\the\chapno.\the\secno}%
5608 % normally calls appendixsectionzzz:
5609 \outer\parseargdef\appendixsection{\apphead1{#1}}
5610 \def\appendixsectionzzz#1{%
5611 \global\subsecno=0 \global\subsubsecno=0 \global\advance\secno by 1
5612 \sectionheading{#1}{sec}{Yappendix}{\appendixletter.\the\secno}%
5614 \let\appendixsec\appendixsection
5616 % normally calls unnumberedseczzz:
5617 \outer\parseargdef\unnumberedsec{\unnmhead1{#1}}
5618 \def\unnumberedseczzz#1{%
5619 \global\subsecno=0 \global\subsubsecno=0 \global\advance\secno by 1
5620 \sectionheading{#1}{sec}{Ynothing}{\the\unnumberedno.\the\secno}%
5623 % Subsections.
5625 % normally calls numberedsubseczzz:
5626 \outer\parseargdef\numberedsubsec{\numhead2{#1}}
5627 \def\numberedsubseczzz#1{%
5628 \global\subsubsecno=0 \global\advance\subsecno by 1
5629 \sectionheading{#1}{subsec}{Ynumbered}{\the\chapno.\the\secno.\the\subsecno}%
5632 % normally calls appendixsubseczzz:
5633 \outer\parseargdef\appendixsubsec{\apphead2{#1}}
5634 \def\appendixsubseczzz#1{%
5635 \global\subsubsecno=0 \global\advance\subsecno by 1
5636 \sectionheading{#1}{subsec}{Yappendix}%
5637 {\appendixletter.\the\secno.\the\subsecno}%
5640 % normally calls unnumberedsubseczzz:
5641 \outer\parseargdef\unnumberedsubsec{\unnmhead2{#1}}
5642 \def\unnumberedsubseczzz#1{%
5643 \global\subsubsecno=0 \global\advance\subsecno by 1
5644 \sectionheading{#1}{subsec}{Ynothing}%
5645 {\the\unnumberedno.\the\secno.\the\subsecno}%
5648 % Subsubsections.
5650 % normally numberedsubsubseczzz:
5651 \outer\parseargdef\numberedsubsubsec{\numhead3{#1}}
5652 \def\numberedsubsubseczzz#1{%
5653 \global\advance\subsubsecno by 1
5654 \sectionheading{#1}{subsubsec}{Ynumbered}%
5655 {\the\chapno.\the\secno.\the\subsecno.\the\subsubsecno}%
5658 % normally appendixsubsubseczzz:
5659 \outer\parseargdef\appendixsubsubsec{\apphead3{#1}}
5660 \def\appendixsubsubseczzz#1{%
5661 \global\advance\subsubsecno by 1
5662 \sectionheading{#1}{subsubsec}{Yappendix}%
5663 {\appendixletter.\the\secno.\the\subsecno.\the\subsubsecno}%
5666 % normally unnumberedsubsubseczzz:
5667 \outer\parseargdef\unnumberedsubsubsec{\unnmhead3{#1}}
5668 \def\unnumberedsubsubseczzz#1{%
5669 \global\advance\subsubsecno by 1
5670 \sectionheading{#1}{subsubsec}{Ynothing}%
5671 {\the\unnumberedno.\the\secno.\the\subsecno.\the\subsubsecno}%
5674 % These macros control what the section commands do, according
5675 % to what kind of chapter we are in (ordinary, appendix, or unnumbered).
5676 % Define them by default for a numbered chapter.
5677 \let\section = \numberedsec
5678 \let\subsection = \numberedsubsec
5679 \let\subsubsection = \numberedsubsubsec
5681 % Define @majorheading, @heading and @subheading
5683 \def\majorheading{%
5684 {\advance\chapheadingskip by 10pt \chapbreak }%
5685 \parsearg\chapheadingzzz
5688 \def\chapheading{\chapbreak \parsearg\chapheadingzzz}
5689 \def\chapheadingzzz#1{%
5690 \vbox{\chapfonts \raggedtitlesettings #1\par}%
5691 \nobreak\bigskip \nobreak
5692 \suppressfirstparagraphindent
5695 % @heading, @subheading, @subsubheading.
5696 \parseargdef\heading{\sectionheading{#1}{sec}{Yomitfromtoc}{}
5697 \suppressfirstparagraphindent}
5698 \parseargdef\subheading{\sectionheading{#1}{subsec}{Yomitfromtoc}{}
5699 \suppressfirstparagraphindent}
5700 \parseargdef\subsubheading{\sectionheading{#1}{subsubsec}{Yomitfromtoc}{}
5701 \suppressfirstparagraphindent}
5703 % These macros generate a chapter, section, etc. heading only
5704 % (including whitespace, linebreaking, etc. around it),
5705 % given all the information in convenient, parsed form.
5707 % Args are the skip and penalty (usually negative)
5708 \def\dobreak#1#2{\par\ifdim\lastskip<#1\removelastskip\penalty#2\vskip#1\fi}
5710 % Parameter controlling skip before chapter headings (if needed)
5711 \newskip\chapheadingskip
5713 % Define plain chapter starts, and page on/off switching for it.
5714 \def\chapbreak{\dobreak \chapheadingskip {-4000}}
5715 \def\chappager{\par\vfill\supereject}
5716 % Because \domark is called before \chapoddpage, the filler page will
5717 % get the headings for the next chapter, which is wrong. But we don't
5718 % care -- we just disable all headings on the filler page.
5719 \def\chapoddpage{%
5720 \chappager
5721 \ifodd\pageno \else
5722 \begingroup
5723 \headingsoff
5724 \null
5725 \chappager
5726 \endgroup
5730 \def\setchapternewpage #1 {\csname CHAPPAG#1\endcsname}
5732 \def\CHAPPAGoff{%
5733 \global\let\contentsalignmacro = \chappager
5734 \global\let\pchapsepmacro=\chapbreak
5735 \global\let\pagealignmacro=\chappager}
5737 \def\CHAPPAGon{%
5738 \global\let\contentsalignmacro = \chappager
5739 \global\let\pchapsepmacro=\chappager
5740 \global\let\pagealignmacro=\chappager
5741 \global\def\HEADINGSon{\HEADINGSsingle}}
5743 \def\CHAPPAGodd{%
5744 \global\let\contentsalignmacro = \chapoddpage
5745 \global\let\pchapsepmacro=\chapoddpage
5746 \global\let\pagealignmacro=\chapoddpage
5747 \global\def\HEADINGSon{\HEADINGSdouble}}
5749 \CHAPPAGon
5751 % Chapter opening.
5753 % #1 is the text, #2 is the section type (Ynumbered, Ynothing,
5754 % Yappendix, Yomitfromtoc), #3 the chapter number.
5755 % Not used for @heading series.
5757 % To test against our argument.
5758 \def\Ynothingkeyword{Ynothing}
5759 \def\Yappendixkeyword{Yappendix}
5760 \def\Yomitfromtockeyword{Yomitfromtoc}
5762 \def\chapmacro#1#2#3{%
5763 \checkenv{}% chapters, etc., should not start inside an environment.
5765 % Insert the first mark before the heading break (see notes for \domark).
5766 \let\prevchapterdefs=\lastchapterdefs
5767 \let\prevsectiondefs=\lastsectiondefs
5768 \gdef\lastsectiondefs{\gdef\thissectionname{}\gdef\thissectionnum{}%
5769 \gdef\thissection{}}%
5771 \def\temptype{#2}%
5772 \ifx\temptype\Ynothingkeyword
5773 \gdef\lastchapterdefs{\gdef\thischaptername{#1}\gdef\thischapternum{}%
5774 \gdef\thischapter{\thischaptername}}%
5775 \else\ifx\temptype\Yomitfromtockeyword
5776 \gdef\lastchapterdefs{\gdef\thischaptername{#1}\gdef\thischapternum{}%
5777 \gdef\thischapter{}}%
5778 \else\ifx\temptype\Yappendixkeyword
5779 \toks0={#1}%
5780 \xdef\lastchapterdefs{%
5781 \gdef\noexpand\thischaptername{\the\toks0}%
5782 \gdef\noexpand\thischapternum{\appendixletter}%
5783 % \noexpand\putwordAppendix avoids expanding indigestible
5784 % commands in some of the translations.
5785 \gdef\noexpand\thischapter{\noexpand\putwordAppendix{}
5786 \noexpand\thischapternum:
5787 \noexpand\thischaptername}%
5789 \else
5790 \toks0={#1}%
5791 \xdef\lastchapterdefs{%
5792 \gdef\noexpand\thischaptername{\the\toks0}%
5793 \gdef\noexpand\thischapternum{\the\chapno}%
5794 % \noexpand\putwordChapter avoids expanding indigestible
5795 % commands in some of the translations.
5796 \gdef\noexpand\thischapter{\noexpand\putwordChapter{}
5797 \noexpand\thischapternum:
5798 \noexpand\thischaptername}%
5800 \fi\fi\fi
5802 % Output the mark. Pass it through \safewhatsit, to take care of
5803 % the preceding space.
5804 \safewhatsit\domark
5806 % Insert the chapter heading break.
5807 \pchapsepmacro
5809 % Now the second mark, after the heading break. No break points
5810 % between here and the heading.
5811 \let\prevchapterdefs=\lastchapterdefs
5812 \let\prevsectiondefs=\lastsectiondefs
5813 \domark
5816 \chapfonts \rmisbold
5817 \let\footnote=\errfootnoteheading % give better error message
5819 % Have to define \lastsection before calling \donoderef, because the
5820 % xref code eventually uses it. On the other hand, it has to be called
5821 % after \pchapsepmacro, or the headline will change too soon.
5822 \gdef\lastsection{#1}%
5824 % Only insert the separating space if we have a chapter/appendix
5825 % number, and don't print the unnumbered ``number''.
5826 \ifx\temptype\Ynothingkeyword
5827 \setbox0 = \hbox{}%
5828 \def\toctype{unnchap}%
5829 \else\ifx\temptype\Yomitfromtockeyword
5830 \setbox0 = \hbox{}% contents like unnumbered, but no toc entry
5831 \def\toctype{omit}%
5832 \else\ifx\temptype\Yappendixkeyword
5833 \setbox0 = \hbox{\putwordAppendix{} #3\enspace}%
5834 \def\toctype{app}%
5835 \else
5836 \setbox0 = \hbox{#3\enspace}%
5837 \def\toctype{numchap}%
5838 \fi\fi\fi
5840 % Write the toc entry for this chapter. Must come before the
5841 % \donoderef, because we include the current node name in the toc
5842 % entry, and \donoderef resets it to empty.
5843 \writetocentry{\toctype}{#1}{#3}%
5845 % For pdftex, we have to write out the node definition (aka, make
5846 % the pdfdest) after any page break, but before the actual text has
5847 % been typeset. If the destination for the pdf outline is after the
5848 % text, then jumping from the outline may wind up with the text not
5849 % being visible, for instance under high magnification.
5850 \donoderef{#2}%
5852 % Typeset the actual heading.
5853 \nobreak % Avoid page breaks at the interline glue.
5854 \vbox{\raggedtitlesettings \hangindent=\wd0 \centerparametersmaybe
5855 \unhbox0 #1\par}%
5857 \nobreak\bigskip % no page break after a chapter title
5858 \nobreak
5861 % @centerchap -- centered and unnumbered.
5862 \let\centerparametersmaybe = \relax
5863 \def\centerparameters{%
5864 \advance\rightskip by 3\rightskip
5865 \leftskip = \rightskip
5866 \parfillskip = 0pt
5870 % I don't think this chapter style is supported any more, so I'm not
5871 % updating it with the new noderef stuff. We'll see. --karl, 11aug03.
5873 \def\setchapterstyle #1 {\csname CHAPF#1\endcsname}
5875 \def\unnchfopen #1{%
5876 \chapoddpage
5877 \vbox{\chapfonts \raggedtitlesettings #1\par}%
5878 \nobreak\bigskip\nobreak
5880 \def\chfopen #1#2{\chapoddpage {\chapfonts
5881 \vbox to 3in{\vfil \hbox to\hsize{\hfil #2} \hbox to\hsize{\hfil #1} \vfil}}%
5882 \par\penalty 5000 %
5884 \def\centerchfopen #1{%
5885 \chapoddpage
5886 \vbox{\chapfonts \raggedtitlesettings \hfill #1\hfill}%
5887 \nobreak\bigskip \nobreak
5889 \def\CHAPFopen{%
5890 \global\let\chapmacro=\chfopen
5891 \global\let\centerchapmacro=\centerchfopen}
5894 % Section titles. These macros combine the section number parts and
5895 % call the generic \sectionheading to do the printing.
5897 \newskip\secheadingskip
5898 \def\secheadingbreak{\dobreak \secheadingskip{-1000}}
5900 % Subsection titles.
5901 \newskip\subsecheadingskip
5902 \def\subsecheadingbreak{\dobreak \subsecheadingskip{-500}}
5904 % Subsubsection titles.
5905 \def\subsubsecheadingskip{\subsecheadingskip}
5906 \def\subsubsecheadingbreak{\subsecheadingbreak}
5909 % Print any size, any type, section title.
5911 % #1 is the text of the title,
5912 % #2 is the section level (sec/subsec/subsubsec),
5913 % #3 is the section type (Ynumbered, Ynothing, Yappendix, Yomitfromtoc),
5914 % #4 is the section number.
5916 \def\seckeyword{sec}
5918 \def\sectionheading#1#2#3#4{%
5920 \def\sectionlevel{#2}%
5921 \def\temptype{#3}%
5923 % It is ok for the @heading series commands to appear inside an
5924 % environment (it's been historically allowed, though the logic is
5925 % dubious), but not the others.
5926 \ifx\temptype\Yomitfromtockeyword\else
5927 \checkenv{}% non-@*heading should not be in an environment.
5929 \let\footnote=\errfootnoteheading
5931 % Switch to the right set of fonts.
5932 \csname #2fonts\endcsname \rmisbold
5934 % Insert first mark before the heading break (see notes for \domark).
5935 \let\prevsectiondefs=\lastsectiondefs
5936 \ifx\temptype\Ynothingkeyword
5937 \ifx\sectionlevel\seckeyword
5938 \gdef\lastsectiondefs{\gdef\thissectionname{#1}\gdef\thissectionnum{}%
5939 \gdef\thissection{\thissectionname}}%
5941 \else\ifx\temptype\Yomitfromtockeyword
5942 % Don't redefine \thissection.
5943 \else\ifx\temptype\Yappendixkeyword
5944 \ifx\sectionlevel\seckeyword
5945 \toks0={#1}%
5946 \xdef\lastsectiondefs{%
5947 \gdef\noexpand\thissectionname{\the\toks0}%
5948 \gdef\noexpand\thissectionnum{#4}%
5949 % \noexpand\putwordSection avoids expanding indigestible
5950 % commands in some of the translations.
5951 \gdef\noexpand\thissection{\noexpand\putwordSection{}
5952 \noexpand\thissectionnum:
5953 \noexpand\thissectionname}%
5956 \else
5957 \ifx\sectionlevel\seckeyword
5958 \toks0={#1}%
5959 \xdef\lastsectiondefs{%
5960 \gdef\noexpand\thissectionname{\the\toks0}%
5961 \gdef\noexpand\thissectionnum{#4}%
5962 % \noexpand\putwordSection avoids expanding indigestible
5963 % commands in some of the translations.
5964 \gdef\noexpand\thissection{\noexpand\putwordSection{}
5965 \noexpand\thissectionnum:
5966 \noexpand\thissectionname}%
5969 \fi\fi\fi
5971 % Go into vertical mode. Usually we'll already be there, but we
5972 % don't want the following whatsit to end up in a preceding paragraph
5973 % if the document didn't happen to have a blank line.
5974 \par
5976 % Output the mark. Pass it through \safewhatsit, to take care of
5977 % the preceding space.
5978 \safewhatsit\domark
5980 % Insert space above the heading.
5981 \csname #2headingbreak\endcsname
5983 % Now the second mark, after the heading break. No break points
5984 % between here and the heading.
5985 \global\let\prevsectiondefs=\lastsectiondefs
5986 \domark
5988 % Only insert the space after the number if we have a section number.
5989 \ifx\temptype\Ynothingkeyword
5990 \setbox0 = \hbox{}%
5991 \def\toctype{unn}%
5992 \gdef\lastsection{#1}%
5993 \else\ifx\temptype\Yomitfromtockeyword
5994 % for @headings -- no section number, don't include in toc,
5995 % and don't redefine \lastsection.
5996 \setbox0 = \hbox{}%
5997 \def\toctype{omit}%
5998 \let\sectionlevel=\empty
5999 \else\ifx\temptype\Yappendixkeyword
6000 \setbox0 = \hbox{#4\enspace}%
6001 \def\toctype{app}%
6002 \gdef\lastsection{#1}%
6003 \else
6004 \setbox0 = \hbox{#4\enspace}%
6005 \def\toctype{num}%
6006 \gdef\lastsection{#1}%
6007 \fi\fi\fi
6009 % Write the toc entry (before \donoderef). See comments in \chapmacro.
6010 \writetocentry{\toctype\sectionlevel}{#1}{#4}%
6012 % Write the node reference (= pdf destination for pdftex).
6013 % Again, see comments in \chapmacro.
6014 \donoderef{#3}%
6016 % Interline glue will be inserted when the vbox is completed.
6017 % That glue will be a valid breakpoint for the page, since it'll be
6018 % preceded by a whatsit (usually from the \donoderef, or from the
6019 % \writetocentry if there was no node). We don't want to allow that
6020 % break, since then the whatsits could end up on page n while the
6021 % section is on page n+1, thus toc/etc. are wrong. Debian bug 276000.
6022 \nobreak
6024 % Output the actual section heading.
6025 \vbox{\hyphenpenalty=10000 \tolerance=5000 \parindent=0pt \ptexraggedright
6026 \hangindent=\wd0 % zero if no section number
6027 \unhbox0 #1}%
6029 % Add extra space after the heading -- half of whatever came above it.
6030 % Don't allow stretch, though.
6031 \kern .5 \csname #2headingskip\endcsname
6033 % Do not let the kern be a potential breakpoint, as it would be if it
6034 % was followed by glue.
6035 \nobreak
6037 % We'll almost certainly start a paragraph next, so don't let that
6038 % glue accumulate. (Not a breakpoint because it's preceded by a
6039 % discardable item.) However, when a paragraph is not started next
6040 % (\startdefun, \cartouche, \center, etc.), this needs to be wiped out
6041 % or the negative glue will cause weirdly wrong output, typically
6042 % obscuring the section heading with something else.
6043 \vskip-\parskip
6045 % This is so the last item on the main vertical list is a known
6046 % \penalty > 10000, so \startdefun, etc., can recognize the situation
6047 % and do the needful.
6048 \penalty 10001
6052 \message{toc,}
6053 % Table of contents.
6054 \newwrite\tocfile
6056 % Write an entry to the toc file, opening it if necessary.
6057 % Called from @chapter, etc.
6059 % Example usage: \writetocentry{sec}{Section Name}{\the\chapno.\the\secno}
6060 % We append the current node name (if any) and page number as additional
6061 % arguments for the \{chap,sec,...}entry macros which will eventually
6062 % read this. The node name is used in the pdf outlines as the
6063 % destination to jump to.
6065 % We open the .toc file for writing here instead of at @setfilename (or
6066 % any other fixed time) so that @contents can be anywhere in the document.
6067 % But if #1 is `omit', then we don't do anything. This is used for the
6068 % table of contents chapter openings themselves.
6070 \newif\iftocfileopened
6071 \def\omitkeyword{omit}%
6073 \def\writetocentry#1#2#3{%
6074 \edef\writetoctype{#1}%
6075 \ifx\writetoctype\omitkeyword \else
6076 \iftocfileopened\else
6077 \immediate\openout\tocfile = \jobname.toc
6078 \global\tocfileopenedtrue
6081 \iflinks
6082 {\atdummies
6083 \edef\temp{%
6084 \write\tocfile{@#1entry{#2}{#3}{\lastnode}{\noexpand\folio}}}%
6085 \temp
6090 % Tell \shipout to create a pdf destination on each page, if we're
6091 % writing pdf. These are used in the table of contents. We can't
6092 % just write one on every page because the title pages are numbered
6093 % 1 and 2 (the page numbers aren't printed), and so are the first
6094 % two pages of the document. Thus, we'd have two destinations named
6095 % `1', and two named `2'.
6096 \ifpdf \global\pdfmakepagedesttrue \fi
6100 % These characters do not print properly in the Computer Modern roman
6101 % fonts, so we must take special care. This is more or less redundant
6102 % with the Texinfo input format setup at the end of this file.
6104 \def\activecatcodes{%
6105 \catcode`\"=\active
6106 \catcode`\$=\active
6107 \catcode`\<=\active
6108 \catcode`\>=\active
6109 \catcode`\\=\active
6110 \catcode`\^=\active
6111 \catcode`\_=\active
6112 \catcode`\|=\active
6113 \catcode`\~=\active
6117 % Read the toc file, which is essentially Texinfo input.
6118 \def\readtocfile{%
6119 \setupdatafile
6120 \activecatcodes
6121 \input \tocreadfilename
6124 \newskip\contentsrightmargin \contentsrightmargin=1in
6125 \newcount\savepageno
6126 \newcount\lastnegativepageno \lastnegativepageno = -1
6128 % Prepare to read what we've written to \tocfile.
6130 \def\startcontents#1{%
6131 % If @setchapternewpage on, and @headings double, the contents should
6132 % start on an odd page, unlike chapters. Thus, we maintain
6133 % \contentsalignmacro in parallel with \pagealignmacro.
6134 % From: Torbjorn Granlund <tege@matematik.su.se>
6135 \contentsalignmacro
6136 \immediate\closeout\tocfile
6138 % Don't need to put `Contents' or `Short Contents' in the headline.
6139 % It is abundantly clear what they are.
6140 \chapmacro{#1}{Yomitfromtoc}{}%
6142 \savepageno = \pageno
6143 \begingroup % Set up to handle contents files properly.
6144 \raggedbottom % Worry more about breakpoints than the bottom.
6145 \advance\hsize by -\contentsrightmargin % Don't use the full line length.
6147 % Roman numerals for page numbers.
6148 \ifnum \pageno>0 \global\pageno = \lastnegativepageno \fi
6151 % redefined for the two-volume lispref. We always output on
6152 % \jobname.toc even if this is redefined.
6154 \def\tocreadfilename{\jobname.toc}
6156 % Normal (long) toc.
6158 \def\contents{%
6159 \startcontents{\putwordTOC}%
6160 \openin 1 \tocreadfilename\space
6161 \ifeof 1 \else
6162 \readtocfile
6164 \vfill \eject
6165 \contentsalignmacro % in case @setchapternewpage odd is in effect
6166 \ifeof 1 \else
6167 \pdfmakeoutlines
6169 \closein 1
6170 \endgroup
6171 \lastnegativepageno = \pageno
6172 \global\pageno = \savepageno
6175 % And just the chapters.
6176 \def\summarycontents{%
6177 \startcontents{\putwordShortTOC}%
6179 \let\partentry = \shortpartentry
6180 \let\numchapentry = \shortchapentry
6181 \let\appentry = \shortchapentry
6182 \let\unnchapentry = \shortunnchapentry
6183 % We want a true roman here for the page numbers.
6184 \secfonts
6185 \let\rm=\shortcontrm \let\bf=\shortcontbf
6186 \let\sl=\shortcontsl \let\tt=\shortconttt
6188 \hyphenpenalty = 10000
6189 \advance\baselineskip by 1pt % Open it up a little.
6190 \def\numsecentry##1##2##3##4{}
6191 \let\appsecentry = \numsecentry
6192 \let\unnsecentry = \numsecentry
6193 \let\numsubsecentry = \numsecentry
6194 \let\appsubsecentry = \numsecentry
6195 \let\unnsubsecentry = \numsecentry
6196 \let\numsubsubsecentry = \numsecentry
6197 \let\appsubsubsecentry = \numsecentry
6198 \let\unnsubsubsecentry = \numsecentry
6199 \openin 1 \tocreadfilename\space
6200 \ifeof 1 \else
6201 \readtocfile
6203 \closein 1
6204 \vfill \eject
6205 \contentsalignmacro % in case @setchapternewpage odd is in effect
6206 \endgroup
6207 \lastnegativepageno = \pageno
6208 \global\pageno = \savepageno
6210 \let\shortcontents = \summarycontents
6212 % Typeset the label for a chapter or appendix for the short contents.
6213 % The arg is, e.g., `A' for an appendix, or `3' for a chapter.
6215 \def\shortchaplabel#1{%
6216 % This space should be enough, since a single number is .5em, and the
6217 % widest letter (M) is 1em, at least in the Computer Modern fonts.
6218 % But use \hss just in case.
6219 % (This space doesn't include the extra space that gets added after
6220 % the label; that gets put in by \shortchapentry above.)
6222 % We'd like to right-justify chapter numbers, but that looks strange
6223 % with appendix letters. And right-justifying numbers and
6224 % left-justifying letters looks strange when there is less than 10
6225 % chapters. Have to read the whole toc once to know how many chapters
6226 % there are before deciding ...
6227 \hbox to 1em{#1\hss}%
6230 % These macros generate individual entries in the table of contents.
6231 % The first argument is the chapter or section name.
6232 % The last argument is the page number.
6233 % The arguments in between are the chapter number, section number, ...
6235 % Parts, in the main contents. Replace the part number, which doesn't
6236 % exist, with an empty box. Let's hope all the numbers have the same width.
6237 % Also ignore the page number, which is conventionally not printed.
6238 \def\numeralbox{\setbox0=\hbox{8}\hbox to \wd0{\hfil}}
6239 \def\partentry#1#2#3#4{\dochapentry{\numeralbox\labelspace#1}{}}
6241 % Parts, in the short toc.
6242 \def\shortpartentry#1#2#3#4{%
6243 \penalty-300
6244 \vskip.5\baselineskip plus.15\baselineskip minus.1\baselineskip
6245 \shortchapentry{{\bf #1}}{\numeralbox}{}{}%
6248 % Chapters, in the main contents.
6249 \def\numchapentry#1#2#3#4{\dochapentry{#2\labelspace#1}{#4}}
6251 % Chapters, in the short toc.
6252 % See comments in \dochapentry re vbox and related settings.
6253 \def\shortchapentry#1#2#3#4{%
6254 \tocentry{\shortchaplabel{#2}\labelspace #1}{\doshortpageno\bgroup#4\egroup}%
6257 % Appendices, in the main contents.
6258 % Need the word Appendix, and a fixed-size box.
6260 \def\appendixbox#1{%
6261 % We use M since it's probably the widest letter.
6262 \setbox0 = \hbox{\putwordAppendix{} M}%
6263 \hbox to \wd0{\putwordAppendix{} #1\hss}}
6265 \def\appentry#1#2#3#4{\dochapentry{\appendixbox{#2}\labelspace#1}{#4}}
6267 % Unnumbered chapters.
6268 \def\unnchapentry#1#2#3#4{\dochapentry{#1}{#4}}
6269 \def\shortunnchapentry#1#2#3#4{\tocentry{#1}{\doshortpageno\bgroup#4\egroup}}
6271 % Sections.
6272 \def\numsecentry#1#2#3#4{\dosecentry{#2\labelspace#1}{#4}}
6273 \let\appsecentry=\numsecentry
6274 \def\unnsecentry#1#2#3#4{\dosecentry{#1}{#4}}
6276 % Subsections.
6277 \def\numsubsecentry#1#2#3#4{\dosubsecentry{#2\labelspace#1}{#4}}
6278 \let\appsubsecentry=\numsubsecentry
6279 \def\unnsubsecentry#1#2#3#4{\dosubsecentry{#1}{#4}}
6281 % And subsubsections.
6282 \def\numsubsubsecentry#1#2#3#4{\dosubsubsecentry{#2\labelspace#1}{#4}}
6283 \let\appsubsubsecentry=\numsubsubsecentry
6284 \def\unnsubsubsecentry#1#2#3#4{\dosubsubsecentry{#1}{#4}}
6286 % This parameter controls the indentation of the various levels.
6287 % Same as \defaultparindent.
6288 \newdimen\tocindent \tocindent = 15pt
6290 % Now for the actual typesetting. In all these, #1 is the text and #2 is the
6291 % page number.
6293 % If the toc has to be broken over pages, we want it to be at chapters
6294 % if at all possible; hence the \penalty.
6295 \def\dochapentry#1#2{%
6296 \penalty-300 \vskip1\baselineskip plus.33\baselineskip minus.25\baselineskip
6297 \begingroup
6298 \chapentryfonts
6299 \tocentry{#1}{\dopageno\bgroup#2\egroup}%
6300 \endgroup
6301 \nobreak\vskip .25\baselineskip plus.1\baselineskip
6304 \def\dosecentry#1#2{\begingroup
6305 \secentryfonts \leftskip=\tocindent
6306 \tocentry{#1}{\dopageno\bgroup#2\egroup}%
6307 \endgroup}
6309 \def\dosubsecentry#1#2{\begingroup
6310 \subsecentryfonts \leftskip=2\tocindent
6311 \tocentry{#1}{\dopageno\bgroup#2\egroup}%
6312 \endgroup}
6314 \def\dosubsubsecentry#1#2{\begingroup
6315 \subsubsecentryfonts \leftskip=3\tocindent
6316 \tocentry{#1}{\dopageno\bgroup#2\egroup}%
6317 \endgroup}
6319 % We use the same \entry macro as for the index entries.
6320 \let\tocentry = \entry
6322 % Space between chapter (or whatever) number and the title.
6323 \def\labelspace{\hskip1em \relax}
6325 \def\dopageno#1{{\rm #1}}
6326 \def\doshortpageno#1{{\rm #1}}
6328 \def\chapentryfonts{\secfonts \rm}
6329 \def\secentryfonts{\textfonts}
6330 \def\subsecentryfonts{\textfonts}
6331 \def\subsubsecentryfonts{\textfonts}
6334 \message{environments,}
6335 % @foo ... @end foo.
6337 % @tex ... @end tex escapes into raw TeX temporarily.
6338 % One exception: @ is still an escape character, so that @end tex works.
6339 % But \@ or @@ will get a plain @ character.
6341 \envdef\tex{%
6342 \setupmarkupstyle{tex}%
6343 \catcode `\\=0 \catcode `\{=1 \catcode `\}=2
6344 \catcode `\$=3 \catcode `\&=4 \catcode `\#=6
6345 \catcode `\^=7 \catcode `\_=8 \catcode `\~=\active \let~=\tie
6346 \catcode `\%=14
6347 \catcode `\+=\other
6348 \catcode `\"=\other
6349 \catcode `\|=\other
6350 \catcode `\<=\other
6351 \catcode `\>=\other
6352 \catcode `\`=\other
6353 \catcode `\'=\other
6354 \escapechar=`\\
6356 % ' is active in math mode (mathcode"8000). So reset it, and all our
6357 % other math active characters (just in case), to plain's definitions.
6358 \mathactive
6360 % Inverse of the list at the beginning of the file.
6361 \let\b=\ptexb
6362 \let\bullet=\ptexbullet
6363 \let\c=\ptexc
6364 \let\,=\ptexcomma
6365 \let\.=\ptexdot
6366 \let\dots=\ptexdots
6367 \let\equiv=\ptexequiv
6368 \let\!=\ptexexclam
6369 \let\i=\ptexi
6370 \let\indent=\ptexindent
6371 \let\noindent=\ptexnoindent
6372 \let\{=\ptexlbrace
6373 \let\+=\tabalign
6374 \let\}=\ptexrbrace
6375 \let\/=\ptexslash
6376 \let\sp=\ptexsp
6377 \let\*=\ptexstar
6378 %\let\sup=\ptexsup % do not redefine, we want @sup to work in math mode
6379 \let\t=\ptext
6380 \expandafter \let\csname top\endcsname=\ptextop % we've made it outer
6381 \let\frenchspacing=\plainfrenchspacing
6383 \def\endldots{\mathinner{\ldots\ldots\ldots\ldots}}%
6384 \def\enddots{\relax\ifmmode\endldots\else$\mathsurround=0pt \endldots\,$\fi}%
6385 \def\@{@}%
6387 % There is no need to define \Etex.
6389 % Define @lisp ... @end lisp.
6390 % @lisp environment forms a group so it can rebind things,
6391 % including the definition of @end lisp (which normally is erroneous).
6393 % Amount to narrow the margins by for @lisp.
6394 \newskip\lispnarrowing \lispnarrowing=0.4in
6396 % This is the definition that ^^M gets inside @lisp, @example, and other
6397 % such environments. \null is better than a space, since it doesn't
6398 % have any width.
6399 \def\lisppar{\null\endgraf}
6401 % This space is always present above and below environments.
6402 \newskip\envskipamount \envskipamount = 0pt
6404 % Make spacing and below environment symmetrical. We use \parskip here
6405 % to help in doing that, since in @example-like environments \parskip
6406 % is reset to zero; thus the \afterenvbreak inserts no space -- but the
6407 % start of the next paragraph will insert \parskip.
6409 \def\aboveenvbreak{{%
6410 % =10000 instead of <10000 because of a special case in \itemzzz and
6411 % \sectionheading, q.v.
6412 \ifnum \lastpenalty=10000 \else
6413 \advance\envskipamount by \parskip
6414 \endgraf
6415 \ifdim\lastskip<\envskipamount
6416 \removelastskip
6417 % it's not a good place to break if the last penalty was \nobreak
6418 % or better ...
6419 \ifnum\lastpenalty<10000 \penalty-50 \fi
6420 \vskip\envskipamount
6425 \let\afterenvbreak = \aboveenvbreak
6427 % \nonarrowing is a flag. If "set", @lisp etc don't narrow margins; it will
6428 % also clear it, so that its embedded environments do the narrowing again.
6429 \let\nonarrowing=\relax
6431 % @cartouche ... @end cartouche: draw rectangle w/rounded corners around
6432 % environment contents.
6433 \font\circle=lcircle10
6434 \newdimen\circthick
6435 \newdimen\cartouter\newdimen\cartinner
6436 \newskip\normbskip\newskip\normpskip\newskip\normlskip
6437 \circthick=\fontdimen8\circle
6439 \def\ctl{{\circle\char'013\hskip -6pt}}% 6pt from pl file: 1/2charwidth
6440 \def\ctr{{\hskip 6pt\circle\char'010}}
6441 \def\cbl{{\circle\char'012\hskip -6pt}}
6442 \def\cbr{{\hskip 6pt\circle\char'011}}
6443 \def\carttop{\hbox to \cartouter{\hskip\lskip
6444 \ctl\leaders\hrule height\circthick\hfil\ctr
6445 \hskip\rskip}}
6446 \def\cartbot{\hbox to \cartouter{\hskip\lskip
6447 \cbl\leaders\hrule height\circthick\hfil\cbr
6448 \hskip\rskip}}
6450 \newskip\lskip\newskip\rskip
6452 \envdef\cartouche{%
6453 \ifhmode\par\fi % can't be in the midst of a paragraph.
6454 \startsavinginserts
6455 \lskip=\leftskip \rskip=\rightskip
6456 \leftskip=0pt\rightskip=0pt % we want these *outside*.
6457 \cartinner=\hsize \advance\cartinner by-\lskip
6458 \advance\cartinner by-\rskip
6459 \cartouter=\hsize
6460 \advance\cartouter by 18.4pt % allow for 3pt kerns on either
6461 % side, and for 6pt waste from
6462 % each corner char, and rule thickness
6463 \normbskip=\baselineskip \normpskip=\parskip \normlskip=\lineskip
6465 % If this cartouche directly follows a sectioning command, we need the
6466 % \parskip glue (backspaced over by default) or the cartouche can
6467 % collide with the section heading.
6468 \ifnum\lastpenalty>10000 \vskip\parskip \penalty\lastpenalty \fi
6470 \vbox\bgroup
6471 \baselineskip=0pt\parskip=0pt\lineskip=0pt
6472 \carttop
6473 \hbox\bgroup
6474 \hskip\lskip
6475 \vrule\kern3pt
6476 \vbox\bgroup
6477 \kern3pt
6478 \hsize=\cartinner
6479 \baselineskip=\normbskip
6480 \lineskip=\normlskip
6481 \parskip=\normpskip
6482 \vskip -\parskip
6483 \comment % For explanation, see the end of def\group.
6485 \def\Ecartouche{%
6486 \ifhmode\par\fi
6487 \kern3pt
6488 \egroup
6489 \kern3pt\vrule
6490 \hskip\rskip
6491 \egroup
6492 \cartbot
6493 \egroup
6494 \checkinserts
6498 % This macro is called at the beginning of all the @example variants,
6499 % inside a group.
6500 \newdimen\nonfillparindent
6501 \def\nonfillstart{%
6502 \aboveenvbreak
6503 \ifdim\hfuzz < 12pt \hfuzz = 12pt \fi % Don't be fussy
6504 \sepspaces % Make spaces be word-separators rather than space tokens.
6505 \let\par = \lisppar % don't ignore blank lines
6506 \obeylines % each line of input is a line of output
6507 \parskip = 0pt
6508 % Turn off paragraph indentation but redefine \indent to emulate
6509 % the normal \indent.
6510 \nonfillparindent=\parindent
6511 \parindent = 0pt
6512 \let\indent\nonfillindent
6514 \emergencystretch = 0pt % don't try to avoid overfull boxes
6515 \ifx\nonarrowing\relax
6516 \advance \leftskip by \lispnarrowing
6517 \exdentamount=\lispnarrowing
6518 \else
6519 \let\nonarrowing = \relax
6521 \let\exdent=\nofillexdent
6524 \begingroup
6525 \obeyspaces
6526 % We want to swallow spaces (but not other tokens) after the fake
6527 % @indent in our nonfill-environments, where spaces are normally
6528 % active and set to @tie, resulting in them not being ignored after
6529 % @indent.
6530 \gdef\nonfillindent{\futurelet\temp\nonfillindentcheck}%
6531 \gdef\nonfillindentcheck{%
6532 \ifx\temp %
6533 \expandafter\nonfillindentgobble%
6534 \else%
6535 \leavevmode\nonfillindentbox%
6536 \fi%
6538 \endgroup
6539 \def\nonfillindentgobble#1{\nonfillindent}
6540 \def\nonfillindentbox{\hbox to \nonfillparindent{\hss}}
6542 % If you want all examples etc. small: @set dispenvsize small.
6543 % If you want even small examples the full size: @set dispenvsize nosmall.
6544 % This affects the following displayed environments:
6545 % @example, @display, @format, @lisp
6547 \def\smallword{small}
6548 \def\nosmallword{nosmall}
6549 \let\SETdispenvsize\relax
6550 \def\setnormaldispenv{%
6551 \ifx\SETdispenvsize\smallword
6552 % end paragraph for sake of leading, in case document has no blank
6553 % line. This is redundant with what happens in \aboveenvbreak, but
6554 % we need to do it before changing the fonts, and it's inconvenient
6555 % to change the fonts afterward.
6556 \ifnum \lastpenalty=10000 \else \endgraf \fi
6557 \smallexamplefonts \rm
6560 \def\setsmalldispenv{%
6561 \ifx\SETdispenvsize\nosmallword
6562 \else
6563 \ifnum \lastpenalty=10000 \else \endgraf \fi
6564 \smallexamplefonts \rm
6568 % We often define two environments, @foo and @smallfoo.
6569 % Let's do it in one command. #1 is the env name, #2 the definition.
6570 \def\makedispenvdef#1#2{%
6571 \expandafter\envdef\csname#1\endcsname {\setnormaldispenv #2}%
6572 \expandafter\envdef\csname small#1\endcsname {\setsmalldispenv #2}%
6573 \expandafter\let\csname E#1\endcsname \afterenvbreak
6574 \expandafter\let\csname Esmall#1\endcsname \afterenvbreak
6577 % Define two environment synonyms (#1 and #2) for an environment.
6578 \def\maketwodispenvdef#1#2#3{%
6579 \makedispenvdef{#1}{#3}%
6580 \makedispenvdef{#2}{#3}%
6583 % @lisp: indented, narrowed, typewriter font;
6584 % @example: same as @lisp.
6586 % @smallexample and @smalllisp: use smaller fonts.
6587 % Originally contributed by Pavel@xerox.
6589 \maketwodispenvdef{lisp}{example}{%
6590 \nonfillstart
6591 \tt\setupmarkupstyle{example}%
6592 \let\kbdfont = \kbdexamplefont % Allow @kbd to do something special.
6593 \gobble % eat return
6595 % @display/@smalldisplay: same as @lisp except keep current font.
6597 \makedispenvdef{display}{%
6598 \nonfillstart
6599 \gobble
6602 % @format/@smallformat: same as @display except don't narrow margins.
6604 \makedispenvdef{format}{%
6605 \let\nonarrowing = t%
6606 \nonfillstart
6607 \gobble
6610 % @flushleft: same as @format, but doesn't obey \SETdispenvsize.
6611 \envdef\flushleft{%
6612 \let\nonarrowing = t%
6613 \nonfillstart
6614 \gobble
6616 \let\Eflushleft = \afterenvbreak
6618 % @flushright.
6620 \envdef\flushright{%
6621 \let\nonarrowing = t%
6622 \nonfillstart
6623 \advance\leftskip by 0pt plus 1fill\relax
6624 \gobble
6626 \let\Eflushright = \afterenvbreak
6629 % @raggedright does more-or-less normal line breaking but no right
6630 % justification. From plain.tex. Don't stretch around special
6631 % characters in urls in this environment, since the stretch at the right
6632 % should be enough.
6633 \envdef\raggedright{%
6634 \rightskip0pt plus2.4em \spaceskip.3333em \xspaceskip.5em\relax
6635 \def\urefprestretchamount{0pt}%
6636 \def\urefpoststretchamount{0pt}%
6638 \let\Eraggedright\par
6640 \envdef\raggedleft{%
6641 \parindent=0pt \leftskip0pt plus2em
6642 \spaceskip.3333em \xspaceskip.5em \parfillskip=0pt
6643 \hbadness=10000 % Last line will usually be underfull, so turn off
6644 % badness reporting.
6646 \let\Eraggedleft\par
6648 \envdef\raggedcenter{%
6649 \parindent=0pt \rightskip0pt plus1em \leftskip0pt plus1em
6650 \spaceskip.3333em \xspaceskip.5em \parfillskip=0pt
6651 \hbadness=10000 % Last line will usually be underfull, so turn off
6652 % badness reporting.
6654 \let\Eraggedcenter\par
6657 % @quotation does normal linebreaking (hence we can't use \nonfillstart)
6658 % and narrows the margins. We keep \parskip nonzero in general, since
6659 % we're doing normal filling. So, when using \aboveenvbreak and
6660 % \afterenvbreak, temporarily make \parskip 0.
6662 \makedispenvdef{quotation}{\quotationstart}
6664 \def\quotationstart{%
6665 \indentedblockstart % same as \indentedblock, but increase right margin too.
6666 \ifx\nonarrowing\relax
6667 \advance\rightskip by \lispnarrowing
6669 \parsearg\quotationlabel
6672 % We have retained a nonzero parskip for the environment, since we're
6673 % doing normal filling.
6675 \def\Equotation{%
6676 \par
6677 \ifx\quotationauthor\thisisundefined\else
6678 % indent a bit.
6679 \leftline{\kern 2\leftskip \sl ---\quotationauthor}%
6681 {\parskip=0pt \afterenvbreak}%
6683 \def\Esmallquotation{\Equotation}
6685 % If we're given an argument, typeset it in bold with a colon after.
6686 \def\quotationlabel#1{%
6687 \def\temp{#1}%
6688 \ifx\temp\empty \else
6689 {\bf #1: }%
6693 % @indentedblock is like @quotation, but indents only on the left and
6694 % has no optional argument.
6696 \makedispenvdef{indentedblock}{\indentedblockstart}
6698 \def\indentedblockstart{%
6699 {\parskip=0pt \aboveenvbreak}% because \aboveenvbreak inserts \parskip
6700 \parindent=0pt
6702 % @cartouche defines \nonarrowing to inhibit narrowing at next level down.
6703 \ifx\nonarrowing\relax
6704 \advance\leftskip by \lispnarrowing
6705 \exdentamount = \lispnarrowing
6706 \else
6707 \let\nonarrowing = \relax
6711 % Keep a nonzero parskip for the environment, since we're doing normal filling.
6713 \def\Eindentedblock{%
6714 \par
6715 {\parskip=0pt \afterenvbreak}%
6717 \def\Esmallindentedblock{\Eindentedblock}
6720 % LaTeX-like @verbatim...@end verbatim and @verb{<char>...<char>}
6721 % If we want to allow any <char> as delimiter,
6722 % we need the curly braces so that makeinfo sees the @verb command, eg:
6723 % `@verbx...x' would look like the '@verbx' command. --janneke@gnu.org
6725 % [Knuth]: Donald Ervin Knuth, 1996. The TeXbook.
6727 % [Knuth] p.344; only we need to do the other characters Texinfo sets
6728 % active too. Otherwise, they get lost as the first character on a
6729 % verbatim line.
6730 \def\dospecials{%
6731 \do\ \do\\\do\{\do\}\do\$\do\&%
6732 \do\#\do\^\do\^^K\do\_\do\^^A\do\%\do\~%
6733 \do\<\do\>\do\|\do\@\do+\do\"%
6734 % Don't do the quotes -- if we do, @set txicodequoteundirected and
6735 % @set txicodequotebacktick will not have effect on @verb and
6736 % @verbatim, and ?` and !` ligatures won't get disabled.
6737 %\do\`\do\'%
6740 % [Knuth] p. 380
6741 \def\uncatcodespecials{%
6742 \def\do##1{\catcode`##1=\other}\dospecials}
6744 % Setup for the @verb command.
6746 % Eight spaces for a tab
6747 \begingroup
6748 \catcode`\^^I=\active
6749 \gdef\tabeightspaces{\catcode`\^^I=\active\def^^I{\ \ \ \ \ \ \ \ }}
6750 \endgroup
6752 \def\setupverb{%
6753 \tt % easiest (and conventionally used) font for verbatim
6754 \def\par{\leavevmode\endgraf}%
6755 \setupmarkupstyle{verb}%
6756 \tabeightspaces
6757 % Respect line breaks,
6758 % print special symbols as themselves, and
6759 % make each space count
6760 % must do in this order:
6761 \obeylines \uncatcodespecials \sepspaces
6764 % Setup for the @verbatim environment
6766 % Real tab expansion.
6767 \newdimen\tabw \setbox0=\hbox{\tt\space} \tabw=8\wd0 % tab amount
6769 % We typeset each line of the verbatim in an \hbox, so we can handle
6770 % tabs. The \global is in case the verbatim line starts with an accent,
6771 % or some other command that starts with a begin-group. Otherwise, the
6772 % entire \verbbox would disappear at the corresponding end-group, before
6773 % it is typeset. Meanwhile, we can't have nested verbatim commands
6774 % (can we?), so the \global won't be overwriting itself.
6775 \newbox\verbbox
6776 \def\starttabbox{\global\setbox\verbbox=\hbox\bgroup}
6778 \begingroup
6779 \catcode`\^^I=\active
6780 \gdef\tabexpand{%
6781 \catcode`\^^I=\active
6782 \def^^I{\leavevmode\egroup
6783 \dimen\verbbox=\wd\verbbox % the width so far, or since the previous tab
6784 \divide\dimen\verbbox by\tabw
6785 \multiply\dimen\verbbox by\tabw % compute previous multiple of \tabw
6786 \advance\dimen\verbbox by\tabw % advance to next multiple of \tabw
6787 \wd\verbbox=\dimen\verbbox \box\verbbox \starttabbox
6790 \endgroup
6792 % start the verbatim environment.
6793 \def\setupverbatim{%
6794 \let\nonarrowing = t%
6795 \nonfillstart
6796 \tt % easiest (and conventionally used) font for verbatim
6797 % The \leavevmode here is for blank lines. Otherwise, we would
6798 % never \starttabox and the \egroup would end verbatim mode.
6799 \def\par{\leavevmode\egroup\box\verbbox\endgraf}%
6800 \tabexpand
6801 \setupmarkupstyle{verbatim}%
6802 % Respect line breaks,
6803 % print special symbols as themselves, and
6804 % make each space count.
6805 % Must do in this order:
6806 \obeylines \uncatcodespecials \sepspaces
6807 \everypar{\starttabbox}%
6810 % Do the @verb magic: verbatim text is quoted by unique
6811 % delimiter characters. Before first delimiter expect a
6812 % right brace, after last delimiter expect closing brace:
6814 % \def\doverb'{'<char>#1<char>'}'{#1}
6816 % [Knuth] p. 382; only eat outer {}
6817 \begingroup
6818 \catcode`[=1\catcode`]=2\catcode`\{=\other\catcode`\}=\other
6819 \gdef\doverb{#1[\def\next##1#1}[##1\endgroup]\next]
6820 \endgroup
6822 \def\verb{\begingroup\setupverb\doverb}
6825 % Do the @verbatim magic: define the macro \doverbatim so that
6826 % the (first) argument ends when '@end verbatim' is reached, ie:
6828 % \def\doverbatim#1@end verbatim{#1}
6830 % For Texinfo it's a lot easier than for LaTeX,
6831 % because texinfo's \verbatim doesn't stop at '\end{verbatim}':
6832 % we need not redefine '\', '{' and '}'.
6834 % Inspired by LaTeX's verbatim command set [latex.ltx]
6836 \begingroup
6837 \catcode`\ =\active
6838 \obeylines %
6839 % ignore everything up to the first ^^M, that's the newline at the end
6840 % of the @verbatim input line itself. Otherwise we get an extra blank
6841 % line in the output.
6842 \xdef\doverbatim#1^^M#2@end verbatim{#2\noexpand\end\gobble verbatim}%
6843 % We really want {...\end verbatim} in the body of the macro, but
6844 % without the active space; thus we have to use \xdef and \gobble.
6845 \endgroup
6847 \envdef\verbatim{%
6848 \setupverbatim\doverbatim
6850 \let\Everbatim = \afterenvbreak
6853 % @verbatiminclude FILE - insert text of file in verbatim environment.
6855 \def\verbatiminclude{\parseargusing\filenamecatcodes\doverbatiminclude}
6857 \def\doverbatiminclude#1{%
6859 \makevalueexpandable
6860 \setupverbatim
6861 \indexnofonts % Allow `@@' and other weird things in file names.
6862 \wlog{texinfo.tex: doing @verbatiminclude of #1^^J}%
6863 \input #1
6864 \afterenvbreak
6868 % @copying ... @end copying.
6869 % Save the text away for @insertcopying later.
6871 % We save the uninterpreted tokens, rather than creating a box.
6872 % Saving the text in a box would be much easier, but then all the
6873 % typesetting commands (@smallbook, font changes, etc.) have to be done
6874 % beforehand -- and a) we want @copying to be done first in the source
6875 % file; b) letting users define the frontmatter in as flexible order as
6876 % possible is very desirable.
6878 \def\copying{\checkenv{}\begingroup\scanargctxt\docopying}
6879 \def\docopying#1@end copying{\endgroup\def\copyingtext{#1}}
6881 \def\insertcopying{%
6882 \begingroup
6883 \parindent = 0pt % paragraph indentation looks wrong on title page
6884 \scanexp\copyingtext
6885 \endgroup
6889 \message{defuns,}
6890 % @defun etc.
6892 \newskip\defbodyindent \defbodyindent=.4in
6893 \newskip\defargsindent \defargsindent=50pt
6894 \newskip\deflastargmargin \deflastargmargin=18pt
6895 \newcount\defunpenalty
6897 % Start the processing of @deffn:
6898 \def\startdefun{%
6899 \ifnum\lastpenalty<10000
6900 \medbreak
6901 \defunpenalty=10003 % Will keep this @deffn together with the
6902 % following @def command, see below.
6903 \else
6904 % If there are two @def commands in a row, we'll have a \nobreak,
6905 % which is there to keep the function description together with its
6906 % header. But if there's nothing but headers, we need to allow a
6907 % break somewhere. Check specifically for penalty 10002, inserted
6908 % by \printdefunline, instead of 10000, since the sectioning
6909 % commands also insert a nobreak penalty, and we don't want to allow
6910 % a break between a section heading and a defun.
6912 % As a further refinement, we avoid "club" headers by signalling
6913 % with penalty of 10003 after the very first @deffn in the
6914 % sequence (see above), and penalty of 10002 after any following
6915 % @def command.
6916 \ifnum\lastpenalty=10002 \penalty2000 \else \defunpenalty=10002 \fi
6918 % Similarly, after a section heading, do not allow a break.
6919 % But do insert the glue.
6920 \medskip % preceded by discardable penalty, so not a breakpoint
6923 \parindent=0in
6924 \advance\leftskip by \defbodyindent
6925 \exdentamount=\defbodyindent
6928 \def\dodefunx#1{%
6929 % First, check whether we are in the right environment:
6930 \checkenv#1%
6932 % As above, allow line break if we have multiple x headers in a row.
6933 % It's not a great place, though.
6934 \ifnum\lastpenalty=10002 \penalty3000 \else \defunpenalty=10002 \fi
6936 % And now, it's time to reuse the body of the original defun:
6937 \expandafter\gobbledefun#1%
6939 \def\gobbledefun#1\startdefun{}
6941 % \printdefunline \deffnheader{text}
6943 \def\printdefunline#1#2{%
6944 \begingroup
6945 % call \deffnheader:
6946 #1#2 \endheader
6947 % common ending:
6948 \interlinepenalty = 10000
6949 \advance\rightskip by 0pt plus 1fil\relax
6950 \endgraf
6951 \nobreak\vskip -\parskip
6952 \penalty\defunpenalty % signal to \startdefun and \dodefunx
6953 % Some of the @defun-type tags do not enable magic parentheses,
6954 % rendering the following check redundant. But we don't optimize.
6955 \checkparencounts
6956 \endgroup
6959 \def\Edefun{\endgraf\medbreak}
6961 % \makedefun{deffn} creates \deffn, \deffnx and \Edeffn;
6962 % the only thing remaining is to define \deffnheader.
6964 \def\makedefun#1{%
6965 \expandafter\let\csname E#1\endcsname = \Edefun
6966 \edef\temp{\noexpand\domakedefun
6967 \makecsname{#1}\makecsname{#1x}\makecsname{#1header}}%
6968 \temp
6971 % \domakedefun \deffn \deffnx \deffnheader
6973 % Define \deffn and \deffnx, without parameters.
6974 % \deffnheader has to be defined explicitly.
6976 \def\domakedefun#1#2#3{%
6977 \envdef#1{%
6978 \startdefun
6979 \doingtypefnfalse % distinguish typed functions from all else
6980 \parseargusing\activeparens{\printdefunline#3}%
6982 \def#2{\dodefunx#1}%
6983 \def#3%
6986 \newif\ifdoingtypefn % doing typed function?
6987 \newif\ifrettypeownline % typeset return type on its own line?
6989 % @deftypefnnewline on|off says whether the return type of typed functions
6990 % are printed on their own line. This affects @deftypefn, @deftypefun,
6991 % @deftypeop, and @deftypemethod.
6993 \parseargdef\deftypefnnewline{%
6994 \def\temp{#1}%
6995 \ifx\temp\onword
6996 \expandafter\let\csname SETtxideftypefnnl\endcsname
6997 = \empty
6998 \else\ifx\temp\offword
6999 \expandafter\let\csname SETtxideftypefnnl\endcsname
7000 = \relax
7001 \else
7002 \errhelp = \EMsimple
7003 \errmessage{Unknown @txideftypefnnl value `\temp',
7004 must be on|off}%
7005 \fi\fi
7008 % Untyped functions:
7010 % @deffn category name args
7011 \makedefun{deffn}{\deffngeneral{}}
7013 % @deffn category class name args
7014 \makedefun{defop}#1 {\defopon{#1\ \putwordon}}
7016 % \defopon {category on}class name args
7017 \def\defopon#1#2 {\deffngeneral{\putwordon\ \code{#2}}{#1\ \code{#2}} }
7019 % \deffngeneral {subind}category name args
7021 \def\deffngeneral#1#2 #3 #4\endheader{%
7022 % Remember that \dosubind{fn}{foo}{} is equivalent to \doind{fn}{foo}.
7023 \dosubind{fn}{\code{#3}}{#1}%
7024 \defname{#2}{}{#3}\magicamp\defunargs{#4\unskip}%
7027 % Typed functions:
7029 % @deftypefn category type name args
7030 \makedefun{deftypefn}{\deftypefngeneral{}}
7032 % @deftypeop category class type name args
7033 \makedefun{deftypeop}#1 {\deftypeopon{#1\ \putwordon}}
7035 % \deftypeopon {category on}class type name args
7036 \def\deftypeopon#1#2 {\deftypefngeneral{\putwordon\ \code{#2}}{#1\ \code{#2}} }
7038 % \deftypefngeneral {subind}category type name args
7040 \def\deftypefngeneral#1#2 #3 #4 #5\endheader{%
7041 \dosubind{fn}{\code{#4}}{#1}%
7042 \doingtypefntrue
7043 \defname{#2}{#3}{#4}\defunargs{#5\unskip}%
7046 % Typed variables:
7048 % @deftypevr category type var args
7049 \makedefun{deftypevr}{\deftypecvgeneral{}}
7051 % @deftypecv category class type var args
7052 \makedefun{deftypecv}#1 {\deftypecvof{#1\ \putwordof}}
7054 % \deftypecvof {category of}class type var args
7055 \def\deftypecvof#1#2 {\deftypecvgeneral{\putwordof\ \code{#2}}{#1\ \code{#2}} }
7057 % \deftypecvgeneral {subind}category type var args
7059 \def\deftypecvgeneral#1#2 #3 #4 #5\endheader{%
7060 \dosubind{vr}{\code{#4}}{#1}%
7061 \defname{#2}{#3}{#4}\defunargs{#5\unskip}%
7064 % Untyped variables:
7066 % @defvr category var args
7067 \makedefun{defvr}#1 {\deftypevrheader{#1} {} }
7069 % @defcv category class var args
7070 \makedefun{defcv}#1 {\defcvof{#1\ \putwordof}}
7072 % \defcvof {category of}class var args
7073 \def\defcvof#1#2 {\deftypecvof{#1}#2 {} }
7075 % Types:
7077 % @deftp category name args
7078 \makedefun{deftp}#1 #2 #3\endheader{%
7079 \doind{tp}{\code{#2}}%
7080 \defname{#1}{}{#2}\defunargs{#3\unskip}%
7083 % Remaining @defun-like shortcuts:
7084 \makedefun{defun}{\deffnheader{\putwordDeffunc} }
7085 \makedefun{defmac}{\deffnheader{\putwordDefmac} }
7086 \makedefun{defspec}{\deffnheader{\putwordDefspec} }
7087 \makedefun{deftypefun}{\deftypefnheader{\putwordDeffunc} }
7088 \makedefun{defvar}{\defvrheader{\putwordDefvar} }
7089 \makedefun{defopt}{\defvrheader{\putwordDefopt} }
7090 \makedefun{deftypevar}{\deftypevrheader{\putwordDefvar} }
7091 \makedefun{defmethod}{\defopon\putwordMethodon}
7092 \makedefun{deftypemethod}{\deftypeopon\putwordMethodon}
7093 \makedefun{defivar}{\defcvof\putwordInstanceVariableof}
7094 \makedefun{deftypeivar}{\deftypecvof\putwordInstanceVariableof}
7096 % \defname, which formats the name of the @def (not the args).
7097 % #1 is the category, such as "Function".
7098 % #2 is the return type, if any.
7099 % #3 is the function name.
7101 % We are followed by (but not passed) the arguments, if any.
7103 \def\defname#1#2#3{%
7104 \par
7105 % Get the values of \leftskip and \rightskip as they were outside the @def...
7106 \advance\leftskip by -\defbodyindent
7108 % Determine if we are typesetting the return type of a typed function
7109 % on a line by itself.
7110 \rettypeownlinefalse
7111 \ifdoingtypefn % doing a typed function specifically?
7112 % then check user option for putting return type on its own line:
7113 \expandafter\ifx\csname SETtxideftypefnnl\endcsname\relax \else
7114 \rettypeownlinetrue
7118 % How we'll format the category name. Putting it in brackets helps
7119 % distinguish it from the body text that may end up on the next line
7120 % just below it.
7121 \def\temp{#1}%
7122 \setbox0=\hbox{\kern\deflastargmargin \ifx\temp\empty\else [\rm\temp]\fi}
7124 % Figure out line sizes for the paragraph shape. We'll always have at
7125 % least two.
7126 \tempnum = 2
7128 % The first line needs space for \box0; but if \rightskip is nonzero,
7129 % we need only space for the part of \box0 which exceeds it:
7130 \dimen0=\hsize \advance\dimen0 by -\wd0 \advance\dimen0 by \rightskip
7132 % If doing a return type on its own line, we'll have another line.
7133 \ifrettypeownline
7134 \advance\tempnum by 1
7135 \def\maybeshapeline{0in \hsize}%
7136 \else
7137 \def\maybeshapeline{}%
7140 % The continuations:
7141 \dimen2=\hsize \advance\dimen2 by -\defargsindent
7143 % The final paragraph shape:
7144 \parshape \tempnum 0in \dimen0 \maybeshapeline \defargsindent \dimen2
7146 % Put the category name at the right margin.
7147 \noindent
7148 \hbox to 0pt{%
7149 \hfil\box0 \kern-\hsize
7150 % \hsize has to be shortened this way:
7151 \kern\leftskip
7152 % Intentionally do not respect \rightskip, since we need the space.
7155 % Allow all lines to be underfull without complaint:
7156 \tolerance=10000 \hbadness=10000
7157 \exdentamount=\defbodyindent
7159 % defun fonts. We use typewriter by default (used to be bold) because:
7160 % . we're printing identifiers, they should be in tt in principle.
7161 % . in languages with many accents, such as Czech or French, it's
7162 % common to leave accents off identifiers. The result looks ok in
7163 % tt, but exceedingly strange in rm.
7164 % . we don't want -- and --- to be treated as ligatures.
7165 % . this still does not fix the ?` and !` ligatures, but so far no
7166 % one has made identifiers using them :).
7167 \df \tt
7168 \def\temp{#2}% text of the return type
7169 \ifx\temp\empty\else
7170 \tclose{\temp}% typeset the return type
7171 \ifrettypeownline
7172 % put return type on its own line; prohibit line break following:
7173 \hfil\vadjust{\nobreak}\break
7174 \else
7175 \space % type on same line, so just followed by a space
7177 \fi % no return type
7178 #3% output function name
7180 {\rm\enskip}% hskip 0.5 em of \tenrm
7182 \boldbrax
7183 % arguments will be output next, if any.
7186 % Print arguments in slanted roman (not ttsl), inconsistently with using
7187 % tt for the name. This is because literal text is sometimes needed in
7188 % the argument list (groff manual), and ttsl and tt are not very
7189 % distinguishable. Prevent hyphenation at `-' chars.
7191 \def\defunargs#1{%
7192 % use sl by default (not ttsl),
7193 % tt for the names.
7194 \df \sl \hyphenchar\font=0
7196 % On the other hand, if an argument has two dashes (for instance), we
7197 % want a way to get ttsl. We used to recommend @var for that, so
7198 % leave the code in, but it's strange for @var to lead to typewriter.
7199 % Nowadays we recommend @code, since the difference between a ttsl hyphen
7200 % and a tt hyphen is pretty tiny. @code also disables ?` !`.
7201 \def\var##1{{\setupmarkupstyle{var}\ttslanted{##1}}}%
7203 \sl\hyphenchar\font=45
7206 % We want ()&[] to print specially on the defun line.
7208 \def\activeparens{%
7209 \catcode`\(=\active \catcode`\)=\active
7210 \catcode`\[=\active \catcode`\]=\active
7211 \catcode`\&=\active
7214 % Make control sequences which act like normal parenthesis chars.
7215 \let\lparen = ( \let\rparen = )
7217 % Be sure that we always have a definition for `(', etc. For example,
7218 % if the fn name has parens in it, \boldbrax will not be in effect yet,
7219 % so TeX would otherwise complain about undefined control sequence.
7221 \activeparens
7222 \global\let(=\lparen \global\let)=\rparen
7223 \global\let[=\lbrack \global\let]=\rbrack
7224 \global\let& = \&
7226 \gdef\boldbrax{\let(=\opnr\let)=\clnr\let[=\lbrb\let]=\rbrb}
7227 \gdef\magicamp{\let&=\amprm}
7230 \newcount\parencount
7232 % If we encounter &foo, then turn on ()-hacking afterwards
7233 \newif\ifampseen
7234 \def\amprm#1 {\ampseentrue{\bf\&#1 }}
7236 \def\parenfont{%
7237 \ifampseen
7238 % At the first level, print parens in roman,
7239 % otherwise use the default font.
7240 \ifnum \parencount=1 \rm \fi
7241 \else
7242 % The \sf parens (in \boldbrax) actually are a little bolder than
7243 % the contained text. This is especially needed for [ and ] .
7247 \def\infirstlevel#1{%
7248 \ifampseen
7249 \ifnum\parencount=1
7254 \def\bfafterword#1 {#1 \bf}
7256 \def\opnr{%
7257 \global\advance\parencount by 1
7258 {\parenfont(}%
7259 \infirstlevel \bfafterword
7261 \def\clnr{%
7262 {\parenfont)}%
7263 \infirstlevel \sl
7264 \global\advance\parencount by -1
7267 \newcount\brackcount
7268 \def\lbrb{%
7269 \global\advance\brackcount by 1
7270 {\bf[}%
7272 \def\rbrb{%
7273 {\bf]}%
7274 \global\advance\brackcount by -1
7277 \def\checkparencounts{%
7278 \ifnum\parencount=0 \else \badparencount \fi
7279 \ifnum\brackcount=0 \else \badbrackcount \fi
7281 % these should not use \errmessage; the glibc manual, at least, actually
7282 % has such constructs (when documenting function pointers).
7283 \def\badparencount{%
7284 \message{Warning: unbalanced parentheses in @def...}%
7285 \global\parencount=0
7287 \def\badbrackcount{%
7288 \message{Warning: unbalanced square brackets in @def...}%
7289 \global\brackcount=0
7293 \message{macros,}
7294 % @macro.
7296 % To do this right we need a feature of e-TeX, \scantokens,
7297 % which we arrange to emulate with a temporary file in ordinary TeX.
7298 \ifx\eTeXversion\thisisundefined
7299 \newwrite\macscribble
7300 \def\scantokens#1{%
7301 \toks0={#1}%
7302 \immediate\openout\macscribble=\jobname.tmp
7303 \immediate\write\macscribble{\the\toks0}%
7304 \immediate\closeout\macscribble
7305 \input \jobname.tmp
7309 \def\scanmacro#1{\begingroup
7310 \newlinechar`\^^M
7311 \let\xeatspaces\eatspaces
7313 % Undo catcode changes of \startcontents and \doprintindex
7314 % When called from @insertcopying or (short)caption, we need active
7315 % backslash to get it printed correctly. Previously, we had
7316 % \catcode`\\=\other instead. We'll see whether a problem appears
7317 % with macro expansion. --kasal, 19aug04
7318 \catcode`\@=0 \catcode`\\=\active \escapechar=`\@
7320 % ... and for \example:
7321 \spaceisspace
7323 % The \empty here causes a following catcode 5 newline to be eaten as
7324 % part of reading whitespace after a control sequence. It does not
7325 % eat a catcode 13 newline. There's no good way to handle the two
7326 % cases (untried: maybe e-TeX's \everyeof could help, though plain TeX
7327 % would then have different behavior). See the Macro Details node in
7328 % the manual for the workaround we recommend for macros and
7329 % line-oriented commands.
7331 \scantokens{#1\empty}%
7332 \endgroup}
7334 \def\scanexp#1{%
7335 \edef\temp{\noexpand\scanmacro{#1}}%
7336 \temp
7339 \newcount\paramno % Count of parameters
7340 \newtoks\macname % Macro name
7341 \newif\ifrecursive % Is it recursive?
7343 % List of all defined macros in the form
7344 % \definedummyword\macro1\definedummyword\macro2...
7345 % Currently is also contains all @aliases; the list can be split
7346 % if there is a need.
7347 \def\macrolist{}
7349 % Add the macro to \macrolist
7350 \def\addtomacrolist#1{\expandafter \addtomacrolistxxx \csname#1\endcsname}
7351 \def\addtomacrolistxxx#1{%
7352 \toks0 = \expandafter{\macrolist\definedummyword#1}%
7353 \xdef\macrolist{\the\toks0}%
7356 % Utility routines.
7357 % This does \let #1 = #2, with \csnames; that is,
7358 % \let \csname#1\endcsname = \csname#2\endcsname
7359 % (except of course we have to play expansion games).
7361 \def\cslet#1#2{%
7362 \expandafter\let
7363 \csname#1\expandafter\endcsname
7364 \csname#2\endcsname
7367 % Trim leading and trailing spaces off a string.
7368 % Concepts from aro-bend problem 15 (see CTAN).
7369 {\catcode`\@=11
7370 \gdef\eatspaces #1{\expandafter\trim@\expandafter{#1 }}
7371 \gdef\trim@ #1{\trim@@ @#1 @ #1 @ @@}
7372 \gdef\trim@@ #1@ #2@ #3@@{\trim@@@\empty #2 @}
7373 \def\unbrace#1{#1}
7374 \unbrace{\gdef\trim@@@ #1 } #2@{#1}
7377 % Trim a single trailing ^^M off a string.
7378 {\catcode`\^^M=\other \catcode`\Q=3%
7379 \gdef\eatcr #1{\eatcra #1Q^^MQ}%
7380 \gdef\eatcra#1^^MQ{\eatcrb#1Q}%
7381 \gdef\eatcrb#1Q#2Q{#1}%
7384 % Macro bodies are absorbed as an argument in a context where
7385 % all characters are catcode 10, 11 or 12, except \ which is active
7386 % (as in normal texinfo). It is necessary to change the definition of \
7387 % to recognize macro arguments; this is the job of \mbodybackslash.
7389 % Non-ASCII encodings make 8-bit characters active, so un-activate
7390 % them to avoid their expansion. Must do this non-globally, to
7391 % confine the change to the current group.
7393 % It's necessary to have hard CRs when the macro is executed. This is
7394 % done by making ^^M (\endlinechar) catcode 12 when reading the macro
7395 % body, and then making it the \newlinechar in \scanmacro.
7397 \def\scanctxt{% used as subroutine
7398 \catcode`\"=\other
7399 \catcode`\+=\other
7400 \catcode`\<=\other
7401 \catcode`\>=\other
7402 \catcode`\@=\other
7403 \catcode`\^=\other
7404 \catcode`\_=\other
7405 \catcode`\|=\other
7406 \catcode`\~=\other
7407 \ifx\declaredencoding\ascii \else \setnonasciicharscatcodenonglobal\other \fi
7410 \def\scanargctxt{% used for copying and captions, not macros.
7411 \scanctxt
7412 \catcode`\\=\other
7413 \catcode`\^^M=\other
7416 \def\macrobodyctxt{% used for @macro definitions
7417 \scanctxt
7418 \catcode`\{=\other
7419 \catcode`\}=\other
7420 \catcode`\^^M=\other
7421 \usembodybackslash
7424 \def\macroargctxt{% used when scanning invocations
7425 \scanctxt
7426 \catcode`\\=0
7428 % why catcode 0 for \ in the above? To recognize \\ \{ \} as "escapes"
7429 % for the single characters \ { }. Thus, we end up with the "commands"
7430 % that would be written @\ @{ @} in a Texinfo document.
7432 % We already have @{ and @}. For @\, we define it here, and only for
7433 % this purpose, to produce a typewriter backslash (so, the @\ that we
7434 % define for @math can't be used with @macro calls):
7436 \def\\{\normalbackslash}%
7438 % We would like to do this for \, too, since that is what makeinfo does.
7439 % But it is not possible, because Texinfo already has a command @, for a
7440 % cedilla accent. Documents must use @comma{} instead.
7442 % \anythingelse will almost certainly be an error of some kind.
7444 % \mbodybackslash is the definition of \ in @macro bodies.
7445 % It maps \foo\ => \csname macarg.foo\endcsname => #N
7446 % where N is the macro parameter number.
7447 % We define \csname macarg.\endcsname to be \realbackslash, so
7448 % \\ in macro replacement text gets you a backslash.
7450 {\catcode`@=0 @catcode`@\=@active
7451 @gdef@usembodybackslash{@let\=@mbodybackslash}
7452 @gdef@mbodybackslash#1\{@csname macarg.#1@endcsname}
7454 \expandafter\def\csname macarg.\endcsname{\realbackslash}
7456 \def\margbackslash#1{\char`\#1 }
7458 \def\macro{\recursivefalse\parsearg\macroxxx}
7459 \def\rmacro{\recursivetrue\parsearg\macroxxx}
7461 \def\macroxxx#1{%
7462 \getargs{#1}% now \macname is the macname and \argl the arglist
7463 \ifx\argl\empty % no arguments
7464 \paramno=0\relax
7465 \else
7466 \expandafter\parsemargdef \argl;%
7467 \if\paramno>256\relax
7468 \ifx\eTeXversion\thisisundefined
7469 \errhelp = \EMsimple
7470 \errmessage{You need eTeX to compile a file with macros with more than 256 arguments}
7474 \if1\csname ismacro.\the\macname\endcsname
7475 \message{Warning: redefining \the\macname}%
7476 \else
7477 \expandafter\ifx\csname \the\macname\endcsname \relax
7478 \else \errmessage{Macro name \the\macname\space already defined}\fi
7479 \global\cslet{macsave.\the\macname}{\the\macname}%
7480 \global\expandafter\let\csname ismacro.\the\macname\endcsname=1%
7481 \addtomacrolist{\the\macname}%
7483 \begingroup \macrobodyctxt
7484 \ifrecursive \expandafter\parsermacbody
7485 \else \expandafter\parsemacbody
7486 \fi}
7488 \parseargdef\unmacro{%
7489 \if1\csname ismacro.#1\endcsname
7490 \global\cslet{#1}{macsave.#1}%
7491 \global\expandafter\let \csname ismacro.#1\endcsname=0%
7492 % Remove the macro name from \macrolist:
7493 \begingroup
7494 \expandafter\let\csname#1\endcsname \relax
7495 \let\definedummyword\unmacrodo
7496 \xdef\macrolist{\macrolist}%
7497 \endgroup
7498 \else
7499 \errmessage{Macro #1 not defined}%
7503 % Called by \do from \dounmacro on each macro. The idea is to omit any
7504 % macro definitions that have been changed to \relax.
7506 \def\unmacrodo#1{%
7507 \ifx #1\relax
7508 % remove this
7509 \else
7510 \noexpand\definedummyword \noexpand#1%
7514 % This makes use of the obscure feature that if the last token of a
7515 % <parameter list> is #, then the preceding argument is delimited by
7516 % an opening brace, and that opening brace is not consumed.
7517 \def\getargs#1{\getargsxxx#1{}}
7518 \def\getargsxxx#1#{\getmacname #1 \relax\getmacargs}
7519 \def\getmacname#1 #2\relax{\macname={#1}}
7520 \def\getmacargs#1{\def\argl{#1}}
7522 % For macro processing make @ a letter so that we can make Texinfo private macro names.
7523 \edef\texiatcatcode{\the\catcode`\@}
7524 \catcode `@=11\relax
7526 % Parse the optional {params} list. Set up \paramno and \paramlist
7527 % so \defmacro knows what to do. Define \macarg.BLAH for each BLAH
7528 % in the params list to some hook where the argument is to be expanded. If
7529 % there are less than 10 arguments that hook is to be replaced by ##N where N
7530 % is the position in that list, that is to say the macro arguments are to be
7531 % defined `a la TeX in the macro body.
7533 % That gets used by \mbodybackslash (above).
7535 % We need to get `macro parameter char #' into several definitions.
7536 % The technique used is stolen from LaTeX: let \hash be something
7537 % unexpandable, insert that wherever you need a #, and then redefine
7538 % it to # just before using the token list produced.
7540 % The same technique is used to protect \eatspaces till just before
7541 % the macro is used.
7543 % If there are 10 or more arguments, a different technique is used, where the
7544 % hook remains in the body, and when macro is to be expanded the body is
7545 % processed again to replace the arguments.
7547 % In that case, the hook is \the\toks N-1, and we simply set \toks N-1 to the
7548 % argument N value and then \edef the body (nothing else will expand because of
7549 % the catcode regime underwhich the body was input).
7551 % If you compile with TeX (not eTeX), and you have macros with 10 or more
7552 % arguments, no macro can have more than 256 arguments (else error).
7553 \def\parsemargdef#1;{%
7554 \paramno=0\def\paramlist{}%
7555 \let\hash\relax
7556 \let\xeatspaces\relax
7557 \parsemargdefxxx#1,;,%
7558 % In case that there are 10 or more arguments we parse again the arguments
7559 % list to set new definitions for the \macarg.BLAH macros corresponding to
7560 % each BLAH argument. It was anyhow needed to parse already once this list
7561 % in order to count the arguments, and as macros with at most 9 arguments
7562 % are by far more frequent than macro with 10 or more arguments, defining
7563 % twice the \macarg.BLAH macros does not cost too much processing power.
7564 \ifnum\paramno<10\relax\else
7565 \paramno0\relax
7566 \parsemmanyargdef@@#1,;,% 10 or more arguments
7569 \def\parsemargdefxxx#1,{%
7570 \if#1;\let\next=\relax
7571 \else \let\next=\parsemargdefxxx
7572 \advance\paramno by 1
7573 \expandafter\edef\csname macarg.\eatspaces{#1}\endcsname
7574 {\xeatspaces{\hash\the\paramno}}%
7575 \edef\paramlist{\paramlist\hash\the\paramno,}%
7576 \fi\next}
7578 \def\parsemmanyargdef@@#1,{%
7579 \if#1;\let\next=\relax
7580 \else
7581 \let\next=\parsemmanyargdef@@
7582 \edef\tempb{\eatspaces{#1}}%
7583 \expandafter\def\expandafter\tempa
7584 \expandafter{\csname macarg.\tempb\endcsname}%
7585 % Note that we need some extra \noexpand\noexpand, this is because we
7586 % don't want \the to be expanded in the \parsermacbody as it uses an
7587 % \xdef .
7588 \expandafter\edef\tempa
7589 {\noexpand\noexpand\noexpand\the\toks\the\paramno}%
7590 \advance\paramno by 1\relax
7591 \fi\next}
7593 % These two commands read recursive and nonrecursive macro bodies.
7594 % (They're different since rec and nonrec macros end differently.)
7597 \catcode `\@\texiatcatcode
7598 \long\def\parsemacbody#1@end macro%
7599 {\xdef\temp{\eatcr{#1}}\endgroup\defmacro}%
7600 \long\def\parsermacbody#1@end rmacro%
7601 {\xdef\temp{\eatcr{#1}}\endgroup\defmacro}%
7602 \catcode `\@=11\relax
7604 \let\endargs@\relax
7605 \let\nil@\relax
7606 \def\nilm@{\nil@}%
7607 \long\def\nillm@{\nil@}%
7609 % This macro is expanded during the Texinfo macro expansion, not during its
7610 % definition. It gets all the arguments values and assigns them to macros
7611 % macarg.ARGNAME
7613 % #1 is the macro name
7614 % #2 is the list of argument names
7615 % #3 is the list of argument values
7616 \def\getargvals@#1#2#3{%
7617 \def\macargdeflist@{}%
7618 \def\saveparamlist@{#2}% Need to keep a copy for parameter expansion.
7619 \def\paramlist{#2,\nil@}%
7620 \def\macroname{#1}%
7621 \begingroup
7622 \macroargctxt
7623 \def\argvaluelist{#3,\nil@}%
7624 \def\@tempa{#3}%
7625 \ifx\@tempa\empty
7626 \setemptyargvalues@
7627 \else
7628 \getargvals@@
7633 \def\getargvals@@{%
7634 \ifx\paramlist\nilm@
7635 % Some sanity check needed here that \argvaluelist is also empty.
7636 \ifx\argvaluelist\nillm@
7637 \else
7638 \errhelp = \EMsimple
7639 \errmessage{Too many arguments in macro `\macroname'!}%
7641 \let\next\macargexpandinbody@
7642 \else
7643 \ifx\argvaluelist\nillm@
7644 % No more arguments values passed to macro. Set remaining named-arg
7645 % macros to empty.
7646 \let\next\setemptyargvalues@
7647 \else
7648 % pop current arg name into \@tempb
7649 \def\@tempa##1{\pop@{\@tempb}{\paramlist}##1\endargs@}%
7650 \expandafter\@tempa\expandafter{\paramlist}%
7651 % pop current argument value into \@tempc
7652 \def\@tempa##1{\longpop@{\@tempc}{\argvaluelist}##1\endargs@}%
7653 \expandafter\@tempa\expandafter{\argvaluelist}%
7654 % Here \@tempb is the current arg name and \@tempc is the current arg value.
7655 % First place the new argument macro definition into \@tempd
7656 \expandafter\macname\expandafter{\@tempc}%
7657 \expandafter\let\csname macarg.\@tempb\endcsname\relax
7658 \expandafter\def\expandafter\@tempe\expandafter{%
7659 \csname macarg.\@tempb\endcsname}%
7660 \edef\@tempd{\long\def\@tempe{\the\macname}}%
7661 \push@\@tempd\macargdeflist@
7662 \let\next\getargvals@@
7665 \next
7668 \def\push@#1#2{%
7669 \expandafter\expandafter\expandafter\def
7670 \expandafter\expandafter\expandafter#2%
7671 \expandafter\expandafter\expandafter{%
7672 \expandafter#1#2}%
7675 % Replace arguments by their values in the macro body, and place the result
7676 % in macro \@tempa
7677 \def\macvalstoargs@{%
7678 % To do this we use the property that token registers that are \the'ed
7679 % within an \edef expand only once. So we are going to place all argument
7680 % values into respective token registers.
7682 % First we save the token context, and initialize argument numbering.
7683 \begingroup
7684 \paramno0\relax
7685 % Then, for each argument number #N, we place the corresponding argument
7686 % value into a new token list register \toks#N
7687 \expandafter\putargsintokens@\saveparamlist@,;,%
7688 % Then, we expand the body so that argument are replaced by their
7689 % values. The trick for values not to be expanded themselves is that they
7690 % are within tokens and that tokens expand only once in an \edef .
7691 \edef\@tempc{\csname mac.\macroname .body\endcsname}%
7692 % Now we restore the token stack pointer to free the token list registers
7693 % which we have used, but we make sure that expanded body is saved after
7694 % group.
7695 \expandafter
7696 \endgroup
7697 \expandafter\def\expandafter\@tempa\expandafter{\@tempc}%
7700 \def\macargexpandinbody@{%
7701 %% Define the named-macro outside of this group and then close this group.
7702 \expandafter
7703 \endgroup
7704 \macargdeflist@
7705 % First the replace in body the macro arguments by their values, the result
7706 % is in \@tempa .
7707 \macvalstoargs@
7708 % Then we point at the \norecurse or \gobble (for recursive) macro value
7709 % with \@tempb .
7710 \expandafter\let\expandafter\@tempb\csname mac.\macroname .recurse\endcsname
7711 % Depending on whether it is recursive or not, we need some tailing
7712 % \egroup .
7713 \ifx\@tempb\gobble
7714 \let\@tempc\relax
7715 \else
7716 \let\@tempc\egroup
7718 % And now we do the real job:
7719 \edef\@tempd{\noexpand\@tempb{\macroname}\noexpand\scanmacro{\@tempa}\@tempc}%
7720 \@tempd
7723 \def\putargsintokens@#1,{%
7724 \if#1;\let\next\relax
7725 \else
7726 \let\next\putargsintokens@
7727 % First we allocate the new token list register, and give it a temporary
7728 % alias \@tempb .
7729 \toksdef\@tempb\the\paramno
7730 % Then we place the argument value into that token list register.
7731 \expandafter\let\expandafter\@tempa\csname macarg.#1\endcsname
7732 \expandafter\@tempb\expandafter{\@tempa}%
7733 \advance\paramno by 1\relax
7735 \next
7738 % Save the token stack pointer into macro #1
7739 \def\texisavetoksstackpoint#1{\edef#1{\the\@cclvi}}
7740 % Restore the token stack pointer from number in macro #1
7741 \def\texirestoretoksstackpoint#1{\expandafter\mathchardef\expandafter\@cclvi#1\relax}
7742 % newtoks that can be used non \outer .
7743 \def\texinonouternewtoks{\alloc@ 5\toks \toksdef \@cclvi}
7745 % Tailing missing arguments are set to empty
7746 \def\setemptyargvalues@{%
7747 \ifx\paramlist\nilm@
7748 \let\next\macargexpandinbody@
7749 \else
7750 \expandafter\setemptyargvaluesparser@\paramlist\endargs@
7751 \let\next\setemptyargvalues@
7753 \next
7756 \def\setemptyargvaluesparser@#1,#2\endargs@{%
7757 \expandafter\def\expandafter\@tempa\expandafter{%
7758 \expandafter\def\csname macarg.#1\endcsname{}}%
7759 \push@\@tempa\macargdeflist@
7760 \def\paramlist{#2}%
7763 % #1 is the element target macro
7764 % #2 is the list macro
7765 % #3,#4\endargs@ is the list value
7766 \def\pop@#1#2#3,#4\endargs@{%
7767 \def#1{#3}%
7768 \def#2{#4}%
7770 \long\def\longpop@#1#2#3,#4\endargs@{%
7771 \long\def#1{#3}%
7772 \long\def#2{#4}%
7775 % This defines a Texinfo @macro. There are eight cases: recursive and
7776 % nonrecursive macros of zero, one, up to nine, and many arguments.
7777 % Much magic with \expandafter here.
7778 % \xdef is used so that macro definitions will survive the file
7779 % they're defined in; @include reads the file inside a group.
7781 \def\defmacro{%
7782 \let\hash=##% convert placeholders to macro parameter chars
7783 \ifrecursive
7784 \ifcase\paramno
7786 \expandafter\xdef\csname\the\macname\endcsname{%
7787 \noexpand\scanmacro{\temp}}%
7788 \or % 1
7789 \expandafter\xdef\csname\the\macname\endcsname{%
7790 \bgroup\noexpand\macroargctxt
7791 \noexpand\braceorline
7792 \expandafter\noexpand\csname\the\macname xxx\endcsname}%
7793 \expandafter\xdef\csname\the\macname xxx\endcsname##1{%
7794 \egroup\noexpand\scanmacro{\temp}}%
7795 \else
7796 \ifnum\paramno<10\relax % at most 9
7797 \expandafter\xdef\csname\the\macname\endcsname{%
7798 \bgroup\noexpand\macroargctxt
7799 \noexpand\csname\the\macname xx\endcsname}%
7800 \expandafter\xdef\csname\the\macname xx\endcsname##1{%
7801 \expandafter\noexpand\csname\the\macname xxx\endcsname ##1,}%
7802 \expandafter\expandafter
7803 \expandafter\xdef
7804 \expandafter\expandafter
7805 \csname\the\macname xxx\endcsname
7806 \paramlist{\egroup\noexpand\scanmacro{\temp}}%
7807 \else % 10 or more
7808 \expandafter\xdef\csname\the\macname\endcsname{%
7809 \noexpand\getargvals@{\the\macname}{\argl}%
7811 \global\expandafter\let\csname mac.\the\macname .body\endcsname\temp
7812 \global\expandafter\let\csname mac.\the\macname .recurse\endcsname\gobble
7815 \else
7816 \ifcase\paramno
7818 \expandafter\xdef\csname\the\macname\endcsname{%
7819 \noexpand\norecurse{\the\macname}%
7820 \noexpand\scanmacro{\temp}\egroup}%
7821 \or % 1
7822 \expandafter\xdef\csname\the\macname\endcsname{%
7823 \bgroup\noexpand\macroargctxt
7824 \noexpand\braceorline
7825 \expandafter\noexpand\csname\the\macname xxx\endcsname}%
7826 \expandafter\xdef\csname\the\macname xxx\endcsname##1{%
7827 \egroup
7828 \noexpand\norecurse{\the\macname}%
7829 \noexpand\scanmacro{\temp}\egroup}%
7830 \else % at most 9
7831 \ifnum\paramno<10\relax
7832 \expandafter\xdef\csname\the\macname\endcsname{%
7833 \bgroup\noexpand\macroargctxt
7834 \expandafter\noexpand\csname\the\macname xx\endcsname}%
7835 \expandafter\xdef\csname\the\macname xx\endcsname##1{%
7836 \expandafter\noexpand\csname\the\macname xxx\endcsname ##1,}%
7837 \expandafter\expandafter
7838 \expandafter\xdef
7839 \expandafter\expandafter
7840 \csname\the\macname xxx\endcsname
7841 \paramlist{%
7842 \egroup
7843 \noexpand\norecurse{\the\macname}%
7844 \noexpand\scanmacro{\temp}\egroup}%
7845 \else % 10 or more:
7846 \expandafter\xdef\csname\the\macname\endcsname{%
7847 \noexpand\getargvals@{\the\macname}{\argl}%
7849 \global\expandafter\let\csname mac.\the\macname .body\endcsname\temp
7850 \global\expandafter\let\csname mac.\the\macname .recurse\endcsname\norecurse
7853 \fi}
7855 \catcode `\@\texiatcatcode\relax
7857 \def\norecurse#1{\bgroup\cslet{#1}{macsave.#1}}
7859 % \braceorline decides whether the next nonwhitespace character is a
7860 % {. If so it reads up to the closing }, if not, it reads the whole
7861 % line. Whatever was read is then fed to the next control sequence
7862 % as an argument (by \parsebrace or \parsearg).
7864 \def\braceorline#1{\let\macnamexxx=#1\futurelet\nchar\braceorlinexxx}
7865 \def\braceorlinexxx{%
7866 \ifx\nchar\bgroup\else
7867 \expandafter\parsearg
7868 \fi \macnamexxx}
7871 % @alias.
7872 % We need some trickery to remove the optional spaces around the equal
7873 % sign. Make them active and then expand them all to nothing.
7875 \def\alias{\parseargusing\obeyspaces\aliasxxx}
7876 \def\aliasxxx #1{\aliasyyy#1\relax}
7877 \def\aliasyyy #1=#2\relax{%
7879 \expandafter\let\obeyedspace=\empty
7880 \addtomacrolist{#1}%
7881 \xdef\next{\global\let\makecsname{#1}=\makecsname{#2}}%
7883 \next
7887 \message{cross references,}
7889 \newwrite\auxfile
7890 \newif\ifhavexrefs % True if xref values are known.
7891 \newif\ifwarnedxrefs % True if we warned once that they aren't known.
7893 % @inforef is relatively simple.
7894 \def\inforef #1{\inforefzzz #1,,,,**}
7895 \def\inforefzzz #1,#2,#3,#4**{%
7896 \putwordSee{} \putwordInfo{} \putwordfile{} \file{\ignorespaces #3{}},
7897 node \samp{\ignorespaces#1{}}}
7899 % @node's only job in TeX is to define \lastnode, which is used in
7900 % cross-references. The @node line might or might not have commas, and
7901 % might or might not have spaces before the first comma, like:
7902 % @node foo , bar , ...
7903 % We don't want such trailing spaces in the node name.
7905 \parseargdef\node{\checkenv{}\donode #1 ,\finishnodeparse}
7907 % also remove a trailing comma, in case of something like this:
7908 % @node Help-Cross, , , Cross-refs
7909 \def\donode#1 ,#2\finishnodeparse{\dodonode #1,\finishnodeparse}
7910 \def\dodonode#1,#2\finishnodeparse{\gdef\lastnode{#1}}
7912 \let\nwnode=\node
7913 \let\lastnode=\empty
7915 % Write a cross-reference definition for the current node. #1 is the
7916 % type (Ynumbered, Yappendix, Ynothing).
7918 \def\donoderef#1{%
7919 \ifx\lastnode\empty\else
7920 \setref{\lastnode}{#1}%
7921 \global\let\lastnode=\empty
7925 % @anchor{NAME} -- define xref target at arbitrary point.
7927 \newcount\savesfregister
7929 \def\savesf{\relax \ifhmode \savesfregister=\spacefactor \fi}
7930 \def\restoresf{\relax \ifhmode \spacefactor=\savesfregister \fi}
7931 \def\anchor#1{\savesf \setref{#1}{Ynothing}\restoresf \ignorespaces}
7933 % \setref{NAME}{SNT} defines a cross-reference point NAME (a node or an
7934 % anchor), which consists of three parts:
7935 % 1) NAME-title - the current sectioning name taken from \lastsection,
7936 % or the anchor name.
7937 % 2) NAME-snt - section number and type, passed as the SNT arg, or
7938 % empty for anchors.
7939 % 3) NAME-pg - the page number.
7941 % This is called from \donoderef, \anchor, and \dofloat. In the case of
7942 % floats, there is an additional part, which is not written here:
7943 % 4) NAME-lof - the text as it should appear in a @listoffloats.
7945 \def\setref#1#2{%
7946 \pdfmkdest{#1}%
7947 \iflinks
7949 \atdummies % preserve commands, but don't expand them
7950 \edef\writexrdef##1##2{%
7951 \write\auxfile{@xrdef{#1-% #1 of \setref, expanded by the \edef
7952 ##1}{##2}}% these are parameters of \writexrdef
7954 \toks0 = \expandafter{\lastsection}%
7955 \immediate \writexrdef{title}{\the\toks0 }%
7956 \immediate \writexrdef{snt}{\csname #2\endcsname}% \Ynumbered etc.
7957 \safewhatsit{\writexrdef{pg}{\folio}}% will be written later, at \shipout
7962 % @xrefautosectiontitle on|off says whether @section(ing) names are used
7963 % automatically in xrefs, if the third arg is not explicitly specified.
7964 % This was provided as a "secret" @set xref-automatic-section-title
7965 % variable, now it's official.
7967 \parseargdef\xrefautomaticsectiontitle{%
7968 \def\temp{#1}%
7969 \ifx\temp\onword
7970 \expandafter\let\csname SETxref-automatic-section-title\endcsname
7971 = \empty
7972 \else\ifx\temp\offword
7973 \expandafter\let\csname SETxref-automatic-section-title\endcsname
7974 = \relax
7975 \else
7976 \errhelp = \EMsimple
7977 \errmessage{Unknown @xrefautomaticsectiontitle value `\temp',
7978 must be on|off}%
7979 \fi\fi
7982 % \f
7983 % @xref, @pxref, and @ref generate cross-references. For \xrefX, #1 is
7984 % the node name, #2 the name of the Info cross-reference, #3 the printed
7985 % node name, #4 the name of the Info file, #5 the name of the printed
7986 % manual. All but the node name can be omitted.
7988 \def\pxref#1{\putwordsee{} \xrefX[#1,,,,,,,]}
7989 \def\xref#1{\putwordSee{} \xrefX[#1,,,,,,,]}
7990 \def\ref#1{\xrefX[#1,,,,,,,]}
7992 \newbox\toprefbox
7993 \newbox\printedrefnamebox
7994 \newbox\infofilenamebox
7995 \newbox\printedmanualbox
7997 \def\xrefX[#1,#2,#3,#4,#5,#6]{\begingroup
7998 \unsepspaces
8000 % Get args without leading/trailing spaces.
8001 \def\printedrefname{\ignorespaces #3}%
8002 \setbox\printedrefnamebox = \hbox{\printedrefname\unskip}%
8004 \def\infofilename{\ignorespaces #4}%
8005 \setbox\infofilenamebox = \hbox{\infofilename\unskip}%
8007 \def\printedmanual{\ignorespaces #5}%
8008 \setbox\printedmanualbox = \hbox{\printedmanual\unskip}%
8010 % If the printed reference name (arg #3) was not explicitly given in
8011 % the @xref, figure out what we want to use.
8012 \ifdim \wd\printedrefnamebox = 0pt
8013 % No printed node name was explicitly given.
8014 \expandafter\ifx\csname SETxref-automatic-section-title\endcsname \relax
8015 % Not auto section-title: use node name inside the square brackets.
8016 \def\printedrefname{\ignorespaces #1}%
8017 \else
8018 % Auto section-title: use chapter/section title inside
8019 % the square brackets if we have it.
8020 \ifdim \wd\printedmanualbox > 0pt
8021 % It is in another manual, so we don't have it; use node name.
8022 \def\printedrefname{\ignorespaces #1}%
8023 \else
8024 \ifhavexrefs
8025 % We (should) know the real title if we have the xref values.
8026 \def\printedrefname{\refx{#1-title}{}}%
8027 \else
8028 % Otherwise just copy the Info node name.
8029 \def\printedrefname{\ignorespaces #1}%
8030 \fi%
8035 % Make link in pdf output.
8036 \ifpdf
8037 {\indexnofonts
8038 \turnoffactive
8039 \makevalueexpandable
8040 % This expands tokens, so do it after making catcode changes, so _
8041 % etc. don't get their TeX definitions. This ignores all spaces in
8042 % #4, including (wrongly) those in the middle of the filename.
8043 \getfilename{#4}%
8045 % This (wrongly) does not take account of leading or trailing
8046 % spaces in #1, which should be ignored.
8047 \edef\pdfxrefdest{#1}%
8048 \ifx\pdfxrefdest\empty
8049 \def\pdfxrefdest{Top}% no empty targets
8050 \else
8051 \txiescapepdf\pdfxrefdest % escape PDF special chars
8054 \leavevmode
8055 \startlink attr{/Border [0 0 0]}%
8056 \ifnum\filenamelength>0
8057 goto file{\the\filename.pdf} name{\pdfxrefdest}%
8058 \else
8059 goto name{\pdfmkpgn{\pdfxrefdest}}%
8062 \setcolor{\linkcolor}%
8065 % Float references are printed completely differently: "Figure 1.2"
8066 % instead of "[somenode], p.3". We distinguish them by the
8067 % LABEL-title being set to a magic string.
8069 % Have to otherify everything special to allow the \csname to
8070 % include an _ in the xref name, etc.
8071 \indexnofonts
8072 \turnoffactive
8073 \expandafter\global\expandafter\let\expandafter\Xthisreftitle
8074 \csname XR#1-title\endcsname
8076 \iffloat\Xthisreftitle
8077 % If the user specified the print name (third arg) to the ref,
8078 % print it instead of our usual "Figure 1.2".
8079 \ifdim\wd\printedrefnamebox = 0pt
8080 \refx{#1-snt}{}%
8081 \else
8082 \printedrefname
8085 % If the user also gave the printed manual name (fifth arg), append
8086 % "in MANUALNAME".
8087 \ifdim \wd\printedmanualbox > 0pt
8088 \space \putwordin{} \cite{\printedmanual}%
8090 \else
8091 % node/anchor (non-float) references.
8093 % If we use \unhbox to print the node names, TeX does not insert
8094 % empty discretionaries after hyphens, which means that it will not
8095 % find a line break at a hyphen in a node names. Since some manuals
8096 % are best written with fairly long node names, containing hyphens,
8097 % this is a loss. Therefore, we give the text of the node name
8098 % again, so it is as if TeX is seeing it for the first time.
8100 \ifdim \wd\printedmanualbox > 0pt
8101 % Cross-manual reference with a printed manual name.
8103 \crossmanualxref{\cite{\printedmanual\unskip}}%
8105 \else\ifdim \wd\infofilenamebox > 0pt
8106 % Cross-manual reference with only an info filename (arg 4), no
8107 % printed manual name (arg 5). This is essentially the same as
8108 % the case above; we output the filename, since we have nothing else.
8110 \crossmanualxref{\code{\infofilename\unskip}}%
8112 \else
8113 % Reference within this manual.
8115 % _ (for example) has to be the character _ for the purposes of the
8116 % control sequence corresponding to the node, but it has to expand
8117 % into the usual \leavevmode...\vrule stuff for purposes of
8118 % printing. So we \turnoffactive for the \refx-snt, back on for the
8119 % printing, back off for the \refx-pg.
8120 {\turnoffactive
8121 % Only output a following space if the -snt ref is nonempty; for
8122 % @unnumbered and @anchor, it won't be.
8123 \setbox2 = \hbox{\ignorespaces \refx{#1-snt}{}}%
8124 \ifdim \wd2 > 0pt \refx{#1-snt}\space\fi
8126 % output the `[mynode]' via the macro below so it can be overridden.
8127 \xrefprintnodename\printedrefname
8129 % But we always want a comma and a space:
8130 ,\space
8132 % output the `page 3'.
8133 \turnoffactive \putwordpage\tie\refx{#1-pg}{}%
8134 \fi\fi
8136 \endlink
8137 \endgroup}
8139 % Output a cross-manual xref to #1. Used just above (twice).
8141 % Only include the text "Section ``foo'' in" if the foo is neither
8142 % missing or Top. Thus, @xref{,,,foo,The Foo Manual} outputs simply
8143 % "see The Foo Manual", the idea being to refer to the whole manual.
8145 % But, this being TeX, we can't easily compare our node name against the
8146 % string "Top" while ignoring the possible spaces before and after in
8147 % the input. By adding the arbitrary 7sp below, we make it much less
8148 % likely that a real node name would have the same width as "Top" (e.g.,
8149 % in a monospaced font). Hopefully it will never happen in practice.
8151 % For the same basic reason, we retypeset the "Top" at every
8152 % reference, since the current font is indeterminate.
8154 \def\crossmanualxref#1{%
8155 \setbox\toprefbox = \hbox{Top\kern7sp}%
8156 \setbox2 = \hbox{\ignorespaces \printedrefname \unskip \kern7sp}%
8157 \ifdim \wd2 > 7sp % nonempty?
8158 \ifdim \wd2 = \wd\toprefbox \else % same as Top?
8159 \putwordSection{} ``\printedrefname'' \putwordin{}\space
8165 % This macro is called from \xrefX for the `[nodename]' part of xref
8166 % output. It's a separate macro only so it can be changed more easily,
8167 % since square brackets don't work well in some documents. Particularly
8168 % one that Bob is working on :).
8170 \def\xrefprintnodename#1{[#1]}
8172 % Things referred to by \setref.
8174 \def\Ynothing{}
8175 \def\Yomitfromtoc{}
8176 \def\Ynumbered{%
8177 \ifnum\secno=0
8178 \putwordChapter@tie \the\chapno
8179 \else \ifnum\subsecno=0
8180 \putwordSection@tie \the\chapno.\the\secno
8181 \else \ifnum\subsubsecno=0
8182 \putwordSection@tie \the\chapno.\the\secno.\the\subsecno
8183 \else
8184 \putwordSection@tie \the\chapno.\the\secno.\the\subsecno.\the\subsubsecno
8185 \fi\fi\fi
8187 \def\Yappendix{%
8188 \ifnum\secno=0
8189 \putwordAppendix@tie @char\the\appendixno{}%
8190 \else \ifnum\subsecno=0
8191 \putwordSection@tie @char\the\appendixno.\the\secno
8192 \else \ifnum\subsubsecno=0
8193 \putwordSection@tie @char\the\appendixno.\the\secno.\the\subsecno
8194 \else
8195 \putwordSection@tie
8196 @char\the\appendixno.\the\secno.\the\subsecno.\the\subsubsecno
8197 \fi\fi\fi
8200 % Define \refx{NAME}{SUFFIX} to reference a cross-reference string named NAME.
8201 % If its value is nonempty, SUFFIX is output afterward.
8203 \def\refx#1#2{%
8205 \indexnofonts
8206 \otherbackslash
8207 \expandafter\global\expandafter\let\expandafter\thisrefX
8208 \csname XR#1\endcsname
8210 \ifx\thisrefX\relax
8211 % If not defined, say something at least.
8212 \angleleft un\-de\-fined\angleright
8213 \iflinks
8214 \ifhavexrefs
8215 {\toks0 = {#1}% avoid expansion of possibly-complex value
8216 \message{\linenumber Undefined cross reference `\the\toks0'.}}%
8217 \else
8218 \ifwarnedxrefs\else
8219 \global\warnedxrefstrue
8220 \message{Cross reference values unknown; you must run TeX again.}%
8224 \else
8225 % It's defined, so just use it.
8226 \thisrefX
8228 #2% Output the suffix in any case.
8231 % This is the macro invoked by entries in the aux file. Usually it's
8232 % just a \def (we prepend XR to the control sequence name to avoid
8233 % collisions). But if this is a float type, we have more work to do.
8235 \def\xrdef#1#2{%
8236 {% The node name might contain 8-bit characters, which in our current
8237 % implementation are changed to commands like @'e. Don't let these
8238 % mess up the control sequence name.
8239 \indexnofonts
8240 \turnoffactive
8241 \xdef\safexrefname{#1}%
8244 \expandafter\gdef\csname XR\safexrefname\endcsname{#2}% remember this xref
8246 % Was that xref control sequence that we just defined for a float?
8247 \expandafter\iffloat\csname XR\safexrefname\endcsname
8248 % it was a float, and we have the (safe) float type in \iffloattype.
8249 \expandafter\let\expandafter\floatlist
8250 \csname floatlist\iffloattype\endcsname
8252 % Is this the first time we've seen this float type?
8253 \expandafter\ifx\floatlist\relax
8254 \toks0 = {\do}% yes, so just \do
8255 \else
8256 % had it before, so preserve previous elements in list.
8257 \toks0 = \expandafter{\floatlist\do}%
8260 % Remember this xref in the control sequence \floatlistFLOATTYPE,
8261 % for later use in \listoffloats.
8262 \expandafter\xdef\csname floatlist\iffloattype\endcsname{\the\toks0
8263 {\safexrefname}}%
8267 % Read the last existing aux file, if any. No error if none exists.
8269 \def\tryauxfile{%
8270 \openin 1 \jobname.aux
8271 \ifeof 1 \else
8272 \readdatafile{aux}%
8273 \global\havexrefstrue
8275 \closein 1
8278 \def\setupdatafile{%
8279 \catcode`\^^@=\other
8280 \catcode`\^^A=\other
8281 \catcode`\^^B=\other
8282 \catcode`\^^C=\other
8283 \catcode`\^^D=\other
8284 \catcode`\^^E=\other
8285 \catcode`\^^F=\other
8286 \catcode`\^^G=\other
8287 \catcode`\^^H=\other
8288 \catcode`\^^K=\other
8289 \catcode`\^^L=\other
8290 \catcode`\^^N=\other
8291 \catcode`\^^P=\other
8292 \catcode`\^^Q=\other
8293 \catcode`\^^R=\other
8294 \catcode`\^^S=\other
8295 \catcode`\^^T=\other
8296 \catcode`\^^U=\other
8297 \catcode`\^^V=\other
8298 \catcode`\^^W=\other
8299 \catcode`\^^X=\other
8300 \catcode`\^^Z=\other
8301 \catcode`\^^[=\other
8302 \catcode`\^^\=\other
8303 \catcode`\^^]=\other
8304 \catcode`\^^^=\other
8305 \catcode`\^^_=\other
8306 % It was suggested to set the catcode of ^ to 7, which would allow ^^e4 etc.
8307 % in xref tags, i.e., node names. But since ^^e4 notation isn't
8308 % supported in the main text, it doesn't seem desirable. Furthermore,
8309 % that is not enough: for node names that actually contain a ^
8310 % character, we would end up writing a line like this: 'xrdef {'hat
8311 % b-title}{'hat b} and \xrdef does a \csname...\endcsname on the first
8312 % argument, and \hat is not an expandable control sequence. It could
8313 % all be worked out, but why? Either we support ^^ or we don't.
8315 % The other change necessary for this was to define \auxhat:
8316 % \def\auxhat{\def^{'hat }}% extra space so ok if followed by letter
8317 % and then to call \auxhat in \setq.
8319 \catcode`\^=\other
8321 % Special characters. Should be turned off anyway, but...
8322 \catcode`\~=\other
8323 \catcode`\[=\other
8324 \catcode`\]=\other
8325 \catcode`\"=\other
8326 \catcode`\_=\other
8327 \catcode`\|=\other
8328 \catcode`\<=\other
8329 \catcode`\>=\other
8330 \catcode`\$=\other
8331 \catcode`\#=\other
8332 \catcode`\&=\other
8333 \catcode`\%=\other
8334 \catcode`+=\other % avoid \+ for paranoia even though we've turned it off
8336 % This is to support \ in node names and titles, since the \
8337 % characters end up in a \csname. It's easier than
8338 % leaving it active and making its active definition an actual \
8339 % character. What I don't understand is why it works in the *value*
8340 % of the xrdef. Seems like it should be a catcode12 \, and that
8341 % should not typeset properly. But it works, so I'm moving on for
8342 % now. --karl, 15jan04.
8343 \catcode`\\=\other
8345 % Make the characters 128-255 be printing characters.
8346 {\setnonasciicharscatcodenonglobal\other}%
8348 % @ is our escape character in .aux files, and we need braces.
8349 \catcode`\{=1
8350 \catcode`\}=2
8351 \catcode`\@=0
8354 \def\readdatafile#1{%
8355 \begingroup
8356 \setupdatafile
8357 \input\jobname.#1
8358 \endgroup}
8361 \message{insertions,}
8362 % including footnotes.
8364 \newcount \footnoteno
8366 % The trailing space in the following definition for supereject is
8367 % vital for proper filling; pages come out unaligned when you do a
8368 % pagealignmacro call if that space before the closing brace is
8369 % removed. (Generally, numeric constants should always be followed by a
8370 % space to prevent strange expansion errors.)
8371 \def\supereject{\par\penalty -20000\footnoteno =0 }
8373 % @footnotestyle is meaningful for Info output only.
8374 \let\footnotestyle=\comment
8376 {\catcode `\@=11
8378 % Auto-number footnotes. Otherwise like plain.
8379 \gdef\footnote{%
8380 \global\advance\footnoteno by \@ne
8381 \edef\thisfootno{$^{\the\footnoteno}$}%
8383 % In case the footnote comes at the end of a sentence, preserve the
8384 % extra spacing after we do the footnote number.
8385 \let\@sf\empty
8386 \ifhmode\edef\@sf{\spacefactor\the\spacefactor}\ptexslash\fi
8388 % Remove inadvertent blank space before typesetting the footnote number.
8389 \unskip
8390 \thisfootno\@sf
8391 \dofootnote
8394 % Don't bother with the trickery in plain.tex to not require the
8395 % footnote text as a parameter. Our footnotes don't need to be so general.
8397 % Oh yes, they do; otherwise, @ifset (and anything else that uses
8398 % \parseargline) fails inside footnotes because the tokens are fixed when
8399 % the footnote is read. --karl, 16nov96.
8401 \gdef\dofootnote{%
8402 \insert\footins\bgroup
8404 % Nested footnotes are not supported in TeX, that would take a lot
8405 % more work. (\startsavinginserts does not suffice.)
8406 \let\footnote=\errfootnotenest
8408 % We want to typeset this text as a normal paragraph, even if the
8409 % footnote reference occurs in (for example) a display environment.
8410 % So reset some parameters.
8411 \hsize=\pagewidth
8412 \interlinepenalty\interfootnotelinepenalty
8413 \splittopskip\ht\strutbox % top baseline for broken footnotes
8414 \splitmaxdepth\dp\strutbox
8415 \floatingpenalty\@MM
8416 \leftskip\z@skip
8417 \rightskip\z@skip
8418 \spaceskip\z@skip
8419 \xspaceskip\z@skip
8420 \parindent\defaultparindent
8422 \smallfonts \rm
8424 % Because we use hanging indentation in footnotes, a @noindent appears
8425 % to exdent this text, so make it be a no-op. makeinfo does not use
8426 % hanging indentation so @noindent can still be needed within footnote
8427 % text after an @example or the like (not that this is good style).
8428 \let\noindent = \relax
8430 % Hang the footnote text off the number. Use \everypar in case the
8431 % footnote extends for more than one paragraph.
8432 \everypar = {\hang}%
8433 \textindent{\thisfootno}%
8435 % Don't crash into the line above the footnote text. Since this
8436 % expands into a box, it must come within the paragraph, lest it
8437 % provide a place where TeX can split the footnote.
8438 \footstrut
8440 % Invoke rest of plain TeX footnote routine.
8441 \futurelet\next\fo@t
8443 }%end \catcode `\@=11
8445 \def\errfootnotenest{%
8446 \errhelp=\EMsimple
8447 \errmessage{Nested footnotes not supported in texinfo.tex,
8448 even though they work in makeinfo; sorry}
8451 \def\errfootnoteheading{%
8452 \errhelp=\EMsimple
8453 \errmessage{Footnotes in chapters, sections, etc., are not supported}
8456 % In case a @footnote appears in a vbox, save the footnote text and create
8457 % the real \insert just after the vbox finished. Otherwise, the insertion
8458 % would be lost.
8459 % Similarly, if a @footnote appears inside an alignment, save the footnote
8460 % text to a box and make the \insert when a row of the table is finished.
8461 % And the same can be done for other insert classes. --kasal, 16nov03.
8463 % Replace the \insert primitive by a cheating macro.
8464 % Deeper inside, just make sure that the saved insertions are not spilled
8465 % out prematurely.
8467 \def\startsavinginserts{%
8468 \ifx \insert\ptexinsert
8469 \let\insert\saveinsert
8470 \else
8471 \let\checkinserts\relax
8475 % This \insert replacement works for both \insert\footins{foo} and
8476 % \insert\footins\bgroup foo\egroup, but it doesn't work for \insert27{foo}.
8478 \def\saveinsert#1{%
8479 \edef\next{\noexpand\savetobox \makeSAVEname#1}%
8480 \afterassignment\next
8481 % swallow the left brace
8482 \let\temp =
8484 \def\makeSAVEname#1{\makecsname{SAVE\expandafter\gobble\string#1}}
8485 \def\savetobox#1{\global\setbox#1 = \vbox\bgroup \unvbox#1}
8487 \def\checksaveins#1{\ifvoid#1\else \placesaveins#1\fi}
8489 \def\placesaveins#1{%
8490 \ptexinsert \csname\expandafter\gobblesave\string#1\endcsname
8491 {\box#1}%
8494 % eat @SAVE -- beware, all of them have catcode \other:
8496 \def\dospecials{\do S\do A\do V\do E} \uncatcodespecials % ;-)
8497 \gdef\gobblesave @SAVE{}
8500 % initialization:
8501 \def\newsaveins #1{%
8502 \edef\next{\noexpand\newsaveinsX \makeSAVEname#1}%
8503 \next
8505 \def\newsaveinsX #1{%
8506 \csname newbox\endcsname #1%
8507 \expandafter\def\expandafter\checkinserts\expandafter{\checkinserts
8508 \checksaveins #1}%
8511 % initialize:
8512 \let\checkinserts\empty
8513 \newsaveins\footins
8514 \newsaveins\margin
8517 % @image. We use the macros from epsf.tex to support this.
8518 % If epsf.tex is not installed and @image is used, we complain.
8520 % Check for and read epsf.tex up front. If we read it only at @image
8521 % time, we might be inside a group, and then its definitions would get
8522 % undone and the next image would fail.
8523 \openin 1 = epsf.tex
8524 \ifeof 1 \else
8525 % Do not bother showing banner with epsf.tex v2.7k (available in
8526 % doc/epsf.tex and on ctan).
8527 \def\epsfannounce{\toks0 = }%
8528 \input epsf.tex
8530 \closein 1
8532 % We will only complain once about lack of epsf.tex.
8533 \newif\ifwarnednoepsf
8534 \newhelp\noepsfhelp{epsf.tex must be installed for images to
8535 work. It is also included in the Texinfo distribution, or you can get
8536 it from ftp://tug.org/tex/epsf.tex.}
8538 \def\image#1{%
8539 \ifx\epsfbox\thisisundefined
8540 \ifwarnednoepsf \else
8541 \errhelp = \noepsfhelp
8542 \errmessage{epsf.tex not found, images will be ignored}%
8543 \global\warnednoepsftrue
8545 \else
8546 \imagexxx #1,,,,,\finish
8550 % Arguments to @image:
8551 % #1 is (mandatory) image filename; we tack on .eps extension.
8552 % #2 is (optional) width, #3 is (optional) height.
8553 % #4 is (ignored optional) html alt text.
8554 % #5 is (ignored optional) extension.
8555 % #6 is just the usual extra ignored arg for parsing stuff.
8556 \newif\ifimagevmode
8557 \def\imagexxx#1,#2,#3,#4,#5,#6\finish{\begingroup
8558 \catcode`\^^M = 5 % in case we're inside an example
8559 \normalturnoffactive % allow _ et al. in names
8560 % If the image is by itself, center it.
8561 \ifvmode
8562 \imagevmodetrue
8563 \else \ifx\centersub\centerV
8564 % for @center @image, we need a vbox so we can have our vertical space
8565 \imagevmodetrue
8566 \vbox\bgroup % vbox has better behavior than vtop herev
8567 \fi\fi
8569 \ifimagevmode
8570 \nobreak\medskip
8571 % Usually we'll have text after the image which will insert
8572 % \parskip glue, so insert it here too to equalize the space
8573 % above and below.
8574 \nobreak\vskip\parskip
8575 \nobreak
8578 % Leave vertical mode so that indentation from an enclosing
8579 % environment such as @quotation is respected.
8580 % However, if we're at the top level, we don't want the
8581 % normal paragraph indentation.
8582 % On the other hand, if we are in the case of @center @image, we don't
8583 % want to start a paragraph, which will create a hsize-width box and
8584 % eradicate the centering.
8585 \ifx\centersub\centerV\else \noindent \fi
8587 % Output the image.
8588 \ifpdf
8589 \dopdfimage{#1}{#2}{#3}%
8590 \else
8591 % \epsfbox itself resets \epsf?size at each figure.
8592 \setbox0 = \hbox{\ignorespaces #2}\ifdim\wd0 > 0pt \epsfxsize=#2\relax \fi
8593 \setbox0 = \hbox{\ignorespaces #3}\ifdim\wd0 > 0pt \epsfysize=#3\relax \fi
8594 \epsfbox{#1.eps}%
8597 \ifimagevmode
8598 \medskip % space after a standalone image
8599 \fi
8600 \ifx\centersub\centerV \egroup \fi
8601 \endgroup}
8604 % @float FLOATTYPE,LABEL,LOC ... @end float for displayed figures, tables,
8605 % etc. We don't actually implement floating yet, we always include the
8606 % float "here". But it seemed the best name for the future.
8608 \envparseargdef\float{\eatcommaspace\eatcommaspace\dofloat#1, , ,\finish}
8610 % There may be a space before second and/or third parameter; delete it.
8611 \def\eatcommaspace#1, {#1,}
8613 % #1 is the optional FLOATTYPE, the text label for this float, typically
8614 % "Figure", "Table", "Example", etc. Can't contain commas. If omitted,
8615 % this float will not be numbered and cannot be referred to.
8617 % #2 is the optional xref label. Also must be present for the float to
8618 % be referable.
8620 % #3 is the optional positioning argument; for now, it is ignored. It
8621 % will somehow specify the positions allowed to float to (here, top, bottom).
8623 % We keep a separate counter for each FLOATTYPE, which we reset at each
8624 % chapter-level command.
8625 \let\resetallfloatnos=\empty
8627 \def\dofloat#1,#2,#3,#4\finish{%
8628 \let\thiscaption=\empty
8629 \let\thisshortcaption=\empty
8631 % don't lose footnotes inside @float.
8633 % BEWARE: when the floats start float, we have to issue warning whenever an
8634 % insert appears inside a float which could possibly float. --kasal, 26may04
8636 \startsavinginserts
8638 % We can't be used inside a paragraph.
8639 \par
8641 \vtop\bgroup
8642 \def\floattype{#1}%
8643 \def\floatlabel{#2}%
8644 \def\floatloc{#3}% we do nothing with this yet.
8646 \ifx\floattype\empty
8647 \let\safefloattype=\empty
8648 \else
8650 % the floattype might have accents or other special characters,
8651 % but we need to use it in a control sequence name.
8652 \indexnofonts
8653 \turnoffactive
8654 \xdef\safefloattype{\floattype}%
8658 % If label is given but no type, we handle that as the empty type.
8659 \ifx\floatlabel\empty \else
8660 % We want each FLOATTYPE to be numbered separately (Figure 1,
8661 % Table 1, Figure 2, ...). (And if no label, no number.)
8663 \expandafter\getfloatno\csname\safefloattype floatno\endcsname
8664 \global\advance\floatno by 1
8667 % This magic value for \lastsection is output by \setref as the
8668 % XREFLABEL-title value. \xrefX uses it to distinguish float
8669 % labels (which have a completely different output format) from
8670 % node and anchor labels. And \xrdef uses it to construct the
8671 % lists of floats.
8673 \edef\lastsection{\floatmagic=\safefloattype}%
8674 \setref{\floatlabel}{Yfloat}%
8678 % start with \parskip glue, I guess.
8679 \vskip\parskip
8681 % Don't suppress indentation if a float happens to start a section.
8682 \restorefirstparagraphindent
8685 % we have these possibilities:
8686 % @float Foo,lbl & @caption{Cap}: Foo 1.1: Cap
8687 % @float Foo,lbl & no caption: Foo 1.1
8688 % @float Foo & @caption{Cap}: Foo: Cap
8689 % @float Foo & no caption: Foo
8690 % @float ,lbl & Caption{Cap}: 1.1: Cap
8691 % @float ,lbl & no caption: 1.1
8692 % @float & @caption{Cap}: Cap
8693 % @float & no caption:
8695 \def\Efloat{%
8696 \let\floatident = \empty
8698 % In all cases, if we have a float type, it comes first.
8699 \ifx\floattype\empty \else \def\floatident{\floattype}\fi
8701 % If we have an xref label, the number comes next.
8702 \ifx\floatlabel\empty \else
8703 \ifx\floattype\empty \else % if also had float type, need tie first.
8704 \appendtomacro\floatident{\tie}%
8706 % the number.
8707 \appendtomacro\floatident{\chaplevelprefix\the\floatno}%
8710 % Start the printed caption with what we've constructed in
8711 % \floatident, but keep it separate; we need \floatident again.
8712 \let\captionline = \floatident
8714 \ifx\thiscaption\empty \else
8715 \ifx\floatident\empty \else
8716 \appendtomacro\captionline{: }% had ident, so need a colon between
8719 % caption text.
8720 \appendtomacro\captionline{\scanexp\thiscaption}%
8723 % If we have anything to print, print it, with space before.
8724 % Eventually this needs to become an \insert.
8725 \ifx\captionline\empty \else
8726 \vskip.5\parskip
8727 \captionline
8729 % Space below caption.
8730 \vskip\parskip
8733 % If have an xref label, write the list of floats info. Do this
8734 % after the caption, to avoid chance of it being a breakpoint.
8735 \ifx\floatlabel\empty \else
8736 % Write the text that goes in the lof to the aux file as
8737 % \floatlabel-lof. Besides \floatident, we include the short
8738 % caption if specified, else the full caption if specified, else nothing.
8740 \atdummies
8742 % since we read the caption text in the macro world, where ^^M
8743 % is turned into a normal character, we have to scan it back, so
8744 % we don't write the literal three characters "^^M" into the aux file.
8745 \scanexp{%
8746 \xdef\noexpand\gtemp{%
8747 \ifx\thisshortcaption\empty
8748 \thiscaption
8749 \else
8750 \thisshortcaption
8754 \immediate\write\auxfile{@xrdef{\floatlabel-lof}{\floatident
8755 \ifx\gtemp\empty \else : \gtemp \fi}}%
8758 \egroup % end of \vtop
8760 % place the captured inserts
8762 % BEWARE: when the floats start floating, we have to issue warning
8763 % whenever an insert appears inside a float which could possibly
8764 % float. --kasal, 26may04
8766 \checkinserts
8769 % Append the tokens #2 to the definition of macro #1, not expanding either.
8771 \def\appendtomacro#1#2{%
8772 \expandafter\def\expandafter#1\expandafter{#1#2}%
8775 % @caption, @shortcaption
8777 \def\caption{\docaption\thiscaption}
8778 \def\shortcaption{\docaption\thisshortcaption}
8779 \def\docaption{\checkenv\float \bgroup\scanargctxt\defcaption}
8780 \def\defcaption#1#2{\egroup \def#1{#2}}
8782 % The parameter is the control sequence identifying the counter we are
8783 % going to use. Create it if it doesn't exist and assign it to \floatno.
8784 \def\getfloatno#1{%
8785 \ifx#1\relax
8786 % Haven't seen this figure type before.
8787 \csname newcount\endcsname #1%
8789 % Remember to reset this floatno at the next chap.
8790 \expandafter\gdef\expandafter\resetallfloatnos
8791 \expandafter{\resetallfloatnos #1=0 }%
8793 \let\floatno#1%
8796 % \setref calls this to get the XREFLABEL-snt value. We want an @xref
8797 % to the FLOATLABEL to expand to "Figure 3.1". We call \setref when we
8798 % first read the @float command.
8800 \def\Yfloat{\floattype@tie \chaplevelprefix\the\floatno}%
8802 % Magic string used for the XREFLABEL-title value, so \xrefX can
8803 % distinguish floats from other xref types.
8804 \def\floatmagic{!!float!!}
8806 % #1 is the control sequence we are passed; we expand into a conditional
8807 % which is true if #1 represents a float ref. That is, the magic
8808 % \lastsection value which we \setref above.
8810 \def\iffloat#1{\expandafter\doiffloat#1==\finish}
8812 % #1 is (maybe) the \floatmagic string. If so, #2 will be the
8813 % (safe) float type for this float. We set \iffloattype to #2.
8815 \def\doiffloat#1=#2=#3\finish{%
8816 \def\temp{#1}%
8817 \def\iffloattype{#2}%
8818 \ifx\temp\floatmagic
8821 % @listoffloats FLOATTYPE - print a list of floats like a table of contents.
8823 \parseargdef\listoffloats{%
8824 \def\floattype{#1}% floattype
8826 % the floattype might have accents or other special characters,
8827 % but we need to use it in a control sequence name.
8828 \indexnofonts
8829 \turnoffactive
8830 \xdef\safefloattype{\floattype}%
8833 % \xrdef saves the floats as a \do-list in \floatlistSAFEFLOATTYPE.
8834 \expandafter\ifx\csname floatlist\safefloattype\endcsname \relax
8835 \ifhavexrefs
8836 % if the user said @listoffloats foo but never @float foo.
8837 \message{\linenumber No `\safefloattype' floats to list.}%
8839 \else
8840 \begingroup
8841 \leftskip=\tocindent % indent these entries like a toc
8842 \let\do=\listoffloatsdo
8843 \csname floatlist\safefloattype\endcsname
8844 \endgroup
8848 % This is called on each entry in a list of floats. We're passed the
8849 % xref label, in the form LABEL-title, which is how we save it in the
8850 % aux file. We strip off the -title and look up \XRLABEL-lof, which
8851 % has the text we're supposed to typeset here.
8853 % Figures without xref labels will not be included in the list (since
8854 % they won't appear in the aux file).
8856 \def\listoffloatsdo#1{\listoffloatsdoentry#1\finish}
8857 \def\listoffloatsdoentry#1-title\finish{{%
8858 % Can't fully expand XR#1-lof because it can contain anything. Just
8859 % pass the control sequence. On the other hand, XR#1-pg is just the
8860 % page number, and we want to fully expand that so we can get a link
8861 % in pdf output.
8862 \toksA = \expandafter{\csname XR#1-lof\endcsname}%
8864 % use the same \entry macro we use to generate the TOC and index.
8865 \edef\writeentry{\noexpand\entry{\the\toksA}{\csname XR#1-pg\endcsname}}%
8866 \writeentry
8870 \message{localization,}
8872 % For single-language documents, @documentlanguage is usually given very
8873 % early, just after @documentencoding. Single argument is the language
8874 % (de) or locale (de_DE) abbreviation.
8877 \catcode`\_ = \active
8878 \globaldefs=1
8879 \parseargdef\documentlanguage{%
8880 \tex % read txi-??.tex file in plain TeX.
8881 % Read the file by the name they passed if it exists.
8882 \let_ = \normalunderscore % normal _ character for filename test
8883 \openin 1 txi-#1.tex
8884 \ifeof 1
8885 \documentlanguagetrywithoutunderscore #1_\finish
8886 \else
8887 \globaldefs = 1 % everything in the txi-LL files needs to persist
8888 \input txi-#1.tex
8890 \closein 1
8891 \endgroup % end raw TeX
8894 % If they passed de_DE, and txi-de_DE.tex doesn't exist,
8895 % try txi-de.tex.
8897 \gdef\documentlanguagetrywithoutunderscore#1_#2\finish{%
8898 \openin 1 txi-#1.tex
8899 \ifeof 1
8900 \errhelp = \nolanghelp
8901 \errmessage{Cannot read language file txi-#1.tex}%
8902 \else
8903 \globaldefs = 1 % everything in the txi-LL files needs to persist
8904 \input txi-#1.tex
8906 \closein 1
8908 }% end of special _ catcode
8910 \newhelp\nolanghelp{The given language definition file cannot be found or
8911 is empty. Maybe you need to install it? Putting it in the current
8912 directory should work if nowhere else does.}
8914 % This macro is called from txi-??.tex files; the first argument is the
8915 % \language name to set (without the "\lang@" prefix), the second and
8916 % third args are \{left,right}hyphenmin.
8918 % The language names to pass are determined when the format is built.
8919 % See the etex.log file created at that time, e.g.,
8920 % /usr/local/texlive/2008/texmf-var/web2c/pdftex/etex.log.
8922 % With TeX Live 2008, etex now includes hyphenation patterns for all
8923 % available languages. This means we can support hyphenation in
8924 % Texinfo, at least to some extent. (This still doesn't solve the
8925 % accented characters problem.)
8927 \catcode`@=11
8928 \def\txisetlanguage#1#2#3{%
8929 % do not set the language if the name is undefined in the current TeX.
8930 \expandafter\ifx\csname lang@#1\endcsname \relax
8931 \message{no patterns for #1}%
8932 \else
8933 \global\language = \csname lang@#1\endcsname
8935 % but there is no harm in adjusting the hyphenmin values regardless.
8936 \global\lefthyphenmin = #2\relax
8937 \global\righthyphenmin = #3\relax
8940 % Helpers for encodings.
8941 % Set the catcode of characters 128 through 255 to the specified number.
8943 \def\setnonasciicharscatcode#1{%
8944 \count255=128
8945 \loop\ifnum\count255<256
8946 \global\catcode\count255=#1\relax
8947 \advance\count255 by 1
8948 \repeat
8951 \def\setnonasciicharscatcodenonglobal#1{%
8952 \count255=128
8953 \loop\ifnum\count255<256
8954 \catcode\count255=#1\relax
8955 \advance\count255 by 1
8956 \repeat
8959 % @documentencoding sets the definition of non-ASCII characters
8960 % according to the specified encoding.
8962 \parseargdef\documentencoding{%
8963 % Encoding being declared for the document.
8964 \def\declaredencoding{\csname #1.enc\endcsname}%
8966 % Supported encodings: names converted to tokens in order to be able
8967 % to compare them with \ifx.
8968 \def\ascii{\csname US-ASCII.enc\endcsname}%
8969 \def\latnine{\csname ISO-8859-15.enc\endcsname}%
8970 \def\latone{\csname ISO-8859-1.enc\endcsname}%
8971 \def\lattwo{\csname ISO-8859-2.enc\endcsname}%
8972 \def\utfeight{\csname UTF-8.enc\endcsname}%
8974 \ifx \declaredencoding \ascii
8975 \asciichardefs
8977 \else \ifx \declaredencoding \lattwo
8978 \setnonasciicharscatcode\active
8979 \lattwochardefs
8981 \else \ifx \declaredencoding \latone
8982 \setnonasciicharscatcode\active
8983 \latonechardefs
8985 \else \ifx \declaredencoding \latnine
8986 \setnonasciicharscatcode\active
8987 \latninechardefs
8989 \else \ifx \declaredencoding \utfeight
8990 \setnonasciicharscatcode\active
8991 % since we already invoked \utfeightchardefs at the top level
8992 % (below), do not re-invoke it, then our check for duplicated
8993 % definitions triggers. Making non-ascii chars active is enough.
8995 \else
8996 \message{Ignoring unknown document encoding: #1.}%
8998 \fi % utfeight
8999 \fi % latnine
9000 \fi % latone
9001 \fi % lattwo
9002 \fi % ascii
9005 % emacs-page
9006 % A message to be logged when using a character that isn't available
9007 % the default font encoding (OT1).
9009 \def\missingcharmsg#1{\message{Character missing, sorry: #1.}}
9011 % Take account of \c (plain) vs. \, (Texinfo) difference.
9012 \def\cedilla#1{\ifx\c\ptexc\c{#1}\else\,{#1}\fi}
9014 % First, make active non-ASCII characters in order for them to be
9015 % correctly categorized when TeX reads the replacement text of
9016 % macros containing the character definitions.
9017 \setnonasciicharscatcode\active
9019 % Latin1 (ISO-8859-1) character definitions.
9020 \def\latonechardefs{%
9021 \gdef^^a0{\tie}
9022 \gdef^^a1{\exclamdown}
9023 \gdef^^a2{\missingcharmsg{CENT SIGN}}
9024 \gdef^^a3{{\pounds}}
9025 \gdef^^a4{\missingcharmsg{CURRENCY SIGN}}
9026 \gdef^^a5{\missingcharmsg{YEN SIGN}}
9027 \gdef^^a6{\missingcharmsg{BROKEN BAR}}
9028 \gdef^^a7{\S}
9029 \gdef^^a8{\"{}}
9030 \gdef^^a9{\copyright}
9031 \gdef^^aa{\ordf}
9032 \gdef^^ab{\guillemetleft}
9033 \gdef^^ac{$\lnot$}
9034 \gdef^^ad{\-}
9035 \gdef^^ae{\registeredsymbol}
9036 \gdef^^af{\={}}
9038 \gdef^^b0{\textdegree}
9039 \gdef^^b1{$\pm$}
9040 \gdef^^b2{$^2$}
9041 \gdef^^b3{$^3$}
9042 \gdef^^b4{\'{}}
9043 \gdef^^b5{$\mu$}
9044 \gdef^^b6{\P}
9045 \gdef^^b7{\ensuremath\cdot}
9046 \gdef^^b8{\cedilla\ }
9047 \gdef^^b9{$^1$}
9048 \gdef^^ba{\ordm}
9049 \gdef^^bb{\guillemetright}
9050 \gdef^^bc{$1\over4$}
9051 \gdef^^bd{$1\over2$}
9052 \gdef^^be{$3\over4$}
9053 \gdef^^bf{\questiondown}
9055 \gdef^^c0{\`A}
9056 \gdef^^c1{\'A}
9057 \gdef^^c2{\^A}
9058 \gdef^^c3{\~A}
9059 \gdef^^c4{\"A}
9060 \gdef^^c5{\ringaccent A}
9061 \gdef^^c6{\AE}
9062 \gdef^^c7{\cedilla C}
9063 \gdef^^c8{\`E}
9064 \gdef^^c9{\'E}
9065 \gdef^^ca{\^E}
9066 \gdef^^cb{\"E}
9067 \gdef^^cc{\`I}
9068 \gdef^^cd{\'I}
9069 \gdef^^ce{\^I}
9070 \gdef^^cf{\"I}
9072 \gdef^^d0{\DH}
9073 \gdef^^d1{\~N}
9074 \gdef^^d2{\`O}
9075 \gdef^^d3{\'O}
9076 \gdef^^d4{\^O}
9077 \gdef^^d5{\~O}
9078 \gdef^^d6{\"O}
9079 \gdef^^d7{$\times$}
9080 \gdef^^d8{\O}
9081 \gdef^^d9{\`U}
9082 \gdef^^da{\'U}
9083 \gdef^^db{\^U}
9084 \gdef^^dc{\"U}
9085 \gdef^^dd{\'Y}
9086 \gdef^^de{\TH}
9087 \gdef^^df{\ss}
9089 \gdef^^e0{\`a}
9090 \gdef^^e1{\'a}
9091 \gdef^^e2{\^a}
9092 \gdef^^e3{\~a}
9093 \gdef^^e4{\"a}
9094 \gdef^^e5{\ringaccent a}
9095 \gdef^^e6{\ae}
9096 \gdef^^e7{\cedilla c}
9097 \gdef^^e8{\`e}
9098 \gdef^^e9{\'e}
9099 \gdef^^ea{\^e}
9100 \gdef^^eb{\"e}
9101 \gdef^^ec{\`{\dotless i}}
9102 \gdef^^ed{\'{\dotless i}}
9103 \gdef^^ee{\^{\dotless i}}
9104 \gdef^^ef{\"{\dotless i}}
9106 \gdef^^f0{\dh}
9107 \gdef^^f1{\~n}
9108 \gdef^^f2{\`o}
9109 \gdef^^f3{\'o}
9110 \gdef^^f4{\^o}
9111 \gdef^^f5{\~o}
9112 \gdef^^f6{\"o}
9113 \gdef^^f7{$\div$}
9114 \gdef^^f8{\o}
9115 \gdef^^f9{\`u}
9116 \gdef^^fa{\'u}
9117 \gdef^^fb{\^u}
9118 \gdef^^fc{\"u}
9119 \gdef^^fd{\'y}
9120 \gdef^^fe{\th}
9121 \gdef^^ff{\"y}
9124 % Latin9 (ISO-8859-15) encoding character definitions.
9125 \def\latninechardefs{%
9126 % Encoding is almost identical to Latin1.
9127 \latonechardefs
9129 \gdef^^a4{\euro}
9130 \gdef^^a6{\v S}
9131 \gdef^^a8{\v s}
9132 \gdef^^b4{\v Z}
9133 \gdef^^b8{\v z}
9134 \gdef^^bc{\OE}
9135 \gdef^^bd{\oe}
9136 \gdef^^be{\"Y}
9139 % Latin2 (ISO-8859-2) character definitions.
9140 \def\lattwochardefs{%
9141 \gdef^^a0{\tie}
9142 \gdef^^a1{\ogonek{A}}
9143 \gdef^^a2{\u{}}
9144 \gdef^^a3{\L}
9145 \gdef^^a4{\missingcharmsg{CURRENCY SIGN}}
9146 \gdef^^a5{\v L}
9147 \gdef^^a6{\'S}
9148 \gdef^^a7{\S}
9149 \gdef^^a8{\"{}}
9150 \gdef^^a9{\v S}
9151 \gdef^^aa{\cedilla S}
9152 \gdef^^ab{\v T}
9153 \gdef^^ac{\'Z}
9154 \gdef^^ad{\-}
9155 \gdef^^ae{\v Z}
9156 \gdef^^af{\dotaccent Z}
9158 \gdef^^b0{\textdegree}
9159 \gdef^^b1{\ogonek{a}}
9160 \gdef^^b2{\ogonek{ }}
9161 \gdef^^b3{\l}
9162 \gdef^^b4{\'{}}
9163 \gdef^^b5{\v l}
9164 \gdef^^b6{\'s}
9165 \gdef^^b7{\v{}}
9166 \gdef^^b8{\cedilla\ }
9167 \gdef^^b9{\v s}
9168 \gdef^^ba{\cedilla s}
9169 \gdef^^bb{\v t}
9170 \gdef^^bc{\'z}
9171 \gdef^^bd{\H{}}
9172 \gdef^^be{\v z}
9173 \gdef^^bf{\dotaccent z}
9175 \gdef^^c0{\'R}
9176 \gdef^^c1{\'A}
9177 \gdef^^c2{\^A}
9178 \gdef^^c3{\u A}
9179 \gdef^^c4{\"A}
9180 \gdef^^c5{\'L}
9181 \gdef^^c6{\'C}
9182 \gdef^^c7{\cedilla C}
9183 \gdef^^c8{\v C}
9184 \gdef^^c9{\'E}
9185 \gdef^^ca{\ogonek{E}}
9186 \gdef^^cb{\"E}
9187 \gdef^^cc{\v E}
9188 \gdef^^cd{\'I}
9189 \gdef^^ce{\^I}
9190 \gdef^^cf{\v D}
9192 \gdef^^d0{\DH}
9193 \gdef^^d1{\'N}
9194 \gdef^^d2{\v N}
9195 \gdef^^d3{\'O}
9196 \gdef^^d4{\^O}
9197 \gdef^^d5{\H O}
9198 \gdef^^d6{\"O}
9199 \gdef^^d7{$\times$}
9200 \gdef^^d8{\v R}
9201 \gdef^^d9{\ringaccent U}
9202 \gdef^^da{\'U}
9203 \gdef^^db{\H U}
9204 \gdef^^dc{\"U}
9205 \gdef^^dd{\'Y}
9206 \gdef^^de{\cedilla T}
9207 \gdef^^df{\ss}
9209 \gdef^^e0{\'r}
9210 \gdef^^e1{\'a}
9211 \gdef^^e2{\^a}
9212 \gdef^^e3{\u a}
9213 \gdef^^e4{\"a}
9214 \gdef^^e5{\'l}
9215 \gdef^^e6{\'c}
9216 \gdef^^e7{\cedilla c}
9217 \gdef^^e8{\v c}
9218 \gdef^^e9{\'e}
9219 \gdef^^ea{\ogonek{e}}
9220 \gdef^^eb{\"e}
9221 \gdef^^ec{\v e}
9222 \gdef^^ed{\'{\dotless{i}}}
9223 \gdef^^ee{\^{\dotless{i}}}
9224 \gdef^^ef{\v d}
9226 \gdef^^f0{\dh}
9227 \gdef^^f1{\'n}
9228 \gdef^^f2{\v n}
9229 \gdef^^f3{\'o}
9230 \gdef^^f4{\^o}
9231 \gdef^^f5{\H o}
9232 \gdef^^f6{\"o}
9233 \gdef^^f7{$\div$}
9234 \gdef^^f8{\v r}
9235 \gdef^^f9{\ringaccent u}
9236 \gdef^^fa{\'u}
9237 \gdef^^fb{\H u}
9238 \gdef^^fc{\"u}
9239 \gdef^^fd{\'y}
9240 \gdef^^fe{\cedilla t}
9241 \gdef^^ff{\dotaccent{}}
9244 % UTF-8 character definitions.
9246 % This code to support UTF-8 is based on LaTeX's utf8.def, with some
9247 % changes for Texinfo conventions. It is included here under the GPL by
9248 % permission from Frank Mittelbach and the LaTeX team.
9250 \newcount\countUTFx
9251 \newcount\countUTFy
9252 \newcount\countUTFz
9254 \gdef\UTFviiiTwoOctets#1#2{\expandafter
9255 \UTFviiiDefined\csname u8:#1\string #2\endcsname}
9257 \gdef\UTFviiiThreeOctets#1#2#3{\expandafter
9258 \UTFviiiDefined\csname u8:#1\string #2\string #3\endcsname}
9260 \gdef\UTFviiiFourOctets#1#2#3#4{\expandafter
9261 \UTFviiiDefined\csname u8:#1\string #2\string #3\string #4\endcsname}
9263 \gdef\UTFviiiDefined#1{%
9264 \ifx #1\relax
9265 \message{\linenumber Unicode char \string #1 not defined for Texinfo}%
9266 \else
9267 \expandafter #1%
9271 \begingroup
9272 \catcode`\~13
9273 \catcode`\"12
9275 \def\UTFviiiLoop{%
9276 \global\catcode\countUTFx\active
9277 \uccode`\~\countUTFx
9278 \uppercase\expandafter{\UTFviiiTmp}%
9279 \advance\countUTFx by 1
9280 \ifnum\countUTFx < \countUTFy
9281 \expandafter\UTFviiiLoop
9282 \fi}
9284 \countUTFx = "C2
9285 \countUTFy = "E0
9286 \def\UTFviiiTmp{%
9287 \xdef~{\noexpand\UTFviiiTwoOctets\string~}}
9288 \UTFviiiLoop
9290 \countUTFx = "E0
9291 \countUTFy = "F0
9292 \def\UTFviiiTmp{%
9293 \xdef~{\noexpand\UTFviiiThreeOctets\string~}}
9294 \UTFviiiLoop
9296 \countUTFx = "F0
9297 \countUTFy = "F4
9298 \def\UTFviiiTmp{%
9299 \xdef~{\noexpand\UTFviiiFourOctets\string~}}
9300 \UTFviiiLoop
9301 \endgroup
9303 \def\globallet{\global\let} % save some \expandafter's below
9305 % @U{xxxx} to produce U+xxxx, if we support it.
9306 \def\U#1{%
9307 \expandafter\ifx\csname uni:#1\endcsname \relax
9308 \errhelp = \EMsimple
9309 \errmessage{Unicode character U+#1 not supported, sorry}%
9310 \else
9311 \csname uni:#1\endcsname
9315 \begingroup
9316 \catcode`\"=12
9317 \catcode`\<=12
9318 \catcode`\.=12
9319 \catcode`\,=12
9320 \catcode`\;=12
9321 \catcode`\!=12
9322 \catcode`\~=13
9323 \gdef\DeclareUnicodeCharacter#1#2{%
9324 \countUTFz = "#1\relax
9325 %\wlog{\space\space defining Unicode char U+#1 (decimal \the\countUTFz)}%
9326 \begingroup
9327 \parseXMLCharref
9328 \def\UTFviiiTwoOctets##1##2{%
9329 \csname u8:##1\string ##2\endcsname}%
9330 \def\UTFviiiThreeOctets##1##2##3{%
9331 \csname u8:##1\string ##2\string ##3\endcsname}%
9332 \def\UTFviiiFourOctets##1##2##3##4{%
9333 \csname u8:##1\string ##2\string ##3\string ##4\endcsname}%
9334 \expandafter\expandafter\expandafter\expandafter
9335 \expandafter\expandafter\expandafter
9336 \gdef\UTFviiiTmp{#2}%
9338 \expandafter\ifx\csname uni:#1\endcsname \relax \else
9339 \errmessage{Internal error, already defined: #1}%
9342 % define an additional control sequence for this code point.
9343 \expandafter\globallet\csname uni:#1\endcsname \UTFviiiTmp
9344 \endgroup}
9346 \gdef\parseXMLCharref{%
9347 \ifnum\countUTFz < "A0\relax
9348 \errhelp = \EMsimple
9349 \errmessage{Cannot define Unicode char value < 00A0}%
9350 \else\ifnum\countUTFz < "800\relax
9351 \parseUTFviiiA,%
9352 \parseUTFviiiB C\UTFviiiTwoOctets.,%
9353 \else\ifnum\countUTFz < "10000\relax
9354 \parseUTFviiiA;%
9355 \parseUTFviiiA,%
9356 \parseUTFviiiB E\UTFviiiThreeOctets.{,;}%
9357 \else
9358 \parseUTFviiiA;%
9359 \parseUTFviiiA,%
9360 \parseUTFviiiA!%
9361 \parseUTFviiiB F\UTFviiiFourOctets.{!,;}%
9362 \fi\fi\fi
9365 \gdef\parseUTFviiiA#1{%
9366 \countUTFx = \countUTFz
9367 \divide\countUTFz by 64
9368 \countUTFy = \countUTFz
9369 \multiply\countUTFz by 64
9370 \advance\countUTFx by -\countUTFz
9371 \advance\countUTFx by 128
9372 \uccode `#1\countUTFx
9373 \countUTFz = \countUTFy}
9375 \gdef\parseUTFviiiB#1#2#3#4{%
9376 \advance\countUTFz by "#10\relax
9377 \uccode `#3\countUTFz
9378 \uppercase{\gdef\UTFviiiTmp{#2#3#4}}}
9379 \endgroup
9381 % https://en.wikipedia.org/wiki/Plane_(Unicode)#Basic_M
9382 % U+0000..U+007F = https://en.wikipedia.org/wiki/Basic_Latin_(Unicode_block)
9383 % U+0080..U+00FF = https://en.wikipedia.org/wiki/Latin-1_Supplement_(Unicode_block)
9384 % U+0100..U+017F = https://en.wikipedia.org/wiki/Latin_Extended-A
9385 % U+0180..U+024F = https://en.wikipedia.org/wiki/Latin_Extended-B
9387 % Many of our renditions are less than wonderful, and all the missing
9388 % characters are available somewhere. Loading the necessary fonts
9389 % awaits user request. We can't truly support Unicode without
9390 % reimplementing everything that's been done in LaTeX for many years,
9391 % plus probably using luatex or xetex, and who knows what else.
9392 % We won't be doing that here in this simple file. But we can try to at
9393 % least make most of the characters not bomb out.
9395 \def\utfeightchardefs{%
9396 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00A0}{\tie}
9397 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00A1}{\exclamdown}
9398 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00A3}{\pounds}
9399 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00A7}{\S}
9400 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00A8}{\"{ }}
9401 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00A9}{\copyright}
9402 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00AA}{\ordf}
9403 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00AB}{\guillemetleft}
9404 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00AC}{\ensuremath\lnot}
9405 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00AD}{\-}
9406 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00AE}{\registeredsymbol}
9407 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00AF}{\={ }}
9409 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00B0}{\ringaccent{ }}
9410 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00B1}{\ensuremath\pm}
9411 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00B2}{$^2$}
9412 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00B3}{$^3$}
9413 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00B4}{\'{ }}
9414 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00B5}{$\mu$}
9415 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00B6}{\P}
9416 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00B7}{\ensuremath\cdot}
9417 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00B8}{\cedilla{ }}
9418 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00B9}{$^1$}
9419 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00BA}{\ordm}
9420 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00BB}{\guillemetright}
9421 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00BC}{$1\over4$}
9422 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00BD}{$1\over2$}
9423 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00BE}{$3\over4$}
9424 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00BF}{\questiondown}
9426 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00C0}{\`A}
9427 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00C1}{\'A}
9428 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00C2}{\^A}
9429 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00C3}{\~A}
9430 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00C4}{\"A}
9431 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00C5}{\AA}
9432 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00C6}{\AE}
9433 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00C7}{\cedilla{C}}
9434 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00C8}{\`E}
9435 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00C9}{\'E}
9436 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00CA}{\^E}
9437 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00CB}{\"E}
9438 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00CC}{\`I}
9439 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00CD}{\'I}
9440 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00CE}{\^I}
9441 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00CF}{\"I}
9443 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00D0}{\DH}
9444 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00D1}{\~N}
9445 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00D2}{\`O}
9446 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00D3}{\'O}
9447 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00D4}{\^O}
9448 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00D5}{\~O}
9449 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00D6}{\"O}
9450 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00D7}{\ensuremath\times}
9451 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00D8}{\O}
9452 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00D9}{\`U}
9453 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00DA}{\'U}
9454 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00DB}{\^U}
9455 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00DC}{\"U}
9456 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00DD}{\'Y}
9457 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00DE}{\TH}
9458 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00DF}{\ss}
9460 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00E0}{\`a}
9461 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00E1}{\'a}
9462 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00E2}{\^a}
9463 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00E3}{\~a}
9464 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00E4}{\"a}
9465 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00E5}{\aa}
9466 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00E6}{\ae}
9467 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00E7}{\cedilla{c}}
9468 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00E8}{\`e}
9469 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00E9}{\'e}
9470 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00EA}{\^e}
9471 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00EB}{\"e}
9472 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00EC}{\`{\dotless{i}}}
9473 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00ED}{\'{\dotless{i}}}
9474 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00EE}{\^{\dotless{i}}}
9475 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00EF}{\"{\dotless{i}}}
9477 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00F0}{\dh}
9478 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00F1}{\~n}
9479 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00F2}{\`o}
9480 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00F3}{\'o}
9481 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00F4}{\^o}
9482 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00F5}{\~o}
9483 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00F6}{\"o}
9484 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00F7}{\ensuremath\div}
9485 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00F8}{\o}
9486 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00F9}{\`u}
9487 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00FA}{\'u}
9488 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00FB}{\^u}
9489 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00FC}{\"u}
9490 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00FD}{\'y}
9491 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00FE}{\th}
9492 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00FF}{\"y}
9494 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0100}{\=A}
9495 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0101}{\=a}
9496 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0102}{\u{A}}
9497 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0103}{\u{a}}
9498 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0104}{\ogonek{A}}
9499 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0105}{\ogonek{a}}
9500 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0106}{\'C}
9501 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0107}{\'c}
9502 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0108}{\^C}
9503 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0109}{\^c}
9504 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{010A}{\dotaccent{C}}
9505 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{010B}{\dotaccent{c}}
9506 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{010C}{\v{C}}
9507 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{010D}{\v{c}}
9508 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{010E}{\v{D}}
9509 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{010F}{d'}
9511 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0110}{\DH}
9512 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0111}{\dh}
9513 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0112}{\=E}
9514 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0113}{\=e}
9515 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0114}{\u{E}}
9516 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0115}{\u{e}}
9517 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0116}{\dotaccent{E}}
9518 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0117}{\dotaccent{e}}
9519 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0118}{\ogonek{E}}
9520 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0119}{\ogonek{e}}
9521 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{011A}{\v{E}}
9522 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{011B}{\v{e}}
9523 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{011C}{\^G}
9524 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{011D}{\^g}
9525 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{011E}{\u{G}}
9526 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{011F}{\u{g}}
9528 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0120}{\dotaccent{G}}
9529 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0121}{\dotaccent{g}}
9530 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0122}{\cedilla{G}}
9531 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0123}{\cedilla{g}}
9532 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0124}{\^H}
9533 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0125}{\^h}
9534 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0126}{\missingcharmsg{H WITH STROKE}}
9535 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0127}{\missingcharmsg{h WITH STROKE}}
9536 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0128}{\~I}
9537 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0129}{\~{\dotless{i}}}
9538 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{012A}{\=I}
9539 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{012B}{\={\dotless{i}}}
9540 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{012C}{\u{I}}
9541 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{012D}{\u{\dotless{i}}}
9542 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{012E}{\ogonek{I}}
9543 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{012F}{\ogonek{i}}
9545 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0130}{\dotaccent{I}}
9546 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0131}{\dotless{i}}
9547 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0132}{IJ}
9548 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0133}{ij}
9549 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0134}{\^J}
9550 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0135}{\^{\dotless{j}}}
9551 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0136}{\cedilla{K}}
9552 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0137}{\cedilla{k}}
9553 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0138}{\ensuremath\kappa}
9554 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0139}{\'L}
9555 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{013A}{\'l}
9556 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{013B}{\cedilla{L}}
9557 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{013C}{\cedilla{l}}
9558 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{013D}{L'}% should kern
9559 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{013E}{l'}% should kern
9560 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{013F}{L\U{00B7}}
9562 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0140}{l\U{00B7}}
9563 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0141}{\L}
9564 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0142}{\l}
9565 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0143}{\'N}
9566 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0144}{\'n}
9567 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0145}{\cedilla{N}}
9568 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0146}{\cedilla{n}}
9569 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0147}{\v{N}}
9570 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0148}{\v{n}}
9571 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0149}{'n}
9572 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{014A}{\missingcharmsg{ENG}}
9573 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{014B}{\missingcharmsg{eng}}
9574 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{014C}{\=O}
9575 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{014D}{\=o}
9576 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{014E}{\u{O}}
9577 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{014F}{\u{o}}
9579 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0150}{\H{O}}
9580 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0151}{\H{o}}
9581 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0152}{\OE}
9582 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0153}{\oe}
9583 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0154}{\'R}
9584 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0155}{\'r}
9585 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0156}{\cedilla{R}}
9586 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0157}{\cedilla{r}}
9587 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0158}{\v{R}}
9588 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0159}{\v{r}}
9589 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{015A}{\'S}
9590 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{015B}{\'s}
9591 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{015C}{\^S}
9592 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{015D}{\^s}
9593 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{015E}{\cedilla{S}}
9594 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{015F}{\cedilla{s}}
9596 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0160}{\v{S}}
9597 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0161}{\v{s}}
9598 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0162}{\cedilla{T}}
9599 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0163}{\cedilla{t}}
9600 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0164}{\v{T}}
9601 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0165}{\v{t}}
9602 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0166}{\missingcharmsg{H WITH STROKE}}
9603 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0167}{\missingcharmsg{h WITH STROKE}}
9604 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0168}{\~U}
9605 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0169}{\~u}
9606 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{016A}{\=U}
9607 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{016B}{\=u}
9608 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{016C}{\u{U}}
9609 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{016D}{\u{u}}
9610 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{016E}{\ringaccent{U}}
9611 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{016F}{\ringaccent{u}}
9613 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0170}{\H{U}}
9614 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0171}{\H{u}}
9615 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0172}{\ogonek{U}}
9616 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0173}{\ogonek{u}}
9617 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0174}{\^W}
9618 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0175}{\^w}
9619 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0176}{\^Y}
9620 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0177}{\^y}
9621 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0178}{\"Y}
9622 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0179}{\'Z}
9623 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{017A}{\'z}
9624 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{017B}{\dotaccent{Z}}
9625 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{017C}{\dotaccent{z}}
9626 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{017D}{\v{Z}}
9627 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{017E}{\v{z}}
9628 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{017F}{\missingcharmsg{LONG S}}
9630 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{01C4}{D\v{Z}}
9631 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{01C5}{D\v{z}}
9632 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{01C6}{d\v{z}}
9633 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{01C7}{LJ}
9634 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{01C8}{Lj}
9635 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{01C9}{lj}
9636 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{01CA}{NJ}
9637 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{01CB}{Nj}
9638 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{01CC}{nj}
9639 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{01CD}{\v{A}}
9640 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{01CE}{\v{a}}
9641 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{01CF}{\v{I}}
9643 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{01D0}{\v{\dotless{i}}}
9644 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{01D1}{\v{O}}
9645 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{01D2}{\v{o}}
9646 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{01D3}{\v{U}}
9647 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{01D4}{\v{u}}
9649 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{01E2}{\={\AE}}
9650 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{01E3}{\={\ae}}
9651 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{01E6}{\v{G}}
9652 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{01E7}{\v{g}}
9653 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{01E8}{\v{K}}
9654 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{01E9}{\v{k}}
9656 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{01F0}{\v{\dotless{j}}}
9657 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{01F1}{DZ}
9658 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{01F2}{Dz}
9659 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{01F3}{dz}
9660 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{01F4}{\'G}
9661 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{01F5}{\'g}
9662 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{01F8}{\`N}
9663 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{01F9}{\`n}
9664 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{01FC}{\'{\AE}}
9665 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{01FD}{\'{\ae}}
9666 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{01FE}{\'{\O}}
9667 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{01FF}{\'{\o}}
9669 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{021E}{\v{H}}
9670 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{021F}{\v{h}}
9672 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0226}{\dotaccent{A}}
9673 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0227}{\dotaccent{a}}
9674 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0228}{\cedilla{E}}
9675 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0229}{\cedilla{e}}
9676 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{022E}{\dotaccent{O}}
9677 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{022F}{\dotaccent{o}}
9679 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0232}{\=Y}
9680 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0233}{\=y}
9681 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0237}{\dotless{j}}
9683 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{02DB}{\ogonek{ }}
9685 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E02}{\dotaccent{B}}
9686 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E03}{\dotaccent{b}}
9687 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E04}{\udotaccent{B}}
9688 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E05}{\udotaccent{b}}
9689 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E06}{\ubaraccent{B}}
9690 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E07}{\ubaraccent{b}}
9691 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E0A}{\dotaccent{D}}
9692 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E0B}{\dotaccent{d}}
9693 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E0C}{\udotaccent{D}}
9694 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E0D}{\udotaccent{d}}
9695 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E0E}{\ubaraccent{D}}
9696 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E0F}{\ubaraccent{d}}
9698 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E1E}{\dotaccent{F}}
9699 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E1F}{\dotaccent{f}}
9701 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E20}{\=G}
9702 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E21}{\=g}
9703 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E22}{\dotaccent{H}}
9704 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E23}{\dotaccent{h}}
9705 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E24}{\udotaccent{H}}
9706 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E25}{\udotaccent{h}}
9707 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E26}{\"H}
9708 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E27}{\"h}
9710 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E30}{\'K}
9711 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E31}{\'k}
9712 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E32}{\udotaccent{K}}
9713 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E33}{\udotaccent{k}}
9714 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E34}{\ubaraccent{K}}
9715 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E35}{\ubaraccent{k}}
9716 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E36}{\udotaccent{L}}
9717 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E37}{\udotaccent{l}}
9718 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E3A}{\ubaraccent{L}}
9719 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E3B}{\ubaraccent{l}}
9720 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E3E}{\'M}
9721 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E3F}{\'m}
9723 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E40}{\dotaccent{M}}
9724 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E41}{\dotaccent{m}}
9725 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E42}{\udotaccent{M}}
9726 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E43}{\udotaccent{m}}
9727 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E44}{\dotaccent{N}}
9728 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E45}{\dotaccent{n}}
9729 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E46}{\udotaccent{N}}
9730 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E47}{\udotaccent{n}}
9731 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E48}{\ubaraccent{N}}
9732 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E49}{\ubaraccent{n}}
9734 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E54}{\'P}
9735 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E55}{\'p}
9736 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E56}{\dotaccent{P}}
9737 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E57}{\dotaccent{p}}
9738 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E58}{\dotaccent{R}}
9739 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E59}{\dotaccent{r}}
9740 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E5A}{\udotaccent{R}}
9741 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E5B}{\udotaccent{r}}
9742 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E5E}{\ubaraccent{R}}
9743 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E5F}{\ubaraccent{r}}
9745 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E60}{\dotaccent{S}}
9746 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E61}{\dotaccent{s}}
9747 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E62}{\udotaccent{S}}
9748 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E63}{\udotaccent{s}}
9749 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E6A}{\dotaccent{T}}
9750 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E6B}{\dotaccent{t}}
9751 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E6C}{\udotaccent{T}}
9752 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E6D}{\udotaccent{t}}
9753 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E6E}{\ubaraccent{T}}
9754 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E6F}{\ubaraccent{t}}
9756 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E7C}{\~V}
9757 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E7D}{\~v}
9758 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E7E}{\udotaccent{V}}
9759 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E7F}{\udotaccent{v}}
9761 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E80}{\`W}
9762 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E81}{\`w}
9763 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E82}{\'W}
9764 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E83}{\'w}
9765 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E84}{\"W}
9766 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E85}{\"w}
9767 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E86}{\dotaccent{W}}
9768 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E87}{\dotaccent{w}}
9769 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E88}{\udotaccent{W}}
9770 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E89}{\udotaccent{w}}
9771 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E8A}{\dotaccent{X}}
9772 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E8B}{\dotaccent{x}}
9773 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E8C}{\"X}
9774 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E8D}{\"x}
9775 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E8E}{\dotaccent{Y}}
9776 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E8F}{\dotaccent{y}}
9778 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E90}{\^Z}
9779 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E91}{\^z}
9780 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E92}{\udotaccent{Z}}
9781 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E93}{\udotaccent{z}}
9782 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E94}{\ubaraccent{Z}}
9783 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E95}{\ubaraccent{z}}
9784 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E96}{\ubaraccent{h}}
9785 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E97}{\"t}
9786 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E98}{\ringaccent{w}}
9787 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E99}{\ringaccent{y}}
9789 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1EA0}{\udotaccent{A}}
9790 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1EA1}{\udotaccent{a}}
9792 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1EB8}{\udotaccent{E}}
9793 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1EB9}{\udotaccent{e}}
9794 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1EBC}{\~E}
9795 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1EBD}{\~e}
9797 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1ECA}{\udotaccent{I}}
9798 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1ECB}{\udotaccent{i}}
9799 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1ECC}{\udotaccent{O}}
9800 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1ECD}{\udotaccent{o}}
9802 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1EE4}{\udotaccent{U}}
9803 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1EE5}{\udotaccent{u}}
9805 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1EF2}{\`Y}
9806 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1EF3}{\`y}
9807 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1EF4}{\udotaccent{Y}}
9809 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1EF8}{\~Y}
9810 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1EF9}{\~y}
9812 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{2013}{--}
9813 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{2014}{---}
9814 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{2018}{\quoteleft}
9815 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{2019}{\quoteright}
9816 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{201A}{\quotesinglbase}
9817 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{201C}{\quotedblleft}
9818 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{201D}{\quotedblright}
9819 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{201E}{\quotedblbase}
9820 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{2020}{\ensuremath\dagger}
9821 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{2021}{\ensuremath\ddagger}
9822 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{2022}{\bullet}
9823 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{2026}{\dots}
9824 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{2039}{\guilsinglleft}
9825 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{203A}{\guilsinglright}
9826 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{20AC}{\euro}
9828 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{2192}{\expansion}
9829 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{21D2}{\result}
9831 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{2212}{\minus}
9832 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{2217}{\point}
9833 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{2225}{\ensuremath\parallel}
9834 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{2261}{\equiv}
9835 }% end of \utfeightchardefs
9837 % US-ASCII character definitions.
9838 \def\asciichardefs{% nothing need be done
9839 \relax
9842 % Latin1 (ISO-8859-1) character definitions.
9843 \def\nonasciistringdefs{%
9844 \setnonasciicharscatcode\active
9845 \def\defstringchar##1{\def##1{\string##1}}%
9847 \defstringchar^^80\defstringchar^^81\defstringchar^^82\defstringchar^^83%
9848 \defstringchar^^84\defstringchar^^85\defstringchar^^86\defstringchar^^87%
9849 \defstringchar^^88\defstringchar^^89\defstringchar^^8a\defstringchar^^8b%
9850 \defstringchar^^8c\defstringchar^^8d\defstringchar^^8e\defstringchar^^8f%
9852 \defstringchar^^90\defstringchar^^91\defstringchar^^92\defstringchar^^93%
9853 \defstringchar^^94\defstringchar^^95\defstringchar^^96\defstringchar^^97%
9854 \defstringchar^^98\defstringchar^^99\defstringchar^^9a\defstringchar^^9b%
9855 \defstringchar^^9c\defstringchar^^9d\defstringchar^^9e\defstringchar^^9f%
9857 \defstringchar^^a0\defstringchar^^a1\defstringchar^^a2\defstringchar^^a3%
9858 \defstringchar^^a4\defstringchar^^a5\defstringchar^^a6\defstringchar^^a7%
9859 \defstringchar^^a8\defstringchar^^a9\defstringchar^^aa\defstringchar^^ab%
9860 \defstringchar^^ac\defstringchar^^ad\defstringchar^^ae\defstringchar^^af%
9862 \defstringchar^^b0\defstringchar^^b1\defstringchar^^b2\defstringchar^^b3%
9863 \defstringchar^^b4\defstringchar^^b5\defstringchar^^b6\defstringchar^^b7%
9864 \defstringchar^^b8\defstringchar^^b9\defstringchar^^ba\defstringchar^^bb%
9865 \defstringchar^^bc\defstringchar^^bd\defstringchar^^be\defstringchar^^bf%
9867 \defstringchar^^c0\defstringchar^^c1\defstringchar^^c2\defstringchar^^c3%
9868 \defstringchar^^c4\defstringchar^^c5\defstringchar^^c6\defstringchar^^c7%
9869 \defstringchar^^c8\defstringchar^^c9\defstringchar^^ca\defstringchar^^cb%
9870 \defstringchar^^cc\defstringchar^^cd\defstringchar^^ce\defstringchar^^cf%
9872 \defstringchar^^d0\defstringchar^^d1\defstringchar^^d2\defstringchar^^d3%
9873 \defstringchar^^d4\defstringchar^^d5\defstringchar^^d6\defstringchar^^d7%
9874 \defstringchar^^d8\defstringchar^^d9\defstringchar^^da\defstringchar^^db%
9875 \defstringchar^^dc\defstringchar^^dd\defstringchar^^de\defstringchar^^df%
9877 \defstringchar^^e0\defstringchar^^e1\defstringchar^^e2\defstringchar^^e3%
9878 \defstringchar^^e4\defstringchar^^e5\defstringchar^^e6\defstringchar^^e7%
9879 \defstringchar^^e8\defstringchar^^e9\defstringchar^^ea\defstringchar^^eb%
9880 \defstringchar^^ec\defstringchar^^ed\defstringchar^^ee\defstringchar^^ef%
9882 \defstringchar^^f0\defstringchar^^f1\defstringchar^^f2\defstringchar^^f3%
9883 \defstringchar^^f4\defstringchar^^f5\defstringchar^^f6\defstringchar^^f7%
9884 \defstringchar^^f8\defstringchar^^f9\defstringchar^^fa\defstringchar^^fb%
9885 \defstringchar^^fc\defstringchar^^fd\defstringchar^^fe\defstringchar^^ff%
9889 % define all the unicode characters we know about, for the sake of @U.
9890 \utfeightchardefs
9893 % Make non-ASCII characters printable again for compatibility with
9894 % existing Texinfo documents that may use them, even without declaring a
9895 % document encoding.
9897 \setnonasciicharscatcode \other
9900 \message{formatting,}
9902 \newdimen\defaultparindent \defaultparindent = 15pt
9904 \chapheadingskip = 15pt plus 4pt minus 2pt
9905 \secheadingskip = 12pt plus 3pt minus 2pt
9906 \subsecheadingskip = 9pt plus 2pt minus 2pt
9908 % Prevent underfull vbox error messages.
9909 \vbadness = 10000
9911 % Don't be very finicky about underfull hboxes, either.
9912 \hbadness = 6666
9914 % Following George Bush, get rid of widows and orphans.
9915 \widowpenalty=10000
9916 \clubpenalty=10000
9918 % Use TeX 3.0's \emergencystretch to help line breaking, but if we're
9919 % using an old version of TeX, don't do anything. We want the amount of
9920 % stretch added to depend on the line length, hence the dependence on
9921 % \hsize. We call this whenever the paper size is set.
9923 \def\setemergencystretch{%
9924 \ifx\emergencystretch\thisisundefined
9925 % Allow us to assign to \emergencystretch anyway.
9926 \def\emergencystretch{\dimen0}%
9927 \else
9928 \emergencystretch = .15\hsize
9932 % Parameters in order: 1) textheight; 2) textwidth;
9933 % 3) voffset; 4) hoffset; 5) binding offset; 6) topskip;
9934 % 7) physical page height; 8) physical page width.
9936 % We also call \setleading{\textleading}, so the caller should define
9937 % \textleading. The caller should also set \parskip.
9939 \def\internalpagesizes#1#2#3#4#5#6#7#8{%
9940 \voffset = #3\relax
9941 \topskip = #6\relax
9942 \splittopskip = \topskip
9944 \vsize = #1\relax
9945 \advance\vsize by \topskip
9946 \outervsize = \vsize
9947 \advance\outervsize by 2\topandbottommargin
9948 \pageheight = \vsize
9950 \hsize = #2\relax
9951 \outerhsize = \hsize
9952 \advance\outerhsize by 0.5in
9953 \pagewidth = \hsize
9955 \normaloffset = #4\relax
9956 \bindingoffset = #5\relax
9958 \ifpdf
9959 \pdfpageheight #7\relax
9960 \pdfpagewidth #8\relax
9961 % if we don't reset these, they will remain at "1 true in" of
9962 % whatever layout pdftex was dumped with.
9963 \pdfhorigin = 1 true in
9964 \pdfvorigin = 1 true in
9967 \setleading{\textleading}
9969 \parindent = \defaultparindent
9970 \setemergencystretch
9973 % @letterpaper (the default).
9974 \def\letterpaper{{\globaldefs = 1
9975 \parskip = 3pt plus 2pt minus 1pt
9976 \textleading = 13.2pt
9978 % If page is nothing but text, make it come out even.
9979 \internalpagesizes{607.2pt}{6in}% that's 46 lines
9980 {\voffset}{.25in}%
9981 {\bindingoffset}{36pt}%
9982 {11in}{8.5in}%
9985 % Use @smallbook to reset parameters for 7x9.25 trim size.
9986 \def\smallbook{{\globaldefs = 1
9987 \parskip = 2pt plus 1pt
9988 \textleading = 12pt
9990 \internalpagesizes{7.5in}{5in}%
9991 {-.2in}{0in}%
9992 {\bindingoffset}{16pt}%
9993 {9.25in}{7in}%
9995 \lispnarrowing = 0.3in
9996 \tolerance = 700
9997 \hfuzz = 1pt
9998 \contentsrightmargin = 0pt
9999 \defbodyindent = .5cm
10002 % Use @smallerbook to reset parameters for 6x9 trim size.
10003 % (Just testing, parameters still in flux.)
10004 \def\smallerbook{{\globaldefs = 1
10005 \parskip = 1.5pt plus 1pt
10006 \textleading = 12pt
10008 \internalpagesizes{7.4in}{4.8in}%
10009 {-.2in}{-.4in}%
10010 {0pt}{14pt}%
10011 {9in}{6in}%
10013 \lispnarrowing = 0.25in
10014 \tolerance = 700
10015 \hfuzz = 1pt
10016 \contentsrightmargin = 0pt
10017 \defbodyindent = .4cm
10020 % Use @afourpaper to print on European A4 paper.
10021 \def\afourpaper{{\globaldefs = 1
10022 \parskip = 3pt plus 2pt minus 1pt
10023 \textleading = 13.2pt
10025 % Double-side printing via postscript on Laserjet 4050
10026 % prints double-sided nicely when \bindingoffset=10mm and \hoffset=-6mm.
10027 % To change the settings for a different printer or situation, adjust
10028 % \normaloffset until the front-side and back-side texts align. Then
10029 % do the same for \bindingoffset. You can set these for testing in
10030 % your texinfo source file like this:
10031 % @tex
10032 % \global\normaloffset = -6mm
10033 % \global\bindingoffset = 10mm
10034 % @end tex
10035 \internalpagesizes{673.2pt}{160mm}% that's 51 lines
10036 {\voffset}{\hoffset}%
10037 {\bindingoffset}{44pt}%
10038 {297mm}{210mm}%
10040 \tolerance = 700
10041 \hfuzz = 1pt
10042 \contentsrightmargin = 0pt
10043 \defbodyindent = 5mm
10046 % Use @afivepaper to print on European A5 paper.
10047 % From romildo@urano.iceb.ufop.br, 2 July 2000.
10048 % He also recommends making @example and @lisp be small.
10049 \def\afivepaper{{\globaldefs = 1
10050 \parskip = 2pt plus 1pt minus 0.1pt
10051 \textleading = 12.5pt
10053 \internalpagesizes{160mm}{120mm}%
10054 {\voffset}{\hoffset}%
10055 {\bindingoffset}{8pt}%
10056 {210mm}{148mm}%
10058 \lispnarrowing = 0.2in
10059 \tolerance = 800
10060 \hfuzz = 1.2pt
10061 \contentsrightmargin = 0pt
10062 \defbodyindent = 2mm
10063 \tableindent = 12mm
10066 % A specific text layout, 24x15cm overall, intended for A4 paper.
10067 \def\afourlatex{{\globaldefs = 1
10068 \afourpaper
10069 \internalpagesizes{237mm}{150mm}%
10070 {\voffset}{4.6mm}%
10071 {\bindingoffset}{7mm}%
10072 {297mm}{210mm}%
10074 % Must explicitly reset to 0 because we call \afourpaper.
10075 \globaldefs = 0
10078 % Use @afourwide to print on A4 paper in landscape format.
10079 \def\afourwide{{\globaldefs = 1
10080 \afourpaper
10081 \internalpagesizes{241mm}{165mm}%
10082 {\voffset}{-2.95mm}%
10083 {\bindingoffset}{7mm}%
10084 {297mm}{210mm}%
10085 \globaldefs = 0
10088 % @pagesizes TEXTHEIGHT[,TEXTWIDTH]
10089 % Perhaps we should allow setting the margins, \topskip, \parskip,
10090 % and/or leading, also. Or perhaps we should compute them somehow.
10092 \parseargdef\pagesizes{\pagesizesyyy #1,,\finish}
10093 \def\pagesizesyyy#1,#2,#3\finish{{%
10094 \setbox0 = \hbox{\ignorespaces #2}\ifdim\wd0 > 0pt \hsize=#2\relax \fi
10095 \globaldefs = 1
10097 \parskip = 3pt plus 2pt minus 1pt
10098 \setleading{\textleading}%
10100 \dimen0 = #1\relax
10101 \advance\dimen0 by \voffset
10103 \dimen2 = \hsize
10104 \advance\dimen2 by \normaloffset
10106 \internalpagesizes{#1}{\hsize}%
10107 {\voffset}{\normaloffset}%
10108 {\bindingoffset}{44pt}%
10109 {\dimen0}{\dimen2}%
10112 % Set default to letter.
10114 \letterpaper
10117 \message{and turning on texinfo input format.}
10119 \def^^L{\par} % remove \outer, so ^L can appear in an @comment
10121 % DEL is a comment character, in case @c does not suffice.
10122 \catcode`\^^? = 14
10124 % Define macros to output various characters with catcode for normal text.
10125 \catcode`\"=\other \def\normaldoublequote{"}
10126 \catcode`\$=\other \def\normaldollar{$}%$ font-lock fix
10127 \catcode`\+=\other \def\normalplus{+}
10128 \catcode`\<=\other \def\normalless{<}
10129 \catcode`\>=\other \def\normalgreater{>}
10130 \catcode`\^=\other \def\normalcaret{^}
10131 \catcode`\_=\other \def\normalunderscore{_}
10132 \catcode`\|=\other \def\normalverticalbar{|}
10133 \catcode`\~=\other \def\normaltilde{~}
10135 % This macro is used to make a character print one way in \tt
10136 % (where it can probably be output as-is), and another way in other fonts,
10137 % where something hairier probably needs to be done.
10139 % #1 is what to print if we are indeed using \tt; #2 is what to print
10140 % otherwise. Since all the Computer Modern typewriter fonts have zero
10141 % interword stretch (and shrink), and it is reasonable to expect all
10142 % typewriter fonts to have this, we can check that font parameter.
10144 \def\ifusingtt#1#2{\ifdim \fontdimen3\font=0pt #1\else #2\fi}
10146 % Same as above, but check for italic font. Actually this also catches
10147 % non-italic slanted fonts since it is impossible to distinguish them from
10148 % italic fonts. But since this is only used by $ and it uses \sl anyway
10149 % this is not a problem.
10150 \def\ifusingit#1#2{\ifdim \fontdimen1\font>0pt #1\else #2\fi}
10152 % Turn off all special characters except @
10153 % (and those which the user can use as if they were ordinary).
10154 % Most of these we simply print from the \tt font, but for some, we can
10155 % use math or other variants that look better in normal text.
10157 \catcode`\"=\active
10158 \def\activedoublequote{{\tt\char34}}
10159 \let"=\activedoublequote
10160 \catcode`\~=\active \def\activetilde{{\tt\char126}} \let~ = \activetilde
10161 \chardef\hat=`\^
10162 \catcode`\^=\active \def\activehat{{\tt \hat}} \let^ = \activehat
10164 \catcode`\_=\active
10165 \def_{\ifusingtt\normalunderscore\_}
10166 \let\realunder=_
10167 % Subroutine for the previous macro.
10168 \def\_{\leavevmode \kern.07em \vbox{\hrule width.3em height.1ex}\kern .07em }
10170 \catcode`\|=\active
10171 \def|{{\tt\char124}}
10173 \chardef \less=`\<
10174 \catcode`\<=\active \def\activeless{{\tt \less}}\let< = \activeless
10175 \chardef \gtr=`\>
10176 \catcode`\>=\active \def\activegtr{{\tt \gtr}}\let> = \activegtr
10177 \catcode`\+=\active \def+{{\tt \char 43}}
10178 \catcode`\$=\active \def${\ifusingit{{\sl\$}}\normaldollar}%$ font-lock fix
10180 % used for headline/footline in the output routine, in case the page
10181 % breaks in the middle of an @tex block.
10182 \def\texinfochars{%
10183 \let< = \activeless
10184 \let> = \activegtr
10185 \let~ = \activetilde
10186 \let^ = \activehat
10187 \markupsetuplqdefault \markupsetuprqdefault
10188 \let\b = \strong
10189 \let\i = \smartitalic
10190 % in principle, all other definitions in \tex have to be undone too.
10193 % If a .fmt file is being used, characters that might appear in a file
10194 % name cannot be active until we have parsed the command line.
10195 % So turn them off again, and have \everyjob (or @setfilename) turn them on.
10196 % \otherifyactive is called near the end of this file.
10197 \def\otherifyactive{\catcode`+=\other \catcode`\_=\other}
10199 % Used sometimes to turn off (effectively) the active characters even after
10200 % parsing them.
10201 \def\turnoffactive{%
10202 \normalturnoffactive
10203 \otherbackslash
10206 \catcode`\@=0
10208 % \backslashcurfont outputs one backslash character in current font,
10209 % as in \char`\\.
10210 \global\chardef\backslashcurfont=`\\
10211 \global\let\rawbackslashxx=\backslashcurfont % let existing .??s files work
10213 % \realbackslash is an actual character `\' with catcode other, and
10214 % \doublebackslash is two of them (for the pdf outlines).
10215 {\catcode`\\=\other @gdef@realbackslash{\} @gdef@doublebackslash{\\}}
10217 % In texinfo, backslash is an active character; it prints the backslash
10218 % in fixed width font.
10219 \catcode`\\=\active % @ for escape char from now on.
10221 % The story here is that in math mode, the \char of \backslashcurfont
10222 % ends up printing the roman \ from the math symbol font (because \char
10223 % in math mode uses the \mathcode, and plain.tex sets
10224 % \mathcode`\\="026E). It seems better for @backslashchar{} to always
10225 % print a typewriter backslash, hence we use an explicit \mathchar,
10226 % which is the decimal equivalent of "715c (class 7, e.g., use \fam;
10227 % ignored family value; char position "5C). We can't use " for the
10228 % usual hex value because it has already been made active.
10229 @def@normalbackslash{{@tt @ifmmode @mathchar29020 @else @backslashcurfont @fi}}
10230 @let@backslashchar = @normalbackslash % @backslashchar{} is for user documents.
10232 % On startup, @fixbackslash assigns:
10233 % @let \ = @normalbackslash
10234 % \rawbackslash defines an active \ to do \backslashcurfont.
10235 % \otherbackslash defines an active \ to be a literal `\' character with
10236 % catcode other. We switch back and forth between these.
10237 @gdef@rawbackslash{@let\=@backslashcurfont}
10238 @gdef@otherbackslash{@let\=@realbackslash}
10240 % Same as @turnoffactive except outputs \ as {\tt\char`\\} instead of
10241 % the literal character `\'. Also revert - to its normal character, in
10242 % case the active - from code has slipped in.
10244 {@catcode`- = @active
10245 @gdef@normalturnoffactive{%
10246 @nonasciistringdefs
10247 @let-=@normaldash
10248 @let"=@normaldoublequote
10249 @let$=@normaldollar %$ font-lock fix
10250 @let+=@normalplus
10251 @let<=@normalless
10252 @let>=@normalgreater
10253 @let\=@normalbackslash
10254 @let^=@normalcaret
10255 @let_=@normalunderscore
10256 @let|=@normalverticalbar
10257 @let~=@normaltilde
10258 @markupsetuplqdefault
10259 @markupsetuprqdefault
10260 @unsepspaces
10264 % Make _ and + \other characters, temporarily.
10265 % This is canceled by @fixbackslash.
10266 @otherifyactive
10268 % If a .fmt file is being used, we don't want the `\input texinfo' to show up.
10269 % That is what \eatinput is for; after that, the `\' should revert to printing
10270 % a backslash.
10272 @gdef@eatinput input texinfo{@fixbackslash}
10273 @global@let\ = @eatinput
10275 % On the other hand, perhaps the file did not have a `\input texinfo'. Then
10276 % the first `\' in the file would cause an error. This macro tries to fix
10277 % that, assuming it is called before the first `\' could plausibly occur.
10278 % Also turn back on active characters that might appear in the input
10279 % file name, in case not using a pre-dumped format.
10281 @gdef@fixbackslash{%
10282 @ifx\@eatinput @let\ = @normalbackslash @fi
10283 @catcode`+=@active
10284 @catcode`@_=@active
10287 % Say @foo, not \foo, in error messages.
10288 @escapechar = `@@
10290 % These (along with & and #) are made active for url-breaking, so need
10291 % active definitions as the normal characters.
10292 @def@normaldot{.}
10293 @def@normalquest{?}
10294 @def@normalslash{/}
10296 % These look ok in all fonts, so just make them not special.
10297 % @hashchar{} gets its own user-level command, because of #line.
10298 @catcode`@& = @other @def@normalamp{&}
10299 @catcode`@# = @other @def@normalhash{#}
10300 @catcode`@% = @other @def@normalpercent{%}
10302 @let @hashchar = @normalhash
10304 @c Finally, make ` and ' active, so that txicodequoteundirected and
10305 @c txicodequotebacktick work right in, e.g., @w{@code{`foo'}}. If we
10306 @c don't make ` and ' active, @code will not get them as active chars.
10307 @c Do this last of all since we use ` in the previous @catcode assignments.
10308 @catcode`@'=@active
10309 @catcode`@`=@active
10310 @markupsetuplqdefault
10311 @markupsetuprqdefault
10313 @c Local variables:
10314 @c eval: (add-hook 'write-file-hooks 'time-stamp)
10315 @c page-delimiter: "^\\\\message\\|emacs-page"
10316 @c time-stamp-start: "def\\\\texinfoversion{"
10317 @c time-stamp-format: "%:y-%02m-%02d.%02H"
10318 @c time-stamp-end: "}"
10319 @c End:
10321 @c vim:sw=2:
10323 @ignore
10324 arch-tag: e1b36e32-c96e-4135-a41a-0b2efa2ea115
10325 @end ignore